ent

package
v0.11.4 Latest Latest
Warning

This package is not in the latest version of its module.

Go to latest
Published: Jan 7, 2023 License: Apache-2.0 Imports: 40 Imported by: 0

Documentation

Index

Constants

View Source
const (
	// Operation types.
	OpCreate    = ent.OpCreate
	OpDelete    = ent.OpDelete
	OpDeleteOne = ent.OpDeleteOne
	OpUpdate    = ent.OpUpdate
	OpUpdateOne = ent.OpUpdateOne

	// Node types.
	TypeAccount  = "Account"
	TypeBlob     = "Blob"
	TypeBlobLink = "BlobLink"
	TypeCar      = "Car"
	TypeDevice   = "Device"
	TypeDoc      = "Doc"
	TypeGroup    = "Group"
	TypeIntSID   = "IntSID"
	TypeLink     = "Link"
	TypeMixinID  = "MixinID"
	TypeNote     = "Note"
	TypeOther    = "Other"
	TypePet      = "Pet"
	TypeRevision = "Revision"
	TypeSession  = "Session"
	TypeToken    = "Token"
	TypeUser     = "User"
)

Variables

This section is empty.

Functions

func IsConstraintError

func IsConstraintError(err error) bool

IsConstraintError returns a boolean indicating whether the error is a constraint failure.

func IsNotFound

func IsNotFound(err error) bool

IsNotFound returns a boolean indicating whether the error is a not found error.

func IsNotLoaded

func IsNotLoaded(err error) bool

IsNotLoaded returns a boolean indicating whether the error is a not loaded error.

func IsNotSingular

func IsNotSingular(err error) bool

IsNotSingular returns a boolean indicating whether the error is a not singular error.

func IsValidationError

func IsValidationError(err error) bool

IsValidationError returns a boolean indicating whether the error is a validation error.

func MaskNotFound

func MaskNotFound(err error) error

MaskNotFound masks not found error.

func NewContext

func NewContext(parent context.Context, c *Client) context.Context

NewContext returns a new context with the given Client attached.

func NewTxContext

func NewTxContext(parent context.Context, tx *Tx) context.Context

NewTxContext returns a new context with the given Tx attached.

Types

type Account

type Account struct {

	// ID of the ent.
	ID sid.ID `json:"id,omitempty"`
	// Email holds the value of the "email" field.
	Email string `json:"email,omitempty"`
	// Edges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.
	// The values are being populated by the AccountQuery when eager-loading is set.
	Edges AccountEdges `json:"edges"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Account is the model entity for the Account schema.

func (*Account) QueryToken

func (a *Account) QueryToken() *TokenQuery

QueryToken queries the "token" edge of the Account entity.

func (*Account) String

func (a *Account) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*Account) Unwrap

func (a *Account) Unwrap() *Account

Unwrap unwraps the Account entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*Account) Update

func (a *Account) Update() *AccountUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this Account. Note that you need to call Account.Unwrap() before calling this method if this Account was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type AccountClient

type AccountClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

AccountClient is a client for the Account schema.

func NewAccountClient

func NewAccountClient(c config) *AccountClient

NewAccountClient returns a client for the Account from the given config.

func (*AccountClient) Create

func (c *AccountClient) Create() *AccountCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a Account entity.

func (*AccountClient) CreateBulk

func (c *AccountClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*AccountCreate) *AccountCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of Account entities.

func (*AccountClient) Delete

func (c *AccountClient) Delete() *AccountDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for Account.

func (*AccountClient) DeleteOne

func (c *AccountClient) DeleteOne(a *Account) *AccountDeleteOne

DeleteOne returns a builder for deleting the given entity.

func (*AccountClient) DeleteOneID

func (c *AccountClient) DeleteOneID(id sid.ID) *AccountDeleteOne

DeleteOneID returns a builder for deleting the given entity by its id.

func (*AccountClient) Get

func (c *AccountClient) Get(ctx context.Context, id sid.ID) (*Account, error)

Get returns a Account entity by its id.

func (*AccountClient) GetX

func (c *AccountClient) GetX(ctx context.Context, id sid.ID) *Account

GetX is like Get, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountClient) Hooks

func (c *AccountClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*AccountClient) Intercept

func (c *AccountClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `account.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*AccountClient) Interceptors

func (c *AccountClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*AccountClient) Query

func (c *AccountClient) Query() *AccountQuery

Query returns a query builder for Account.

func (*AccountClient) QueryToken

func (c *AccountClient) QueryToken(a *Account) *TokenQuery

QueryToken queries the token edge of a Account.

func (*AccountClient) Update

func (c *AccountClient) Update() *AccountUpdate

Update returns an update builder for Account.

func (*AccountClient) UpdateOne

func (c *AccountClient) UpdateOne(a *Account) *AccountUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*AccountClient) UpdateOneID

func (c *AccountClient) UpdateOneID(id sid.ID) *AccountUpdateOne

UpdateOneID returns an update builder for the given id.

func (*AccountClient) Use

func (c *AccountClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `account.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type AccountCreate

type AccountCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

AccountCreate is the builder for creating a Account entity.

func (*AccountCreate) AddToken

func (ac *AccountCreate) AddToken(t ...*Token) *AccountCreate

AddToken adds the "token" edges to the Token entity.

func (*AccountCreate) AddTokenIDs

func (ac *AccountCreate) AddTokenIDs(ids ...sid.ID) *AccountCreate

AddTokenIDs adds the "token" edge to the Token entity by IDs.

func (*AccountCreate) Exec

func (ac *AccountCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*AccountCreate) ExecX

func (ac *AccountCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountCreate) Mutation

func (ac *AccountCreate) Mutation() *AccountMutation

Mutation returns the AccountMutation object of the builder.

func (*AccountCreate) OnConflict

func (ac *AccountCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *AccountUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Account.Create().
	SetEmail(v).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.AccountUpsert) {
		SetEmail(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*AccountCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (ac *AccountCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *AccountUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Account.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*AccountCreate) Save

func (ac *AccountCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Account, error)

Save creates the Account in the database.

func (*AccountCreate) SaveX

func (ac *AccountCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Account

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*AccountCreate) SetEmail

func (ac *AccountCreate) SetEmail(s string) *AccountCreate

SetEmail sets the "email" field.

func (*AccountCreate) SetID

func (ac *AccountCreate) SetID(s sid.ID) *AccountCreate

SetID sets the "id" field.

func (*AccountCreate) SetNillableID

func (ac *AccountCreate) SetNillableID(s *sid.ID) *AccountCreate

SetNillableID sets the "id" field if the given value is not nil.

type AccountCreateBulk

type AccountCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

AccountCreateBulk is the builder for creating many Account entities in bulk.

func (*AccountCreateBulk) Exec

func (acb *AccountCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*AccountCreateBulk) ExecX

func (acb *AccountCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (acb *AccountCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *AccountUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Account.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.AccountUpsert) {
		SetEmail(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*AccountCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (acb *AccountCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *AccountUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Account.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*AccountCreateBulk) Save

func (acb *AccountCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*Account, error)

Save creates the Account entities in the database.

func (*AccountCreateBulk) SaveX

func (acb *AccountCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*Account

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type AccountDelete

type AccountDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

AccountDelete is the builder for deleting a Account entity.

func (*AccountDelete) Exec

func (ad *AccountDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*AccountDelete) ExecX

func (ad *AccountDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountDelete) Where

func (ad *AccountDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.Account) *AccountDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the AccountDelete builder.

type AccountDeleteOne

type AccountDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

AccountDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single Account entity.

func (*AccountDeleteOne) Exec

func (ado *AccountDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*AccountDeleteOne) ExecX

func (ado *AccountDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type AccountEdges

type AccountEdges struct {
	// Token holds the value of the token edge.
	Token []*Token `json:"token,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

AccountEdges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.

func (AccountEdges) TokenOrErr

func (e AccountEdges) TokenOrErr() ([]*Token, error)

TokenOrErr returns the Token value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading.

type AccountFilter

type AccountFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

AccountFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for AccountQuery.

func (*AccountFilter) Where

func (f *AccountFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*AccountFilter) WhereEmail

func (f *AccountFilter) WhereEmail(p entql.StringP)

WhereEmail applies the entql string predicate on the email field.

func (*AccountFilter) WhereHasToken

func (f *AccountFilter) WhereHasToken()

WhereHasToken applies a predicate to check if query has an edge token.

func (*AccountFilter) WhereHasTokenWith

func (f *AccountFilter) WhereHasTokenWith(preds ...predicate.Token)

WhereHasTokenWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge token with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*AccountFilter) WhereID

func (f *AccountFilter) WhereID(p entql.OtherP)

WhereID applies the entql other predicate on the id field.

type AccountGroupBy

type AccountGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

AccountGroupBy is the group-by builder for Account entities.

func (*AccountGroupBy) Aggregate

func (agb *AccountGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *AccountGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*AccountGroupBy) Bool

func (s *AccountGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*AccountGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *AccountGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountGroupBy) Bools

func (s *AccountGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*AccountGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *AccountGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountGroupBy) Float64

func (s *AccountGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*AccountGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *AccountGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *AccountGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*AccountGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *AccountGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountGroupBy) Int

func (s *AccountGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*AccountGroupBy) IntX

func (s *AccountGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountGroupBy) Ints

func (s *AccountGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*AccountGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *AccountGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountGroupBy) Scan

func (agb *AccountGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*AccountGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *AccountGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountGroupBy) String

func (s *AccountGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*AccountGroupBy) StringX

func (s *AccountGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountGroupBy) Strings

func (s *AccountGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*AccountGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *AccountGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type AccountMutation

type AccountMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

AccountMutation represents an operation that mutates the Account nodes in the graph.

func (*AccountMutation) AddField

func (m *AccountMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*AccountMutation) AddTokenIDs

func (m *AccountMutation) AddTokenIDs(ids ...sid.ID)

AddTokenIDs adds the "token" edge to the Token entity by ids.

func (*AccountMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *AccountMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*AccountMutation) AddedField

func (m *AccountMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*AccountMutation) AddedFields

func (m *AccountMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*AccountMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *AccountMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*AccountMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *AccountMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*AccountMutation) ClearField

func (m *AccountMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*AccountMutation) ClearToken

func (m *AccountMutation) ClearToken()

ClearToken clears the "token" edge to the Token entity.

func (*AccountMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *AccountMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*AccountMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *AccountMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (AccountMutation) Client

func (m AccountMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*AccountMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *AccountMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*AccountMutation) Email

func (m *AccountMutation) Email() (r string, exists bool)

Email returns the value of the "email" field in the mutation.

func (*AccountMutation) Field

func (m *AccountMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*AccountMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *AccountMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*AccountMutation) Fields

func (m *AccountMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*AccountMutation) Filter

func (m *AccountMutation) Filter() *AccountFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the AccountMutation builder.

func (*AccountMutation) ID

func (m *AccountMutation) ID() (id sid.ID, exists bool)

ID returns the ID value in the mutation. Note that the ID is only available if it was provided to the builder or after it was returned from the database.

func (*AccountMutation) IDs

func (m *AccountMutation) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]sid.ID, error)

IDs queries the database and returns the entity ids that match the mutation's predicate. That means, if the mutation is applied within a transaction with an isolation level such as sql.LevelSerializable, the returned ids match the ids of the rows that will be updated or updated by the mutation.

func (*AccountMutation) OldEmail

func (m *AccountMutation) OldEmail(ctx context.Context) (v string, err error)

OldEmail returns the old "email" field's value of the Account entity. If the Account object wasn't provided to the builder, the object is fetched from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the database query fails.

func (*AccountMutation) OldField

func (m *AccountMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*AccountMutation) Op

func (m *AccountMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*AccountMutation) RemoveTokenIDs

func (m *AccountMutation) RemoveTokenIDs(ids ...sid.ID)

RemoveTokenIDs removes the "token" edge to the Token entity by IDs.

func (*AccountMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *AccountMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*AccountMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *AccountMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*AccountMutation) RemovedTokenIDs

func (m *AccountMutation) RemovedTokenIDs() (ids []sid.ID)

RemovedToken returns the removed IDs of the "token" edge to the Token entity.

func (*AccountMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *AccountMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*AccountMutation) ResetEmail

func (m *AccountMutation) ResetEmail()

ResetEmail resets all changes to the "email" field.

func (*AccountMutation) ResetField

func (m *AccountMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*AccountMutation) ResetToken

func (m *AccountMutation) ResetToken()

ResetToken resets all changes to the "token" edge.

func (*AccountMutation) SetEmail

func (m *AccountMutation) SetEmail(s string)

SetEmail sets the "email" field.

func (*AccountMutation) SetField

func (m *AccountMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*AccountMutation) SetID

func (m *AccountMutation) SetID(id sid.ID)

SetID sets the value of the id field. Note that this operation is only accepted on creation of Account entities.

func (*AccountMutation) SetOp

func (m *AccountMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (*AccountMutation) TokenCleared

func (m *AccountMutation) TokenCleared() bool

TokenCleared reports if the "token" edge to the Token entity was cleared.

func (*AccountMutation) TokenIDs

func (m *AccountMutation) TokenIDs() (ids []sid.ID)

TokenIDs returns the "token" edge IDs in the mutation.

func (AccountMutation) Tx

func (m AccountMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*AccountMutation) Type

func (m *AccountMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (Account).

func (*AccountMutation) Where

func (m *AccountMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.Account)

Where appends a list predicates to the AccountMutation builder.

func (*AccountMutation) WhereP

func (m *AccountMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the AccountMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type AccountQuery

type AccountQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

AccountQuery is the builder for querying Account entities.

func (*AccountQuery) Aggregate

func (aq *AccountQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *AccountSelect

Aggregate returns a AccountSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*AccountQuery) All

func (aq *AccountQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*Account, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of Accounts.

func (*AccountQuery) AllX

func (aq *AccountQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*Account

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountQuery) Clone

func (aq *AccountQuery) Clone() *AccountQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the AccountQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*AccountQuery) Count

func (aq *AccountQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*AccountQuery) CountX

func (aq *AccountQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountQuery) Exist

func (aq *AccountQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*AccountQuery) ExistX

func (aq *AccountQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountQuery) Filter

func (aq *AccountQuery) Filter() *AccountFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the AccountQuery builder.

func (*AccountQuery) First

func (aq *AccountQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*Account, error)

First returns the first Account entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Account was found.

func (*AccountQuery) FirstID

func (aq *AccountQuery) FirstID(ctx context.Context) (id sid.ID, err error)

FirstID returns the first Account ID from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Account ID was found.

func (*AccountQuery) FirstIDX

func (aq *AccountQuery) FirstIDX(ctx context.Context) sid.ID

FirstIDX is like FirstID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountQuery) FirstX

func (aq *AccountQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *Account

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountQuery) GroupBy

func (aq *AccountQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *AccountGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

Example:

var v []struct {
	Email string `json:"email,omitempty"`
	Count int `json:"count,omitempty"`
}

client.Account.Query().
	GroupBy(account.FieldEmail).
	Aggregate(ent.Count()).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*AccountQuery) IDs

func (aq *AccountQuery) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]sid.ID, error)

IDs executes the query and returns a list of Account IDs.

func (*AccountQuery) IDsX

func (aq *AccountQuery) IDsX(ctx context.Context) []sid.ID

IDsX is like IDs, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountQuery) Limit

func (aq *AccountQuery) Limit(limit int) *AccountQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*AccountQuery) Offset

func (aq *AccountQuery) Offset(offset int) *AccountQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*AccountQuery) Only

func (aq *AccountQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*Account, error)

Only returns a single Account entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Account entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Account entities are found.

func (*AccountQuery) OnlyID

func (aq *AccountQuery) OnlyID(ctx context.Context) (id sid.ID, err error)

OnlyID is like Only, but returns the only Account ID in the query. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Account ID is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no entities are found.

func (*AccountQuery) OnlyIDX

func (aq *AccountQuery) OnlyIDX(ctx context.Context) sid.ID

OnlyIDX is like OnlyID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountQuery) OnlyX

func (aq *AccountQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *Account

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountQuery) Order

func (aq *AccountQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *AccountQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (*AccountQuery) QueryToken

func (aq *AccountQuery) QueryToken() *TokenQuery

QueryToken chains the current query on the "token" edge.

func (*AccountQuery) Select

func (aq *AccountQuery) Select(fields ...string) *AccountSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

Example:

var v []struct {
	Email string `json:"email,omitempty"`
}

client.Account.Query().
	Select(account.FieldEmail).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*AccountQuery) Unique

func (aq *AccountQuery) Unique(unique bool) *AccountQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*AccountQuery) Where

func (aq *AccountQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.Account) *AccountQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the AccountQuery builder.

func (*AccountQuery) WithToken

func (aq *AccountQuery) WithToken(opts ...func(*TokenQuery)) *AccountQuery

WithToken tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "token" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

type AccountSelect

type AccountSelect struct {
	*AccountQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

AccountSelect is the builder for selecting fields of Account entities.

func (*AccountSelect) Aggregate

func (as *AccountSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *AccountSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*AccountSelect) Bool

func (s *AccountSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*AccountSelect) BoolX

func (s *AccountSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountSelect) Bools

func (s *AccountSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*AccountSelect) BoolsX

func (s *AccountSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountSelect) Float64

func (s *AccountSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*AccountSelect) Float64X

func (s *AccountSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountSelect) Float64s

func (s *AccountSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*AccountSelect) Float64sX

func (s *AccountSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountSelect) Int

func (s *AccountSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*AccountSelect) IntX

func (s *AccountSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountSelect) Ints

func (s *AccountSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*AccountSelect) IntsX

func (s *AccountSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountSelect) Scan

func (as *AccountSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*AccountSelect) ScanX

func (s *AccountSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountSelect) String

func (s *AccountSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*AccountSelect) StringX

func (s *AccountSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountSelect) Strings

func (s *AccountSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*AccountSelect) StringsX

func (s *AccountSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type AccountUpdate

type AccountUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

AccountUpdate is the builder for updating Account entities.

func (*AccountUpdate) AddToken

func (au *AccountUpdate) AddToken(t ...*Token) *AccountUpdate

AddToken adds the "token" edges to the Token entity.

func (*AccountUpdate) AddTokenIDs

func (au *AccountUpdate) AddTokenIDs(ids ...sid.ID) *AccountUpdate

AddTokenIDs adds the "token" edge to the Token entity by IDs.

func (*AccountUpdate) ClearToken

func (au *AccountUpdate) ClearToken() *AccountUpdate

ClearToken clears all "token" edges to the Token entity.

func (*AccountUpdate) Exec

func (au *AccountUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*AccountUpdate) ExecX

func (au *AccountUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountUpdate) Mutation

func (au *AccountUpdate) Mutation() *AccountMutation

Mutation returns the AccountMutation object of the builder.

func (*AccountUpdate) RemoveToken

func (au *AccountUpdate) RemoveToken(t ...*Token) *AccountUpdate

RemoveToken removes "token" edges to Token entities.

func (*AccountUpdate) RemoveTokenIDs

func (au *AccountUpdate) RemoveTokenIDs(ids ...sid.ID) *AccountUpdate

RemoveTokenIDs removes the "token" edge to Token entities by IDs.

func (*AccountUpdate) Save

func (au *AccountUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*AccountUpdate) SaveX

func (au *AccountUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountUpdate) SetEmail

func (au *AccountUpdate) SetEmail(s string) *AccountUpdate

SetEmail sets the "email" field.

func (*AccountUpdate) Where

func (au *AccountUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.Account) *AccountUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the AccountUpdate builder.

type AccountUpdateOne

type AccountUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

AccountUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single Account entity.

func (*AccountUpdateOne) AddToken

func (auo *AccountUpdateOne) AddToken(t ...*Token) *AccountUpdateOne

AddToken adds the "token" edges to the Token entity.

func (*AccountUpdateOne) AddTokenIDs

func (auo *AccountUpdateOne) AddTokenIDs(ids ...sid.ID) *AccountUpdateOne

AddTokenIDs adds the "token" edge to the Token entity by IDs.

func (*AccountUpdateOne) ClearToken

func (auo *AccountUpdateOne) ClearToken() *AccountUpdateOne

ClearToken clears all "token" edges to the Token entity.

func (*AccountUpdateOne) Exec

func (auo *AccountUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*AccountUpdateOne) ExecX

func (auo *AccountUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountUpdateOne) Mutation

func (auo *AccountUpdateOne) Mutation() *AccountMutation

Mutation returns the AccountMutation object of the builder.

func (*AccountUpdateOne) RemoveToken

func (auo *AccountUpdateOne) RemoveToken(t ...*Token) *AccountUpdateOne

RemoveToken removes "token" edges to Token entities.

func (*AccountUpdateOne) RemoveTokenIDs

func (auo *AccountUpdateOne) RemoveTokenIDs(ids ...sid.ID) *AccountUpdateOne

RemoveTokenIDs removes the "token" edge to Token entities by IDs.

func (*AccountUpdateOne) Save

func (auo *AccountUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Account, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated Account entity.

func (*AccountUpdateOne) SaveX

func (auo *AccountUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Account

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountUpdateOne) Select

func (auo *AccountUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *AccountUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

func (*AccountUpdateOne) SetEmail

func (auo *AccountUpdateOne) SetEmail(s string) *AccountUpdateOne

SetEmail sets the "email" field.

type AccountUpsert

type AccountUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

AccountUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

func (*AccountUpsert) SetEmail

func (u *AccountUpsert) SetEmail(v string) *AccountUpsert

SetEmail sets the "email" field.

func (*AccountUpsert) UpdateEmail

func (u *AccountUpsert) UpdateEmail() *AccountUpsert

UpdateEmail sets the "email" field to the value that was provided on create.

type AccountUpsertBulk

type AccountUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

AccountUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of Account nodes.

func (*AccountUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *AccountUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *AccountUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*AccountUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *AccountUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*AccountUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *AccountUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountUpsertBulk) Ignore

func (u *AccountUpsertBulk) Ignore() *AccountUpsertBulk

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Account.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*AccountUpsertBulk) SetEmail

func (u *AccountUpsertBulk) SetEmail(v string) *AccountUpsertBulk

SetEmail sets the "email" field.

func (*AccountUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *AccountUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*AccountUpsert)) *AccountUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the AccountCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*AccountUpsertBulk) UpdateEmail

func (u *AccountUpsertBulk) UpdateEmail() *AccountUpsertBulk

UpdateEmail sets the "email" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*AccountUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *AccountUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *AccountUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Account.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(account.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type AccountUpsertOne

type AccountUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

AccountUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one Account node.

func (*AccountUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *AccountUpsertOne) DoNothing() *AccountUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*AccountUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *AccountUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*AccountUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *AccountUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountUpsertOne) ID

func (u *AccountUpsertOne) ID(ctx context.Context) (id sid.ID, err error)

Exec executes the UPSERT query and returns the inserted/updated ID.

func (*AccountUpsertOne) IDX

func (u *AccountUpsertOne) IDX(ctx context.Context) sid.ID

IDX is like ID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*AccountUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *AccountUpsertOne) Ignore() *AccountUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Account.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*AccountUpsertOne) SetEmail

func (u *AccountUpsertOne) SetEmail(v string) *AccountUpsertOne

SetEmail sets the "email" field.

func (*AccountUpsertOne) Update

func (u *AccountUpsertOne) Update(set func(*AccountUpsert)) *AccountUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the AccountCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*AccountUpsertOne) UpdateEmail

func (u *AccountUpsertOne) UpdateEmail() *AccountUpsertOne

UpdateEmail sets the "email" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*AccountUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *AccountUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *AccountUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create except the ID field. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Account.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(account.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type Accounts

type Accounts []*Account

Accounts is a parsable slice of Account.

type AggregateFunc

type AggregateFunc func(*sql.Selector) string

AggregateFunc applies an aggregation step on the group-by traversal/selector.

func As

As is a pseudo aggregation function for renaming another other functions with custom names. For example:

GroupBy(field1, field2).
Aggregate(ent.As(ent.Sum(field1), "sum_field1"), (ent.As(ent.Sum(field2), "sum_field2")).
Scan(ctx, &v)

func Count

func Count() AggregateFunc

Count applies the "count" aggregation function on each group.

func Max

func Max(field string) AggregateFunc

Max applies the "max" aggregation function on the given field of each group.

func Mean

func Mean(field string) AggregateFunc

Mean applies the "mean" aggregation function on the given field of each group.

func Min

func Min(field string) AggregateFunc

Min applies the "min" aggregation function on the given field of each group.

func Sum

func Sum(field string) AggregateFunc

Sum applies the "sum" aggregation function on the given field of each group.

type Blob

type Blob struct {

	// ID of the ent.
	ID uuid.UUID `json:"id,omitempty"`
	// UUID holds the value of the "uuid" field.
	UUID uuid.UUID `json:"uuid,omitempty"`
	// Count holds the value of the "count" field.
	Count int `json:"count,omitempty"`
	// Edges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.
	// The values are being populated by the BlobQuery when eager-loading is set.
	Edges BlobEdges `json:"edges"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Blob is the model entity for the Blob schema.

func (b *Blob) QueryBlobLinks() *BlobLinkQuery

QueryBlobLinks queries the "blob_links" edge of the Blob entity.

func (b *Blob) QueryLinks() *BlobQuery

QueryLinks queries the "links" edge of the Blob entity.

func (*Blob) QueryParent

func (b *Blob) QueryParent() *BlobQuery

QueryParent queries the "parent" edge of the Blob entity.

func (*Blob) String

func (b *Blob) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*Blob) Unwrap

func (b *Blob) Unwrap() *Blob

Unwrap unwraps the Blob entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*Blob) Update

func (b *Blob) Update() *BlobUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this Blob. Note that you need to call Blob.Unwrap() before calling this method if this Blob was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type BlobClient

type BlobClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobClient is a client for the Blob schema.

func NewBlobClient

func NewBlobClient(c config) *BlobClient

NewBlobClient returns a client for the Blob from the given config.

func (*BlobClient) Create

func (c *BlobClient) Create() *BlobCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a Blob entity.

func (*BlobClient) CreateBulk

func (c *BlobClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*BlobCreate) *BlobCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of Blob entities.

func (*BlobClient) Delete

func (c *BlobClient) Delete() *BlobDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for Blob.

func (*BlobClient) DeleteOne

func (c *BlobClient) DeleteOne(b *Blob) *BlobDeleteOne

DeleteOne returns a builder for deleting the given entity.

func (*BlobClient) DeleteOneID

func (c *BlobClient) DeleteOneID(id uuid.UUID) *BlobDeleteOne

DeleteOneID returns a builder for deleting the given entity by its id.

func (*BlobClient) Get

func (c *BlobClient) Get(ctx context.Context, id uuid.UUID) (*Blob, error)

Get returns a Blob entity by its id.

func (*BlobClient) GetX

func (c *BlobClient) GetX(ctx context.Context, id uuid.UUID) *Blob

GetX is like Get, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobClient) Hooks

func (c *BlobClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*BlobClient) Intercept

func (c *BlobClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `blob.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*BlobClient) Interceptors

func (c *BlobClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*BlobClient) Query

func (c *BlobClient) Query() *BlobQuery

Query returns a query builder for Blob.

func (c *BlobClient) QueryBlobLinks(b *Blob) *BlobLinkQuery

QueryBlobLinks queries the blob_links edge of a Blob.

func (c *BlobClient) QueryLinks(b *Blob) *BlobQuery

QueryLinks queries the links edge of a Blob.

func (*BlobClient) QueryParent

func (c *BlobClient) QueryParent(b *Blob) *BlobQuery

QueryParent queries the parent edge of a Blob.

func (*BlobClient) Update

func (c *BlobClient) Update() *BlobUpdate

Update returns an update builder for Blob.

func (*BlobClient) UpdateOne

func (c *BlobClient) UpdateOne(b *Blob) *BlobUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*BlobClient) UpdateOneID

func (c *BlobClient) UpdateOneID(id uuid.UUID) *BlobUpdateOne

UpdateOneID returns an update builder for the given id.

func (*BlobClient) Use

func (c *BlobClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `blob.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type BlobCreate

type BlobCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobCreate is the builder for creating a Blob entity.

func (*BlobCreate) AddLinkIDs

func (bc *BlobCreate) AddLinkIDs(ids ...uuid.UUID) *BlobCreate

AddLinkIDs adds the "links" edge to the Blob entity by IDs.

func (bc *BlobCreate) AddLinks(b ...*Blob) *BlobCreate

AddLinks adds the "links" edges to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobCreate) Exec

func (bc *BlobCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*BlobCreate) ExecX

func (bc *BlobCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobCreate) Mutation

func (bc *BlobCreate) Mutation() *BlobMutation

Mutation returns the BlobMutation object of the builder.

func (*BlobCreate) OnConflict

func (bc *BlobCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *BlobUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Blob.Create().
	SetUUID(v).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.BlobUpsert) {
		SetUUID(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*BlobCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (bc *BlobCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *BlobUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Blob.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*BlobCreate) Save

func (bc *BlobCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Blob, error)

Save creates the Blob in the database.

func (*BlobCreate) SaveX

func (bc *BlobCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Blob

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*BlobCreate) SetCount

func (bc *BlobCreate) SetCount(i int) *BlobCreate

SetCount sets the "count" field.

func (*BlobCreate) SetID

func (bc *BlobCreate) SetID(u uuid.UUID) *BlobCreate

SetID sets the "id" field.

func (*BlobCreate) SetNillableCount

func (bc *BlobCreate) SetNillableCount(i *int) *BlobCreate

SetNillableCount sets the "count" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*BlobCreate) SetNillableID

func (bc *BlobCreate) SetNillableID(u *uuid.UUID) *BlobCreate

SetNillableID sets the "id" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*BlobCreate) SetNillableParentID

func (bc *BlobCreate) SetNillableParentID(id *uuid.UUID) *BlobCreate

SetNillableParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Blob entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*BlobCreate) SetNillableUUID

func (bc *BlobCreate) SetNillableUUID(u *uuid.UUID) *BlobCreate

SetNillableUUID sets the "uuid" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*BlobCreate) SetParent

func (bc *BlobCreate) SetParent(b *Blob) *BlobCreate

SetParent sets the "parent" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobCreate) SetParentID

func (bc *BlobCreate) SetParentID(id uuid.UUID) *BlobCreate

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Blob entity by ID.

func (*BlobCreate) SetUUID

func (bc *BlobCreate) SetUUID(u uuid.UUID) *BlobCreate

SetUUID sets the "uuid" field.

type BlobCreateBulk

type BlobCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobCreateBulk is the builder for creating many Blob entities in bulk.

func (*BlobCreateBulk) Exec

func (bcb *BlobCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*BlobCreateBulk) ExecX

func (bcb *BlobCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (bcb *BlobCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *BlobUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Blob.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.BlobUpsert) {
		SetUUID(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*BlobCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (bcb *BlobCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *BlobUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Blob.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*BlobCreateBulk) Save

func (bcb *BlobCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*Blob, error)

Save creates the Blob entities in the database.

func (*BlobCreateBulk) SaveX

func (bcb *BlobCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*Blob

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type BlobDelete

type BlobDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobDelete is the builder for deleting a Blob entity.

func (*BlobDelete) Exec

func (bd *BlobDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*BlobDelete) ExecX

func (bd *BlobDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobDelete) Where

func (bd *BlobDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.Blob) *BlobDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the BlobDelete builder.

type BlobDeleteOne

type BlobDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single Blob entity.

func (*BlobDeleteOne) Exec

func (bdo *BlobDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*BlobDeleteOne) ExecX

func (bdo *BlobDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type BlobEdges

type BlobEdges struct {
	// Parent holds the value of the parent edge.
	Parent *Blob `json:"parent,omitempty"`
	// Links holds the value of the links edge.
	Links []*Blob `json:"links,omitempty"`
	// BlobLinks holds the value of the blob_links edge.
	BlobLinks []*BlobLink `json:"blob_links,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobEdges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.

func (BlobEdges) BlobLinksOrErr

func (e BlobEdges) BlobLinksOrErr() ([]*BlobLink, error)

BlobLinksOrErr returns the BlobLinks value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading.

func (BlobEdges) LinksOrErr

func (e BlobEdges) LinksOrErr() ([]*Blob, error)

LinksOrErr returns the Links value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading.

func (BlobEdges) ParentOrErr

func (e BlobEdges) ParentOrErr() (*Blob, error)

ParentOrErr returns the Parent value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading, or loaded but was not found.

type BlobFilter

type BlobFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for BlobQuery.

func (*BlobFilter) Where

func (f *BlobFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*BlobFilter) WhereCount

func (f *BlobFilter) WhereCount(p entql.IntP)

WhereCount applies the entql int predicate on the count field.

func (f *BlobFilter) WhereHasBlobLinks()

WhereHasBlobLinks applies a predicate to check if query has an edge blob_links.

func (*BlobFilter) WhereHasBlobLinksWith

func (f *BlobFilter) WhereHasBlobLinksWith(preds ...predicate.BlobLink)

WhereHasBlobLinksWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge blob_links with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (f *BlobFilter) WhereHasLinks()

WhereHasLinks applies a predicate to check if query has an edge links.

func (*BlobFilter) WhereHasLinksWith

func (f *BlobFilter) WhereHasLinksWith(preds ...predicate.Blob)

WhereHasLinksWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge links with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*BlobFilter) WhereHasParent

func (f *BlobFilter) WhereHasParent()

WhereHasParent applies a predicate to check if query has an edge parent.

func (*BlobFilter) WhereHasParentWith

func (f *BlobFilter) WhereHasParentWith(preds ...predicate.Blob)

WhereHasParentWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge parent with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*BlobFilter) WhereID

func (f *BlobFilter) WhereID(p entql.ValueP)

WhereID applies the entql [16]byte predicate on the id field.

func (*BlobFilter) WhereUUID

func (f *BlobFilter) WhereUUID(p entql.ValueP)

WhereUUID applies the entql [16]byte predicate on the uuid field.

type BlobGroupBy

type BlobGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobGroupBy is the group-by builder for Blob entities.

func (*BlobGroupBy) Aggregate

func (bgb *BlobGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *BlobGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*BlobGroupBy) Bool

func (s *BlobGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *BlobGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobGroupBy) Bools

func (s *BlobGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *BlobGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobGroupBy) Float64

func (s *BlobGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *BlobGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *BlobGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *BlobGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobGroupBy) Int

func (s *BlobGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobGroupBy) IntX

func (s *BlobGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobGroupBy) Ints

func (s *BlobGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *BlobGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobGroupBy) Scan

func (bgb *BlobGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*BlobGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *BlobGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobGroupBy) String

func (s *BlobGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobGroupBy) StringX

func (s *BlobGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobGroupBy) Strings

func (s *BlobGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *BlobGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type BlobLink struct {

	// CreatedAt holds the value of the "created_at" field.
	CreatedAt time.Time `json:"created_at,omitempty"`
	// BlobID holds the value of the "blob_id" field.
	BlobID uuid.UUID `json:"blob_id,omitempty"`
	// LinkID holds the value of the "link_id" field.
	LinkID uuid.UUID `json:"link_id,omitempty"`
	// Edges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.
	// The values are being populated by the BlobLinkQuery when eager-loading is set.
	Edges BlobLinkEdges `json:"edges"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobLink is the model entity for the BlobLink schema.

func (*BlobLink) QueryBlob

func (bl *BlobLink) QueryBlob() *BlobQuery

QueryBlob queries the "blob" edge of the BlobLink entity.

func (bl *BlobLink) QueryLink() *BlobQuery

QueryLink queries the "link" edge of the BlobLink entity.

func (*BlobLink) String

func (bl *BlobLink) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*BlobLink) Unwrap

func (bl *BlobLink) Unwrap() *BlobLink

Unwrap unwraps the BlobLink entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*BlobLink) Update

func (bl *BlobLink) Update() *BlobLinkUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this BlobLink. Note that you need to call BlobLink.Unwrap() before calling this method if this BlobLink was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type BlobLinkClient

type BlobLinkClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobLinkClient is a client for the BlobLink schema.

func NewBlobLinkClient

func NewBlobLinkClient(c config) *BlobLinkClient

NewBlobLinkClient returns a client for the BlobLink from the given config.

func (*BlobLinkClient) Create

func (c *BlobLinkClient) Create() *BlobLinkCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a BlobLink entity.

func (*BlobLinkClient) CreateBulk

func (c *BlobLinkClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*BlobLinkCreate) *BlobLinkCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of BlobLink entities.

func (*BlobLinkClient) Delete

func (c *BlobLinkClient) Delete() *BlobLinkDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for BlobLink.

func (*BlobLinkClient) Hooks

func (c *BlobLinkClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*BlobLinkClient) Intercept

func (c *BlobLinkClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `bloblink.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*BlobLinkClient) Interceptors

func (c *BlobLinkClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*BlobLinkClient) Query

func (c *BlobLinkClient) Query() *BlobLinkQuery

Query returns a query builder for BlobLink.

func (*BlobLinkClient) QueryBlob

func (c *BlobLinkClient) QueryBlob(bl *BlobLink) *BlobQuery

QueryBlob queries the blob edge of a BlobLink.

func (c *BlobLinkClient) QueryLink(bl *BlobLink) *BlobQuery

QueryLink queries the link edge of a BlobLink.

func (*BlobLinkClient) Update

func (c *BlobLinkClient) Update() *BlobLinkUpdate

Update returns an update builder for BlobLink.

func (*BlobLinkClient) UpdateOne

func (c *BlobLinkClient) UpdateOne(bl *BlobLink) *BlobLinkUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*BlobLinkClient) Use

func (c *BlobLinkClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `bloblink.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type BlobLinkCreate

type BlobLinkCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobLinkCreate is the builder for creating a BlobLink entity.

func (*BlobLinkCreate) Exec

func (blc *BlobLinkCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*BlobLinkCreate) ExecX

func (blc *BlobLinkCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkCreate) Mutation

func (blc *BlobLinkCreate) Mutation() *BlobLinkMutation

Mutation returns the BlobLinkMutation object of the builder.

func (*BlobLinkCreate) OnConflict

func (blc *BlobLinkCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *BlobLinkUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.BlobLink.Create().
	SetCreatedAt(v).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.BlobLinkUpsert) {
		SetCreatedAt(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*BlobLinkCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (blc *BlobLinkCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *BlobLinkUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.BlobLink.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*BlobLinkCreate) Save

func (blc *BlobLinkCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*BlobLink, error)

Save creates the BlobLink in the database.

func (*BlobLinkCreate) SaveX

func (blc *BlobLinkCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *BlobLink

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*BlobLinkCreate) SetBlob

func (blc *BlobLinkCreate) SetBlob(b *Blob) *BlobLinkCreate

SetBlob sets the "blob" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobLinkCreate) SetBlobID

func (blc *BlobLinkCreate) SetBlobID(u uuid.UUID) *BlobLinkCreate

SetBlobID sets the "blob_id" field.

func (*BlobLinkCreate) SetCreatedAt

func (blc *BlobLinkCreate) SetCreatedAt(t time.Time) *BlobLinkCreate

SetCreatedAt sets the "created_at" field.

func (blc *BlobLinkCreate) SetLink(b *Blob) *BlobLinkCreate

SetLink sets the "link" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobLinkCreate) SetLinkID

func (blc *BlobLinkCreate) SetLinkID(u uuid.UUID) *BlobLinkCreate

SetLinkID sets the "link_id" field.

func (*BlobLinkCreate) SetNillableCreatedAt

func (blc *BlobLinkCreate) SetNillableCreatedAt(t *time.Time) *BlobLinkCreate

SetNillableCreatedAt sets the "created_at" field if the given value is not nil.

type BlobLinkCreateBulk

type BlobLinkCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobLinkCreateBulk is the builder for creating many BlobLink entities in bulk.

func (*BlobLinkCreateBulk) Exec

func (blcb *BlobLinkCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*BlobLinkCreateBulk) ExecX

func (blcb *BlobLinkCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (blcb *BlobLinkCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *BlobLinkUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.BlobLink.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.BlobLinkUpsert) {
		SetCreatedAt(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*BlobLinkCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (blcb *BlobLinkCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *BlobLinkUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.BlobLink.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*BlobLinkCreateBulk) Save

func (blcb *BlobLinkCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*BlobLink, error)

Save creates the BlobLink entities in the database.

func (*BlobLinkCreateBulk) SaveX

func (blcb *BlobLinkCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*BlobLink

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type BlobLinkDelete

type BlobLinkDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobLinkDelete is the builder for deleting a BlobLink entity.

func (*BlobLinkDelete) Exec

func (bld *BlobLinkDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*BlobLinkDelete) ExecX

func (bld *BlobLinkDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkDelete) Where

func (bld *BlobLinkDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.BlobLink) *BlobLinkDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the BlobLinkDelete builder.

type BlobLinkDeleteOne

type BlobLinkDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobLinkDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single BlobLink entity.

func (*BlobLinkDeleteOne) Exec

func (bldo *BlobLinkDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*BlobLinkDeleteOne) ExecX

func (bldo *BlobLinkDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type BlobLinkEdges

type BlobLinkEdges struct {
	// Blob holds the value of the blob edge.
	Blob *Blob `json:"blob,omitempty"`
	// Link holds the value of the link edge.
	Link *Blob `json:"link,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobLinkEdges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.

func (BlobLinkEdges) BlobOrErr

func (e BlobLinkEdges) BlobOrErr() (*Blob, error)

BlobOrErr returns the Blob value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading, or loaded but was not found.

func (BlobLinkEdges) LinkOrErr

func (e BlobLinkEdges) LinkOrErr() (*Blob, error)

LinkOrErr returns the Link value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading, or loaded but was not found.

type BlobLinkFilter

type BlobLinkFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobLinkFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for BlobLinkQuery.

func (*BlobLinkFilter) Where

func (f *BlobLinkFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*BlobLinkFilter) WhereBlobID

func (f *BlobLinkFilter) WhereBlobID(p entql.ValueP)

WhereBlobID applies the entql [16]byte predicate on the blob_id field.

func (*BlobLinkFilter) WhereCreatedAt

func (f *BlobLinkFilter) WhereCreatedAt(p entql.TimeP)

WhereCreatedAt applies the entql time.Time predicate on the created_at field.

func (*BlobLinkFilter) WhereHasBlob

func (f *BlobLinkFilter) WhereHasBlob()

WhereHasBlob applies a predicate to check if query has an edge blob.

func (*BlobLinkFilter) WhereHasBlobWith

func (f *BlobLinkFilter) WhereHasBlobWith(preds ...predicate.Blob)

WhereHasBlobWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge blob with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (f *BlobLinkFilter) WhereHasLink()

WhereHasLink applies a predicate to check if query has an edge link.

func (*BlobLinkFilter) WhereHasLinkWith

func (f *BlobLinkFilter) WhereHasLinkWith(preds ...predicate.Blob)

WhereHasLinkWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge link with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*BlobLinkFilter) WhereLinkID

func (f *BlobLinkFilter) WhereLinkID(p entql.ValueP)

WhereLinkID applies the entql [16]byte predicate on the link_id field.

type BlobLinkGroupBy

type BlobLinkGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobLinkGroupBy is the group-by builder for BlobLink entities.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) Aggregate

func (blgb *BlobLinkGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *BlobLinkGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) Bool

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) Bools

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) Float64

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) Int

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) IntX

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) Ints

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) Scan

func (blgb *BlobLinkGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) String

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) StringX

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) Strings

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobLinkGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *BlobLinkGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type BlobLinkMutation

type BlobLinkMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobLinkMutation represents an operation that mutates the BlobLink nodes in the graph.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) AddField

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) AddedField

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) AddedFields

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) BlobCleared

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) BlobCleared() bool

BlobCleared reports if the "blob" edge to the Blob entity was cleared.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) BlobID

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) BlobID() (r uuid.UUID, exists bool)

BlobID returns the value of the "blob_id" field in the mutation.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) BlobIDs

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) BlobIDs() (ids []uuid.UUID)

BlobIDs returns the "blob" edge IDs in the mutation. Note that IDs always returns len(IDs) <= 1 for unique edges, and you should use BlobID instead. It exists only for internal usage by the builders.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) ClearBlob

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) ClearBlob()

ClearBlob clears the "blob" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) ClearField

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) ClearLink()

ClearLink clears the "link" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (BlobLinkMutation) Client

func (m BlobLinkMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) CreatedAt

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) CreatedAt() (r time.Time, exists bool)

CreatedAt returns the value of the "created_at" field in the mutation.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) Field

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) Fields

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*BlobLinkMutation) Filter

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) Filter() *BlobLinkFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the BlobLinkMutation builder.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) LinkCleared

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) LinkCleared() bool

LinkCleared reports if the "link" edge to the Blob entity was cleared.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) LinkID

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) LinkID() (r uuid.UUID, exists bool)

LinkID returns the value of the "link_id" field in the mutation.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) LinkIDs

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) LinkIDs() (ids []uuid.UUID)

LinkIDs returns the "link" edge IDs in the mutation. Note that IDs always returns len(IDs) <= 1 for unique edges, and you should use LinkID instead. It exists only for internal usage by the builders.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) OldField

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) Op

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) ResetBlob

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) ResetBlob()

ResetBlob resets all changes to the "blob" edge.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) ResetBlobID

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) ResetBlobID()

ResetBlobID resets all changes to the "blob_id" field.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) ResetCreatedAt

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) ResetCreatedAt()

ResetCreatedAt resets all changes to the "created_at" field.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) ResetField

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) ResetLink()

ResetLink resets all changes to the "link" edge.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) ResetLinkID

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) ResetLinkID()

ResetLinkID resets all changes to the "link_id" field.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) SetBlobID

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) SetBlobID(u uuid.UUID)

SetBlobID sets the "blob_id" field.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) SetCreatedAt

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) SetCreatedAt(t time.Time)

SetCreatedAt sets the "created_at" field.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) SetField

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) SetLinkID

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) SetLinkID(u uuid.UUID)

SetLinkID sets the "link_id" field.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) SetOp

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (BlobLinkMutation) Tx

func (m BlobLinkMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) Type

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (BlobLink).

func (*BlobLinkMutation) Where

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.BlobLink)

Where appends a list predicates to the BlobLinkMutation builder.

func (*BlobLinkMutation) WhereP

func (m *BlobLinkMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the BlobLinkMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type BlobLinkQuery

type BlobLinkQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobLinkQuery is the builder for querying BlobLink entities.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) Aggregate

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *BlobLinkSelect

Aggregate returns a BlobLinkSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) All

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*BlobLink, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of BlobLinks.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) AllX

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*BlobLink

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) Clone

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) Clone() *BlobLinkQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the BlobLinkQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) Count

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) CountX

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) Exist

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) ExistX

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) Filter

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) Filter() *BlobLinkFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the BlobLinkQuery builder.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) First

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*BlobLink, error)

First returns the first BlobLink entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no BlobLink was found.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) FirstX

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *BlobLink

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) GroupBy

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *BlobLinkGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

Example:

var v []struct {
	CreatedAt time.Time `json:"created_at,omitempty"`
	Count int `json:"count,omitempty"`
}

client.BlobLink.Query().
	GroupBy(bloblink.FieldCreatedAt).
	Aggregate(ent.Count()).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*BlobLinkQuery) Limit

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) Limit(limit int) *BlobLinkQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) Offset

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) Offset(offset int) *BlobLinkQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) Only

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*BlobLink, error)

Only returns a single BlobLink entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one BlobLink entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no BlobLink entities are found.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) OnlyX

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *BlobLink

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) Order

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *BlobLinkQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) QueryBlob

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) QueryBlob() *BlobQuery

QueryBlob chains the current query on the "blob" edge.

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) QueryLink() *BlobQuery

QueryLink chains the current query on the "link" edge.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) Select

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) Select(fields ...string) *BlobLinkSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

Example:

var v []struct {
	CreatedAt time.Time `json:"created_at,omitempty"`
}

client.BlobLink.Query().
	Select(bloblink.FieldCreatedAt).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*BlobLinkQuery) Unique

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) Unique(unique bool) *BlobLinkQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) Where

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.BlobLink) *BlobLinkQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the BlobLinkQuery builder.

func (*BlobLinkQuery) WithBlob

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) WithBlob(opts ...func(*BlobQuery)) *BlobLinkQuery

WithBlob tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "blob" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

func (blq *BlobLinkQuery) WithLink(opts ...func(*BlobQuery)) *BlobLinkQuery

WithLink tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "link" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

type BlobLinkSelect

type BlobLinkSelect struct {
	*BlobLinkQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobLinkSelect is the builder for selecting fields of BlobLink entities.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) Aggregate

func (bls *BlobLinkSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *BlobLinkSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) Bool

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) BoolX

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) Bools

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) BoolsX

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) Float64

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) Float64X

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) Float64s

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) Float64sX

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) Int

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) IntX

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) Ints

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) IntsX

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) Scan

func (bls *BlobLinkSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) ScanX

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) String

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) StringX

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) Strings

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobLinkSelect) StringsX

func (s *BlobLinkSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type BlobLinkUpdate

type BlobLinkUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobLinkUpdate is the builder for updating BlobLink entities.

func (*BlobLinkUpdate) ClearBlob

func (blu *BlobLinkUpdate) ClearBlob() *BlobLinkUpdate

ClearBlob clears the "blob" edge to the Blob entity.

func (blu *BlobLinkUpdate) ClearLink() *BlobLinkUpdate

ClearLink clears the "link" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobLinkUpdate) Exec

func (blu *BlobLinkUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*BlobLinkUpdate) ExecX

func (blu *BlobLinkUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkUpdate) Mutation

func (blu *BlobLinkUpdate) Mutation() *BlobLinkMutation

Mutation returns the BlobLinkMutation object of the builder.

func (*BlobLinkUpdate) Save

func (blu *BlobLinkUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*BlobLinkUpdate) SaveX

func (blu *BlobLinkUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkUpdate) SetBlob

func (blu *BlobLinkUpdate) SetBlob(b *Blob) *BlobLinkUpdate

SetBlob sets the "blob" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobLinkUpdate) SetBlobID

func (blu *BlobLinkUpdate) SetBlobID(u uuid.UUID) *BlobLinkUpdate

SetBlobID sets the "blob_id" field.

func (*BlobLinkUpdate) SetCreatedAt

func (blu *BlobLinkUpdate) SetCreatedAt(t time.Time) *BlobLinkUpdate

SetCreatedAt sets the "created_at" field.

func (blu *BlobLinkUpdate) SetLink(b *Blob) *BlobLinkUpdate

SetLink sets the "link" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobLinkUpdate) SetLinkID

func (blu *BlobLinkUpdate) SetLinkID(u uuid.UUID) *BlobLinkUpdate

SetLinkID sets the "link_id" field.

func (*BlobLinkUpdate) SetNillableCreatedAt

func (blu *BlobLinkUpdate) SetNillableCreatedAt(t *time.Time) *BlobLinkUpdate

SetNillableCreatedAt sets the "created_at" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*BlobLinkUpdate) Where

func (blu *BlobLinkUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.BlobLink) *BlobLinkUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the BlobLinkUpdate builder.

type BlobLinkUpdateOne

type BlobLinkUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobLinkUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single BlobLink entity.

func (*BlobLinkUpdateOne) ClearBlob

func (bluo *BlobLinkUpdateOne) ClearBlob() *BlobLinkUpdateOne

ClearBlob clears the "blob" edge to the Blob entity.

func (bluo *BlobLinkUpdateOne) ClearLink() *BlobLinkUpdateOne

ClearLink clears the "link" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobLinkUpdateOne) Exec

func (bluo *BlobLinkUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*BlobLinkUpdateOne) ExecX

func (bluo *BlobLinkUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkUpdateOne) Mutation

func (bluo *BlobLinkUpdateOne) Mutation() *BlobLinkMutation

Mutation returns the BlobLinkMutation object of the builder.

func (*BlobLinkUpdateOne) Save

func (bluo *BlobLinkUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*BlobLink, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated BlobLink entity.

func (*BlobLinkUpdateOne) SaveX

func (bluo *BlobLinkUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *BlobLink

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkUpdateOne) Select

func (bluo *BlobLinkUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *BlobLinkUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

func (*BlobLinkUpdateOne) SetBlob

func (bluo *BlobLinkUpdateOne) SetBlob(b *Blob) *BlobLinkUpdateOne

SetBlob sets the "blob" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobLinkUpdateOne) SetBlobID

func (bluo *BlobLinkUpdateOne) SetBlobID(u uuid.UUID) *BlobLinkUpdateOne

SetBlobID sets the "blob_id" field.

func (*BlobLinkUpdateOne) SetCreatedAt

func (bluo *BlobLinkUpdateOne) SetCreatedAt(t time.Time) *BlobLinkUpdateOne

SetCreatedAt sets the "created_at" field.

func (bluo *BlobLinkUpdateOne) SetLink(b *Blob) *BlobLinkUpdateOne

SetLink sets the "link" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobLinkUpdateOne) SetLinkID

func (bluo *BlobLinkUpdateOne) SetLinkID(u uuid.UUID) *BlobLinkUpdateOne

SetLinkID sets the "link_id" field.

func (*BlobLinkUpdateOne) SetNillableCreatedAt

func (bluo *BlobLinkUpdateOne) SetNillableCreatedAt(t *time.Time) *BlobLinkUpdateOne

SetNillableCreatedAt sets the "created_at" field if the given value is not nil.

type BlobLinkUpsert

type BlobLinkUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

BlobLinkUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

func (*BlobLinkUpsert) SetBlobID

func (u *BlobLinkUpsert) SetBlobID(v uuid.UUID) *BlobLinkUpsert

SetBlobID sets the "blob_id" field.

func (*BlobLinkUpsert) SetCreatedAt

func (u *BlobLinkUpsert) SetCreatedAt(v time.Time) *BlobLinkUpsert

SetCreatedAt sets the "created_at" field.

func (*BlobLinkUpsert) SetLinkID

func (u *BlobLinkUpsert) SetLinkID(v uuid.UUID) *BlobLinkUpsert

SetLinkID sets the "link_id" field.

func (*BlobLinkUpsert) UpdateBlobID

func (u *BlobLinkUpsert) UpdateBlobID() *BlobLinkUpsert

UpdateBlobID sets the "blob_id" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*BlobLinkUpsert) UpdateCreatedAt

func (u *BlobLinkUpsert) UpdateCreatedAt() *BlobLinkUpsert

UpdateCreatedAt sets the "created_at" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*BlobLinkUpsert) UpdateLinkID

func (u *BlobLinkUpsert) UpdateLinkID() *BlobLinkUpsert

UpdateLinkID sets the "link_id" field to the value that was provided on create.

type BlobLinkUpsertBulk

type BlobLinkUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobLinkUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of BlobLink nodes.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *BlobLinkUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertBulk) Ignore

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.BlobLink.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*BlobLinkUpsertBulk) SetBlobID

SetBlobID sets the "blob_id" field.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertBulk) SetCreatedAt

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertBulk) SetCreatedAt(v time.Time) *BlobLinkUpsertBulk

SetCreatedAt sets the "created_at" field.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertBulk) SetLinkID

SetLinkID sets the "link_id" field.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*BlobLinkUpsert)) *BlobLinkUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the BlobLinkCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertBulk) UpdateBlobID

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertBulk) UpdateBlobID() *BlobLinkUpsertBulk

UpdateBlobID sets the "blob_id" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertBulk) UpdateCreatedAt

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertBulk) UpdateCreatedAt() *BlobLinkUpsertBulk

UpdateCreatedAt sets the "created_at" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertBulk) UpdateLinkID

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertBulk) UpdateLinkID() *BlobLinkUpsertBulk

UpdateLinkID sets the "link_id" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *BlobLinkUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.BlobLink.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type BlobLinkUpsertOne

type BlobLinkUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobLinkUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one BlobLink node.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertOne) DoNothing() *BlobLinkUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertOne) Ignore() *BlobLinkUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.BlobLink.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*BlobLinkUpsertOne) SetBlobID

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertOne) SetBlobID(v uuid.UUID) *BlobLinkUpsertOne

SetBlobID sets the "blob_id" field.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertOne) SetCreatedAt

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertOne) SetCreatedAt(v time.Time) *BlobLinkUpsertOne

SetCreatedAt sets the "created_at" field.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertOne) SetLinkID

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertOne) SetLinkID(v uuid.UUID) *BlobLinkUpsertOne

SetLinkID sets the "link_id" field.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertOne) Update

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertOne) Update(set func(*BlobLinkUpsert)) *BlobLinkUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the BlobLinkCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertOne) UpdateBlobID

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertOne) UpdateBlobID() *BlobLinkUpsertOne

UpdateBlobID sets the "blob_id" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertOne) UpdateCreatedAt

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertOne) UpdateCreatedAt() *BlobLinkUpsertOne

UpdateCreatedAt sets the "created_at" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertOne) UpdateLinkID

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertOne) UpdateLinkID() *BlobLinkUpsertOne

UpdateLinkID sets the "link_id" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*BlobLinkUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *BlobLinkUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *BlobLinkUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.BlobLink.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)
type BlobLinks []*BlobLink

BlobLinks is a parsable slice of BlobLink.

type BlobMutation

type BlobMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobMutation represents an operation that mutates the Blob nodes in the graph.

func (*BlobMutation) AddCount

func (m *BlobMutation) AddCount(i int)

AddCount adds i to the "count" field.

func (*BlobMutation) AddField

func (m *BlobMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*BlobMutation) AddLinkIDs

func (m *BlobMutation) AddLinkIDs(ids ...uuid.UUID)

AddLinkIDs adds the "links" edge to the Blob entity by ids.

func (*BlobMutation) AddedCount

func (m *BlobMutation) AddedCount() (r int, exists bool)

AddedCount returns the value that was added to the "count" field in this mutation.

func (*BlobMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *BlobMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*BlobMutation) AddedField

func (m *BlobMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*BlobMutation) AddedFields

func (m *BlobMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*BlobMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *BlobMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*BlobMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *BlobMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*BlobMutation) ClearField

func (m *BlobMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (m *BlobMutation) ClearLinks()

ClearLinks clears the "links" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobMutation) ClearParent

func (m *BlobMutation) ClearParent()

ClearParent clears the "parent" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *BlobMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*BlobMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *BlobMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (BlobMutation) Client

func (m BlobMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*BlobMutation) Count

func (m *BlobMutation) Count() (r int, exists bool)

Count returns the value of the "count" field in the mutation.

func (*BlobMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *BlobMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*BlobMutation) Field

func (m *BlobMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*BlobMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *BlobMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*BlobMutation) Fields

func (m *BlobMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*BlobMutation) Filter

func (m *BlobMutation) Filter() *BlobFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the BlobMutation builder.

func (*BlobMutation) ID

func (m *BlobMutation) ID() (id uuid.UUID, exists bool)

ID returns the ID value in the mutation. Note that the ID is only available if it was provided to the builder or after it was returned from the database.

func (*BlobMutation) IDs

func (m *BlobMutation) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]uuid.UUID, error)

IDs queries the database and returns the entity ids that match the mutation's predicate. That means, if the mutation is applied within a transaction with an isolation level such as sql.LevelSerializable, the returned ids match the ids of the rows that will be updated or updated by the mutation.

func (*BlobMutation) LinksCleared

func (m *BlobMutation) LinksCleared() bool

LinksCleared reports if the "links" edge to the Blob entity was cleared.

func (*BlobMutation) LinksIDs

func (m *BlobMutation) LinksIDs() (ids []uuid.UUID)

LinksIDs returns the "links" edge IDs in the mutation.

func (*BlobMutation) OldCount

func (m *BlobMutation) OldCount(ctx context.Context) (v int, err error)

OldCount returns the old "count" field's value of the Blob entity. If the Blob object wasn't provided to the builder, the object is fetched from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the database query fails.

func (*BlobMutation) OldField

func (m *BlobMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*BlobMutation) OldUUID

func (m *BlobMutation) OldUUID(ctx context.Context) (v uuid.UUID, err error)

OldUUID returns the old "uuid" field's value of the Blob entity. If the Blob object wasn't provided to the builder, the object is fetched from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the database query fails.

func (*BlobMutation) Op

func (m *BlobMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*BlobMutation) ParentCleared

func (m *BlobMutation) ParentCleared() bool

ParentCleared reports if the "parent" edge to the Blob entity was cleared.

func (*BlobMutation) ParentID

func (m *BlobMutation) ParentID() (id uuid.UUID, exists bool)

ParentID returns the "parent" edge ID in the mutation.

func (*BlobMutation) ParentIDs

func (m *BlobMutation) ParentIDs() (ids []uuid.UUID)

ParentIDs returns the "parent" edge IDs in the mutation. Note that IDs always returns len(IDs) <= 1 for unique edges, and you should use ParentID instead. It exists only for internal usage by the builders.

func (*BlobMutation) RemoveLinkIDs

func (m *BlobMutation) RemoveLinkIDs(ids ...uuid.UUID)

RemoveLinkIDs removes the "links" edge to the Blob entity by IDs.

func (*BlobMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *BlobMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*BlobMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *BlobMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*BlobMutation) RemovedLinksIDs

func (m *BlobMutation) RemovedLinksIDs() (ids []uuid.UUID)

RemovedLinks returns the removed IDs of the "links" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobMutation) ResetCount

func (m *BlobMutation) ResetCount()

ResetCount resets all changes to the "count" field.

func (*BlobMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *BlobMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*BlobMutation) ResetField

func (m *BlobMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (m *BlobMutation) ResetLinks()

ResetLinks resets all changes to the "links" edge.

func (*BlobMutation) ResetParent

func (m *BlobMutation) ResetParent()

ResetParent resets all changes to the "parent" edge.

func (*BlobMutation) ResetUUID

func (m *BlobMutation) ResetUUID()

ResetUUID resets all changes to the "uuid" field.

func (*BlobMutation) SetCount

func (m *BlobMutation) SetCount(i int)

SetCount sets the "count" field.

func (*BlobMutation) SetField

func (m *BlobMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*BlobMutation) SetID

func (m *BlobMutation) SetID(id uuid.UUID)

SetID sets the value of the id field. Note that this operation is only accepted on creation of Blob entities.

func (*BlobMutation) SetOp

func (m *BlobMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (*BlobMutation) SetParentID

func (m *BlobMutation) SetParentID(id uuid.UUID)

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Blob entity by id.

func (*BlobMutation) SetUUID

func (m *BlobMutation) SetUUID(u uuid.UUID)

SetUUID sets the "uuid" field.

func (BlobMutation) Tx

func (m BlobMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*BlobMutation) Type

func (m *BlobMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (Blob).

func (*BlobMutation) UUID

func (m *BlobMutation) UUID() (r uuid.UUID, exists bool)

UUID returns the value of the "uuid" field in the mutation.

func (*BlobMutation) Where

func (m *BlobMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.Blob)

Where appends a list predicates to the BlobMutation builder.

func (*BlobMutation) WhereP

func (m *BlobMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the BlobMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type BlobQuery

type BlobQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobQuery is the builder for querying Blob entities.

func (*BlobQuery) Aggregate

func (bq *BlobQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *BlobSelect

Aggregate returns a BlobSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*BlobQuery) All

func (bq *BlobQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*Blob, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of Blobs.

func (*BlobQuery) AllX

func (bq *BlobQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*Blob

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobQuery) Clone

func (bq *BlobQuery) Clone() *BlobQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the BlobQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*BlobQuery) Count

func (bq *BlobQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*BlobQuery) CountX

func (bq *BlobQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobQuery) Exist

func (bq *BlobQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*BlobQuery) ExistX

func (bq *BlobQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobQuery) Filter

func (bq *BlobQuery) Filter() *BlobFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the BlobQuery builder.

func (*BlobQuery) First

func (bq *BlobQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*Blob, error)

First returns the first Blob entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Blob was found.

func (*BlobQuery) FirstID

func (bq *BlobQuery) FirstID(ctx context.Context) (id uuid.UUID, err error)

FirstID returns the first Blob ID from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Blob ID was found.

func (*BlobQuery) FirstIDX

func (bq *BlobQuery) FirstIDX(ctx context.Context) uuid.UUID

FirstIDX is like FirstID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobQuery) FirstX

func (bq *BlobQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *Blob

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobQuery) GroupBy

func (bq *BlobQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *BlobGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

Example:

var v []struct {
	UUID uuid.UUID `json:"uuid,omitempty"`
	Count int `json:"count,omitempty"`
}

client.Blob.Query().
	GroupBy(blob.FieldUUID).
	Aggregate(ent.Count()).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*BlobQuery) IDs

func (bq *BlobQuery) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]uuid.UUID, error)

IDs executes the query and returns a list of Blob IDs.

func (*BlobQuery) IDsX

func (bq *BlobQuery) IDsX(ctx context.Context) []uuid.UUID

IDsX is like IDs, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobQuery) Limit

func (bq *BlobQuery) Limit(limit int) *BlobQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*BlobQuery) Offset

func (bq *BlobQuery) Offset(offset int) *BlobQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*BlobQuery) Only

func (bq *BlobQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*Blob, error)

Only returns a single Blob entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Blob entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Blob entities are found.

func (*BlobQuery) OnlyID

func (bq *BlobQuery) OnlyID(ctx context.Context) (id uuid.UUID, err error)

OnlyID is like Only, but returns the only Blob ID in the query. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Blob ID is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no entities are found.

func (*BlobQuery) OnlyIDX

func (bq *BlobQuery) OnlyIDX(ctx context.Context) uuid.UUID

OnlyIDX is like OnlyID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobQuery) OnlyX

func (bq *BlobQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *Blob

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobQuery) Order

func (bq *BlobQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *BlobQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (bq *BlobQuery) QueryBlobLinks() *BlobLinkQuery

QueryBlobLinks chains the current query on the "blob_links" edge.

func (bq *BlobQuery) QueryLinks() *BlobQuery

QueryLinks chains the current query on the "links" edge.

func (*BlobQuery) QueryParent

func (bq *BlobQuery) QueryParent() *BlobQuery

QueryParent chains the current query on the "parent" edge.

func (*BlobQuery) Select

func (bq *BlobQuery) Select(fields ...string) *BlobSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

Example:

var v []struct {
	UUID uuid.UUID `json:"uuid,omitempty"`
}

client.Blob.Query().
	Select(blob.FieldUUID).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*BlobQuery) Unique

func (bq *BlobQuery) Unique(unique bool) *BlobQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*BlobQuery) Where

func (bq *BlobQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.Blob) *BlobQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the BlobQuery builder.

func (bq *BlobQuery) WithBlobLinks(opts ...func(*BlobLinkQuery)) *BlobQuery

WithBlobLinks tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "blob_links" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

func (bq *BlobQuery) WithLinks(opts ...func(*BlobQuery)) *BlobQuery

WithLinks tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "links" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

func (*BlobQuery) WithParent

func (bq *BlobQuery) WithParent(opts ...func(*BlobQuery)) *BlobQuery

WithParent tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "parent" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

type BlobSelect

type BlobSelect struct {
	*BlobQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobSelect is the builder for selecting fields of Blob entities.

func (*BlobSelect) Aggregate

func (bs *BlobSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *BlobSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*BlobSelect) Bool

func (s *BlobSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobSelect) BoolX

func (s *BlobSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobSelect) Bools

func (s *BlobSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobSelect) BoolsX

func (s *BlobSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobSelect) Float64

func (s *BlobSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobSelect) Float64X

func (s *BlobSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobSelect) Float64s

func (s *BlobSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobSelect) Float64sX

func (s *BlobSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobSelect) Int

func (s *BlobSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobSelect) IntX

func (s *BlobSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobSelect) Ints

func (s *BlobSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobSelect) IntsX

func (s *BlobSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobSelect) Scan

func (bs *BlobSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*BlobSelect) ScanX

func (s *BlobSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobSelect) String

func (s *BlobSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobSelect) StringX

func (s *BlobSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobSelect) Strings

func (s *BlobSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*BlobSelect) StringsX

func (s *BlobSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type BlobUpdate

type BlobUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobUpdate is the builder for updating Blob entities.

func (*BlobUpdate) AddCount

func (bu *BlobUpdate) AddCount(i int) *BlobUpdate

AddCount adds i to the "count" field.

func (*BlobUpdate) AddLinkIDs

func (bu *BlobUpdate) AddLinkIDs(ids ...uuid.UUID) *BlobUpdate

AddLinkIDs adds the "links" edge to the Blob entity by IDs.

func (bu *BlobUpdate) AddLinks(b ...*Blob) *BlobUpdate

AddLinks adds the "links" edges to the Blob entity.

func (bu *BlobUpdate) ClearLinks() *BlobUpdate

ClearLinks clears all "links" edges to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobUpdate) ClearParent

func (bu *BlobUpdate) ClearParent() *BlobUpdate

ClearParent clears the "parent" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobUpdate) Exec

func (bu *BlobUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*BlobUpdate) ExecX

func (bu *BlobUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobUpdate) Mutation

func (bu *BlobUpdate) Mutation() *BlobMutation

Mutation returns the BlobMutation object of the builder.

func (*BlobUpdate) RemoveLinkIDs

func (bu *BlobUpdate) RemoveLinkIDs(ids ...uuid.UUID) *BlobUpdate

RemoveLinkIDs removes the "links" edge to Blob entities by IDs.

func (bu *BlobUpdate) RemoveLinks(b ...*Blob) *BlobUpdate

RemoveLinks removes "links" edges to Blob entities.

func (*BlobUpdate) Save

func (bu *BlobUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*BlobUpdate) SaveX

func (bu *BlobUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobUpdate) SetCount

func (bu *BlobUpdate) SetCount(i int) *BlobUpdate

SetCount sets the "count" field.

func (*BlobUpdate) SetNillableCount

func (bu *BlobUpdate) SetNillableCount(i *int) *BlobUpdate

SetNillableCount sets the "count" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*BlobUpdate) SetNillableParentID

func (bu *BlobUpdate) SetNillableParentID(id *uuid.UUID) *BlobUpdate

SetNillableParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Blob entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*BlobUpdate) SetNillableUUID

func (bu *BlobUpdate) SetNillableUUID(u *uuid.UUID) *BlobUpdate

SetNillableUUID sets the "uuid" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*BlobUpdate) SetParent

func (bu *BlobUpdate) SetParent(b *Blob) *BlobUpdate

SetParent sets the "parent" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobUpdate) SetParentID

func (bu *BlobUpdate) SetParentID(id uuid.UUID) *BlobUpdate

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Blob entity by ID.

func (*BlobUpdate) SetUUID

func (bu *BlobUpdate) SetUUID(u uuid.UUID) *BlobUpdate

SetUUID sets the "uuid" field.

func (*BlobUpdate) Where

func (bu *BlobUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.Blob) *BlobUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the BlobUpdate builder.

type BlobUpdateOne

type BlobUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single Blob entity.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) AddCount

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) AddCount(i int) *BlobUpdateOne

AddCount adds i to the "count" field.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) AddLinkIDs

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) AddLinkIDs(ids ...uuid.UUID) *BlobUpdateOne

AddLinkIDs adds the "links" edge to the Blob entity by IDs.

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) AddLinks(b ...*Blob) *BlobUpdateOne

AddLinks adds the "links" edges to the Blob entity.

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) ClearLinks() *BlobUpdateOne

ClearLinks clears all "links" edges to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) ClearParent

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) ClearParent() *BlobUpdateOne

ClearParent clears the "parent" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) Exec

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) ExecX

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) Mutation

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) Mutation() *BlobMutation

Mutation returns the BlobMutation object of the builder.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) RemoveLinkIDs

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) RemoveLinkIDs(ids ...uuid.UUID) *BlobUpdateOne

RemoveLinkIDs removes the "links" edge to Blob entities by IDs.

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) RemoveLinks(b ...*Blob) *BlobUpdateOne

RemoveLinks removes "links" edges to Blob entities.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) Save

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Blob, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated Blob entity.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) SaveX

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Blob

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) Select

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *BlobUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) SetCount

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) SetCount(i int) *BlobUpdateOne

SetCount sets the "count" field.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) SetNillableCount

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) SetNillableCount(i *int) *BlobUpdateOne

SetNillableCount sets the "count" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) SetNillableParentID

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) SetNillableParentID(id *uuid.UUID) *BlobUpdateOne

SetNillableParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Blob entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) SetNillableUUID

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) SetNillableUUID(u *uuid.UUID) *BlobUpdateOne

SetNillableUUID sets the "uuid" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) SetParent

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) SetParent(b *Blob) *BlobUpdateOne

SetParent sets the "parent" edge to the Blob entity.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) SetParentID

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) SetParentID(id uuid.UUID) *BlobUpdateOne

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Blob entity by ID.

func (*BlobUpdateOne) SetUUID

func (buo *BlobUpdateOne) SetUUID(u uuid.UUID) *BlobUpdateOne

SetUUID sets the "uuid" field.

type BlobUpsert

type BlobUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

BlobUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

func (*BlobUpsert) AddCount

func (u *BlobUpsert) AddCount(v int) *BlobUpsert

AddCount adds v to the "count" field.

func (*BlobUpsert) SetCount

func (u *BlobUpsert) SetCount(v int) *BlobUpsert

SetCount sets the "count" field.

func (*BlobUpsert) SetUUID

func (u *BlobUpsert) SetUUID(v uuid.UUID) *BlobUpsert

SetUUID sets the "uuid" field.

func (*BlobUpsert) UpdateCount

func (u *BlobUpsert) UpdateCount() *BlobUpsert

UpdateCount sets the "count" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*BlobUpsert) UpdateUUID

func (u *BlobUpsert) UpdateUUID() *BlobUpsert

UpdateUUID sets the "uuid" field to the value that was provided on create.

type BlobUpsertBulk

type BlobUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of Blob nodes.

func (*BlobUpsertBulk) AddCount

func (u *BlobUpsertBulk) AddCount(v int) *BlobUpsertBulk

AddCount adds v to the "count" field.

func (*BlobUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *BlobUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *BlobUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*BlobUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *BlobUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*BlobUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *BlobUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobUpsertBulk) Ignore

func (u *BlobUpsertBulk) Ignore() *BlobUpsertBulk

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Blob.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*BlobUpsertBulk) SetCount

func (u *BlobUpsertBulk) SetCount(v int) *BlobUpsertBulk

SetCount sets the "count" field.

func (*BlobUpsertBulk) SetUUID

func (u *BlobUpsertBulk) SetUUID(v uuid.UUID) *BlobUpsertBulk

SetUUID sets the "uuid" field.

func (*BlobUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *BlobUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*BlobUpsert)) *BlobUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the BlobCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*BlobUpsertBulk) UpdateCount

func (u *BlobUpsertBulk) UpdateCount() *BlobUpsertBulk

UpdateCount sets the "count" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*BlobUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *BlobUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *BlobUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Blob.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(blob.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*BlobUpsertBulk) UpdateUUID

func (u *BlobUpsertBulk) UpdateUUID() *BlobUpsertBulk

UpdateUUID sets the "uuid" field to the value that was provided on create.

type BlobUpsertOne

type BlobUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

BlobUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one Blob node.

func (*BlobUpsertOne) AddCount

func (u *BlobUpsertOne) AddCount(v int) *BlobUpsertOne

AddCount adds v to the "count" field.

func (*BlobUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *BlobUpsertOne) DoNothing() *BlobUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*BlobUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *BlobUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*BlobUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *BlobUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobUpsertOne) ID

func (u *BlobUpsertOne) ID(ctx context.Context) (id uuid.UUID, err error)

Exec executes the UPSERT query and returns the inserted/updated ID.

func (*BlobUpsertOne) IDX

func (u *BlobUpsertOne) IDX(ctx context.Context) uuid.UUID

IDX is like ID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*BlobUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *BlobUpsertOne) Ignore() *BlobUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Blob.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*BlobUpsertOne) SetCount

func (u *BlobUpsertOne) SetCount(v int) *BlobUpsertOne

SetCount sets the "count" field.

func (*BlobUpsertOne) SetUUID

func (u *BlobUpsertOne) SetUUID(v uuid.UUID) *BlobUpsertOne

SetUUID sets the "uuid" field.

func (*BlobUpsertOne) Update

func (u *BlobUpsertOne) Update(set func(*BlobUpsert)) *BlobUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the BlobCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*BlobUpsertOne) UpdateCount

func (u *BlobUpsertOne) UpdateCount() *BlobUpsertOne

UpdateCount sets the "count" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*BlobUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *BlobUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *BlobUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create except the ID field. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Blob.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(blob.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*BlobUpsertOne) UpdateUUID

func (u *BlobUpsertOne) UpdateUUID() *BlobUpsertOne

UpdateUUID sets the "uuid" field to the value that was provided on create.

type Blobs

type Blobs []*Blob

Blobs is a parsable slice of Blob.

type Car

type Car struct {

	// ID of the ent.
	ID int `json:"id,omitempty"`
	// BeforeID holds the value of the "before_id" field.
	BeforeID float64 `json:"before_id,omitempty"`
	// AfterID holds the value of the "after_id" field.
	AfterID float64 `json:"after_id,omitempty"`
	// Model holds the value of the "model" field.
	Model string `json:"model,omitempty"`
	// Edges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.
	// The values are being populated by the CarQuery when eager-loading is set.
	Edges CarEdges `json:"edges"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Car is the model entity for the Car schema.

func (*Car) QueryOwner

func (c *Car) QueryOwner() *PetQuery

QueryOwner queries the "owner" edge of the Car entity.

func (*Car) String

func (c *Car) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*Car) Unwrap

func (c *Car) Unwrap() *Car

Unwrap unwraps the Car entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*Car) Update

func (c *Car) Update() *CarUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this Car. Note that you need to call Car.Unwrap() before calling this method if this Car was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type CarClient

type CarClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

CarClient is a client for the Car schema.

func NewCarClient

func NewCarClient(c config) *CarClient

NewCarClient returns a client for the Car from the given config.

func (*CarClient) Create

func (c *CarClient) Create() *CarCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a Car entity.

func (*CarClient) CreateBulk

func (c *CarClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*CarCreate) *CarCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of Car entities.

func (*CarClient) Delete

func (c *CarClient) Delete() *CarDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for Car.

func (*CarClient) DeleteOne

func (c *CarClient) DeleteOne(ca *Car) *CarDeleteOne

DeleteOne returns a builder for deleting the given entity.

func (*CarClient) DeleteOneID

func (c *CarClient) DeleteOneID(id int) *CarDeleteOne

DeleteOneID returns a builder for deleting the given entity by its id.

func (*CarClient) Get

func (c *CarClient) Get(ctx context.Context, id int) (*Car, error)

Get returns a Car entity by its id.

func (*CarClient) GetX

func (c *CarClient) GetX(ctx context.Context, id int) *Car

GetX is like Get, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarClient) Hooks

func (c *CarClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*CarClient) Intercept

func (c *CarClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `car.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*CarClient) Interceptors

func (c *CarClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*CarClient) Query

func (c *CarClient) Query() *CarQuery

Query returns a query builder for Car.

func (*CarClient) QueryOwner

func (c *CarClient) QueryOwner(ca *Car) *PetQuery

QueryOwner queries the owner edge of a Car.

func (*CarClient) Update

func (c *CarClient) Update() *CarUpdate

Update returns an update builder for Car.

func (*CarClient) UpdateOne

func (c *CarClient) UpdateOne(ca *Car) *CarUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*CarClient) UpdateOneID

func (c *CarClient) UpdateOneID(id int) *CarUpdateOne

UpdateOneID returns an update builder for the given id.

func (*CarClient) Use

func (c *CarClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `car.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type CarCreate

type CarCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

CarCreate is the builder for creating a Car entity.

func (*CarCreate) Exec

func (cc *CarCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*CarCreate) ExecX

func (cc *CarCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarCreate) Mutation

func (cc *CarCreate) Mutation() *CarMutation

Mutation returns the CarMutation object of the builder.

func (*CarCreate) OnConflict

func (cc *CarCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *CarUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Car.Create().
	SetBeforeID(v).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.CarUpsert) {
		SetBeforeID(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*CarCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (cc *CarCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *CarUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Car.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*CarCreate) Save

func (cc *CarCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Car, error)

Save creates the Car in the database.

func (*CarCreate) SaveX

func (cc *CarCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Car

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*CarCreate) SetAfterID

func (cc *CarCreate) SetAfterID(f float64) *CarCreate

SetAfterID sets the "after_id" field.

func (*CarCreate) SetBeforeID

func (cc *CarCreate) SetBeforeID(f float64) *CarCreate

SetBeforeID sets the "before_id" field.

func (*CarCreate) SetID

func (cc *CarCreate) SetID(i int) *CarCreate

SetID sets the "id" field.

func (*CarCreate) SetModel

func (cc *CarCreate) SetModel(s string) *CarCreate

SetModel sets the "model" field.

func (*CarCreate) SetNillableAfterID

func (cc *CarCreate) SetNillableAfterID(f *float64) *CarCreate

SetNillableAfterID sets the "after_id" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*CarCreate) SetNillableBeforeID

func (cc *CarCreate) SetNillableBeforeID(f *float64) *CarCreate

SetNillableBeforeID sets the "before_id" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*CarCreate) SetNillableOwnerID

func (cc *CarCreate) SetNillableOwnerID(id *string) *CarCreate

SetNillableOwnerID sets the "owner" edge to the Pet entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*CarCreate) SetOwner

func (cc *CarCreate) SetOwner(p *Pet) *CarCreate

SetOwner sets the "owner" edge to the Pet entity.

func (*CarCreate) SetOwnerID

func (cc *CarCreate) SetOwnerID(id string) *CarCreate

SetOwnerID sets the "owner" edge to the Pet entity by ID.

type CarCreateBulk

type CarCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

CarCreateBulk is the builder for creating many Car entities in bulk.

func (*CarCreateBulk) Exec

func (ccb *CarCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*CarCreateBulk) ExecX

func (ccb *CarCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (ccb *CarCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *CarUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Car.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.CarUpsert) {
		SetBeforeID(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*CarCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (ccb *CarCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *CarUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Car.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*CarCreateBulk) Save

func (ccb *CarCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*Car, error)

Save creates the Car entities in the database.

func (*CarCreateBulk) SaveX

func (ccb *CarCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*Car

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type CarDelete

type CarDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

CarDelete is the builder for deleting a Car entity.

func (*CarDelete) Exec

func (cd *CarDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*CarDelete) ExecX

func (cd *CarDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarDelete) Where

func (cd *CarDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.Car) *CarDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the CarDelete builder.

type CarDeleteOne

type CarDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

CarDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single Car entity.

func (*CarDeleteOne) Exec

func (cdo *CarDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*CarDeleteOne) ExecX

func (cdo *CarDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type CarEdges

type CarEdges struct {
	// Owner holds the value of the owner edge.
	Owner *Pet `json:"owner,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

CarEdges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.

func (CarEdges) OwnerOrErr

func (e CarEdges) OwnerOrErr() (*Pet, error)

OwnerOrErr returns the Owner value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading, or loaded but was not found.

type CarFilter

type CarFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

CarFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for CarQuery.

func (*CarFilter) Where

func (f *CarFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*CarFilter) WhereAfterID

func (f *CarFilter) WhereAfterID(p entql.Float64P)

WhereAfterID applies the entql float64 predicate on the after_id field.

func (*CarFilter) WhereBeforeID

func (f *CarFilter) WhereBeforeID(p entql.Float64P)

WhereBeforeID applies the entql float64 predicate on the before_id field.

func (*CarFilter) WhereHasOwner

func (f *CarFilter) WhereHasOwner()

WhereHasOwner applies a predicate to check if query has an edge owner.

func (*CarFilter) WhereHasOwnerWith

func (f *CarFilter) WhereHasOwnerWith(preds ...predicate.Pet)

WhereHasOwnerWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge owner with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*CarFilter) WhereID

func (f *CarFilter) WhereID(p entql.IntP)

WhereID applies the entql int predicate on the id field.

func (*CarFilter) WhereModel

func (f *CarFilter) WhereModel(p entql.StringP)

WhereModel applies the entql string predicate on the model field.

type CarGroupBy

type CarGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

CarGroupBy is the group-by builder for Car entities.

func (*CarGroupBy) Aggregate

func (cgb *CarGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *CarGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*CarGroupBy) Bool

func (s *CarGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*CarGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *CarGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarGroupBy) Bools

func (s *CarGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*CarGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *CarGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarGroupBy) Float64

func (s *CarGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*CarGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *CarGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *CarGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*CarGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *CarGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarGroupBy) Int

func (s *CarGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*CarGroupBy) IntX

func (s *CarGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarGroupBy) Ints

func (s *CarGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*CarGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *CarGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarGroupBy) Scan

func (cgb *CarGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*CarGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *CarGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarGroupBy) String

func (s *CarGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*CarGroupBy) StringX

func (s *CarGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarGroupBy) Strings

func (s *CarGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*CarGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *CarGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type CarMutation

type CarMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

CarMutation represents an operation that mutates the Car nodes in the graph.

func (*CarMutation) AddAfterID

func (m *CarMutation) AddAfterID(f float64)

AddAfterID adds f to the "after_id" field.

func (*CarMutation) AddBeforeID

func (m *CarMutation) AddBeforeID(f float64)

AddBeforeID adds f to the "before_id" field.

func (*CarMutation) AddField

func (m *CarMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*CarMutation) AddedAfterID

func (m *CarMutation) AddedAfterID() (r float64, exists bool)

AddedAfterID returns the value that was added to the "after_id" field in this mutation.

func (*CarMutation) AddedBeforeID

func (m *CarMutation) AddedBeforeID() (r float64, exists bool)

AddedBeforeID returns the value that was added to the "before_id" field in this mutation.

func (*CarMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *CarMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*CarMutation) AddedField

func (m *CarMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*CarMutation) AddedFields

func (m *CarMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*CarMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *CarMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*CarMutation) AfterID

func (m *CarMutation) AfterID() (r float64, exists bool)

AfterID returns the value of the "after_id" field in the mutation.

func (*CarMutation) AfterIDCleared

func (m *CarMutation) AfterIDCleared() bool

AfterIDCleared returns if the "after_id" field was cleared in this mutation.

func (*CarMutation) BeforeID

func (m *CarMutation) BeforeID() (r float64, exists bool)

BeforeID returns the value of the "before_id" field in the mutation.

func (*CarMutation) BeforeIDCleared

func (m *CarMutation) BeforeIDCleared() bool

BeforeIDCleared returns if the "before_id" field was cleared in this mutation.

func (*CarMutation) ClearAfterID

func (m *CarMutation) ClearAfterID()

ClearAfterID clears the value of the "after_id" field.

func (*CarMutation) ClearBeforeID

func (m *CarMutation) ClearBeforeID()

ClearBeforeID clears the value of the "before_id" field.

func (*CarMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *CarMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*CarMutation) ClearField

func (m *CarMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*CarMutation) ClearOwner

func (m *CarMutation) ClearOwner()

ClearOwner clears the "owner" edge to the Pet entity.

func (*CarMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *CarMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*CarMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *CarMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (CarMutation) Client

func (m CarMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*CarMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *CarMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*CarMutation) Field

func (m *CarMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*CarMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *CarMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*CarMutation) Fields

func (m *CarMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*CarMutation) Filter

func (m *CarMutation) Filter() *CarFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the CarMutation builder.

func (*CarMutation) ID

func (m *CarMutation) ID() (id int, exists bool)

ID returns the ID value in the mutation. Note that the ID is only available if it was provided to the builder or after it was returned from the database.

func (*CarMutation) IDs

func (m *CarMutation) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

IDs queries the database and returns the entity ids that match the mutation's predicate. That means, if the mutation is applied within a transaction with an isolation level such as sql.LevelSerializable, the returned ids match the ids of the rows that will be updated or updated by the mutation.

func (*CarMutation) Model

func (m *CarMutation) Model() (r string, exists bool)

Model returns the value of the "model" field in the mutation.

func (*CarMutation) OldAfterID

func (m *CarMutation) OldAfterID(ctx context.Context) (v float64, err error)

OldAfterID returns the old "after_id" field's value of the Car entity. If the Car object wasn't provided to the builder, the object is fetched from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the database query fails.

func (*CarMutation) OldBeforeID

func (m *CarMutation) OldBeforeID(ctx context.Context) (v float64, err error)

OldBeforeID returns the old "before_id" field's value of the Car entity. If the Car object wasn't provided to the builder, the object is fetched from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the database query fails.

func (*CarMutation) OldField

func (m *CarMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*CarMutation) OldModel

func (m *CarMutation) OldModel(ctx context.Context) (v string, err error)

OldModel returns the old "model" field's value of the Car entity. If the Car object wasn't provided to the builder, the object is fetched from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the database query fails.

func (*CarMutation) Op

func (m *CarMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*CarMutation) OwnerCleared

func (m *CarMutation) OwnerCleared() bool

OwnerCleared reports if the "owner" edge to the Pet entity was cleared.

func (*CarMutation) OwnerID

func (m *CarMutation) OwnerID() (id string, exists bool)

OwnerID returns the "owner" edge ID in the mutation.

func (*CarMutation) OwnerIDs

func (m *CarMutation) OwnerIDs() (ids []string)

OwnerIDs returns the "owner" edge IDs in the mutation. Note that IDs always returns len(IDs) <= 1 for unique edges, and you should use OwnerID instead. It exists only for internal usage by the builders.

func (*CarMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *CarMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*CarMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *CarMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*CarMutation) ResetAfterID

func (m *CarMutation) ResetAfterID()

ResetAfterID resets all changes to the "after_id" field.

func (*CarMutation) ResetBeforeID

func (m *CarMutation) ResetBeforeID()

ResetBeforeID resets all changes to the "before_id" field.

func (*CarMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *CarMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*CarMutation) ResetField

func (m *CarMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*CarMutation) ResetModel

func (m *CarMutation) ResetModel()

ResetModel resets all changes to the "model" field.

func (*CarMutation) ResetOwner

func (m *CarMutation) ResetOwner()

ResetOwner resets all changes to the "owner" edge.

func (*CarMutation) SetAfterID

func (m *CarMutation) SetAfterID(f float64)

SetAfterID sets the "after_id" field.

func (*CarMutation) SetBeforeID

func (m *CarMutation) SetBeforeID(f float64)

SetBeforeID sets the "before_id" field.

func (*CarMutation) SetField

func (m *CarMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*CarMutation) SetID

func (m *CarMutation) SetID(id int)

SetID sets the value of the id field. Note that this operation is only accepted on creation of Car entities.

func (*CarMutation) SetModel

func (m *CarMutation) SetModel(s string)

SetModel sets the "model" field.

func (*CarMutation) SetOp

func (m *CarMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (*CarMutation) SetOwnerID

func (m *CarMutation) SetOwnerID(id string)

SetOwnerID sets the "owner" edge to the Pet entity by id.

func (CarMutation) Tx

func (m CarMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*CarMutation) Type

func (m *CarMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (Car).

func (*CarMutation) Where

func (m *CarMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.Car)

Where appends a list predicates to the CarMutation builder.

func (*CarMutation) WhereP

func (m *CarMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the CarMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type CarQuery

type CarQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

CarQuery is the builder for querying Car entities.

func (*CarQuery) Aggregate

func (cq *CarQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *CarSelect

Aggregate returns a CarSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*CarQuery) All

func (cq *CarQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*Car, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of Cars.

func (*CarQuery) AllX

func (cq *CarQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*Car

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarQuery) Clone

func (cq *CarQuery) Clone() *CarQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the CarQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*CarQuery) Count

func (cq *CarQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*CarQuery) CountX

func (cq *CarQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarQuery) Exist

func (cq *CarQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*CarQuery) ExistX

func (cq *CarQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarQuery) Filter

func (cq *CarQuery) Filter() *CarFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the CarQuery builder.

func (*CarQuery) First

func (cq *CarQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*Car, error)

First returns the first Car entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Car was found.

func (*CarQuery) FirstID

func (cq *CarQuery) FirstID(ctx context.Context) (id int, err error)

FirstID returns the first Car ID from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Car ID was found.

func (*CarQuery) FirstIDX

func (cq *CarQuery) FirstIDX(ctx context.Context) int

FirstIDX is like FirstID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarQuery) FirstX

func (cq *CarQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *Car

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarQuery) GroupBy

func (cq *CarQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *CarGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

Example:

var v []struct {
	BeforeID float64 `json:"before_id,omitempty"`
	Count int `json:"count,omitempty"`
}

client.Car.Query().
	GroupBy(car.FieldBeforeID).
	Aggregate(ent.Count()).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*CarQuery) IDs

func (cq *CarQuery) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

IDs executes the query and returns a list of Car IDs.

func (*CarQuery) IDsX

func (cq *CarQuery) IDsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IDsX is like IDs, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarQuery) Limit

func (cq *CarQuery) Limit(limit int) *CarQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*CarQuery) Offset

func (cq *CarQuery) Offset(offset int) *CarQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*CarQuery) Only

func (cq *CarQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*Car, error)

Only returns a single Car entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Car entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Car entities are found.

func (*CarQuery) OnlyID

func (cq *CarQuery) OnlyID(ctx context.Context) (id int, err error)

OnlyID is like Only, but returns the only Car ID in the query. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Car ID is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no entities are found.

func (*CarQuery) OnlyIDX

func (cq *CarQuery) OnlyIDX(ctx context.Context) int

OnlyIDX is like OnlyID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarQuery) OnlyX

func (cq *CarQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *Car

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarQuery) Order

func (cq *CarQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *CarQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (*CarQuery) QueryOwner

func (cq *CarQuery) QueryOwner() *PetQuery

QueryOwner chains the current query on the "owner" edge.

func (*CarQuery) Select

func (cq *CarQuery) Select(fields ...string) *CarSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

Example:

var v []struct {
	BeforeID float64 `json:"before_id,omitempty"`
}

client.Car.Query().
	Select(car.FieldBeforeID).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*CarQuery) Unique

func (cq *CarQuery) Unique(unique bool) *CarQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*CarQuery) Where

func (cq *CarQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.Car) *CarQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the CarQuery builder.

func (*CarQuery) WithOwner

func (cq *CarQuery) WithOwner(opts ...func(*PetQuery)) *CarQuery

WithOwner tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "owner" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

type CarSelect

type CarSelect struct {
	*CarQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

CarSelect is the builder for selecting fields of Car entities.

func (*CarSelect) Aggregate

func (cs *CarSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *CarSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*CarSelect) Bool

func (s *CarSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*CarSelect) BoolX

func (s *CarSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarSelect) Bools

func (s *CarSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*CarSelect) BoolsX

func (s *CarSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarSelect) Float64

func (s *CarSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*CarSelect) Float64X

func (s *CarSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarSelect) Float64s

func (s *CarSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*CarSelect) Float64sX

func (s *CarSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarSelect) Int

func (s *CarSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*CarSelect) IntX

func (s *CarSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarSelect) Ints

func (s *CarSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*CarSelect) IntsX

func (s *CarSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarSelect) Scan

func (cs *CarSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*CarSelect) ScanX

func (s *CarSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarSelect) String

func (s *CarSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*CarSelect) StringX

func (s *CarSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarSelect) Strings

func (s *CarSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*CarSelect) StringsX

func (s *CarSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type CarUpdate

type CarUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

CarUpdate is the builder for updating Car entities.

func (*CarUpdate) AddAfterID

func (cu *CarUpdate) AddAfterID(f float64) *CarUpdate

AddAfterID adds f to the "after_id" field.

func (*CarUpdate) AddBeforeID

func (cu *CarUpdate) AddBeforeID(f float64) *CarUpdate

AddBeforeID adds f to the "before_id" field.

func (*CarUpdate) ClearAfterID

func (cu *CarUpdate) ClearAfterID() *CarUpdate

ClearAfterID clears the value of the "after_id" field.

func (*CarUpdate) ClearBeforeID

func (cu *CarUpdate) ClearBeforeID() *CarUpdate

ClearBeforeID clears the value of the "before_id" field.

func (*CarUpdate) ClearOwner

func (cu *CarUpdate) ClearOwner() *CarUpdate

ClearOwner clears the "owner" edge to the Pet entity.

func (*CarUpdate) Exec

func (cu *CarUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*CarUpdate) ExecX

func (cu *CarUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarUpdate) Mutation

func (cu *CarUpdate) Mutation() *CarMutation

Mutation returns the CarMutation object of the builder.

func (*CarUpdate) Save

func (cu *CarUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*CarUpdate) SaveX

func (cu *CarUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarUpdate) SetAfterID

func (cu *CarUpdate) SetAfterID(f float64) *CarUpdate

SetAfterID sets the "after_id" field.

func (*CarUpdate) SetBeforeID

func (cu *CarUpdate) SetBeforeID(f float64) *CarUpdate

SetBeforeID sets the "before_id" field.

func (*CarUpdate) SetModel

func (cu *CarUpdate) SetModel(s string) *CarUpdate

SetModel sets the "model" field.

func (*CarUpdate) SetNillableAfterID

func (cu *CarUpdate) SetNillableAfterID(f *float64) *CarUpdate

SetNillableAfterID sets the "after_id" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*CarUpdate) SetNillableBeforeID

func (cu *CarUpdate) SetNillableBeforeID(f *float64) *CarUpdate

SetNillableBeforeID sets the "before_id" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*CarUpdate) SetNillableOwnerID

func (cu *CarUpdate) SetNillableOwnerID(id *string) *CarUpdate

SetNillableOwnerID sets the "owner" edge to the Pet entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*CarUpdate) SetOwner

func (cu *CarUpdate) SetOwner(p *Pet) *CarUpdate

SetOwner sets the "owner" edge to the Pet entity.

func (*CarUpdate) SetOwnerID

func (cu *CarUpdate) SetOwnerID(id string) *CarUpdate

SetOwnerID sets the "owner" edge to the Pet entity by ID.

func (*CarUpdate) Where

func (cu *CarUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.Car) *CarUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the CarUpdate builder.

type CarUpdateOne

type CarUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

CarUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single Car entity.

func (*CarUpdateOne) AddAfterID

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) AddAfterID(f float64) *CarUpdateOne

AddAfterID adds f to the "after_id" field.

func (*CarUpdateOne) AddBeforeID

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) AddBeforeID(f float64) *CarUpdateOne

AddBeforeID adds f to the "before_id" field.

func (*CarUpdateOne) ClearAfterID

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) ClearAfterID() *CarUpdateOne

ClearAfterID clears the value of the "after_id" field.

func (*CarUpdateOne) ClearBeforeID

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) ClearBeforeID() *CarUpdateOne

ClearBeforeID clears the value of the "before_id" field.

func (*CarUpdateOne) ClearOwner

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) ClearOwner() *CarUpdateOne

ClearOwner clears the "owner" edge to the Pet entity.

func (*CarUpdateOne) Exec

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*CarUpdateOne) ExecX

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarUpdateOne) Mutation

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) Mutation() *CarMutation

Mutation returns the CarMutation object of the builder.

func (*CarUpdateOne) Save

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Car, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated Car entity.

func (*CarUpdateOne) SaveX

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Car

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarUpdateOne) Select

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *CarUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

func (*CarUpdateOne) SetAfterID

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) SetAfterID(f float64) *CarUpdateOne

SetAfterID sets the "after_id" field.

func (*CarUpdateOne) SetBeforeID

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) SetBeforeID(f float64) *CarUpdateOne

SetBeforeID sets the "before_id" field.

func (*CarUpdateOne) SetModel

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) SetModel(s string) *CarUpdateOne

SetModel sets the "model" field.

func (*CarUpdateOne) SetNillableAfterID

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) SetNillableAfterID(f *float64) *CarUpdateOne

SetNillableAfterID sets the "after_id" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*CarUpdateOne) SetNillableBeforeID

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) SetNillableBeforeID(f *float64) *CarUpdateOne

SetNillableBeforeID sets the "before_id" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*CarUpdateOne) SetNillableOwnerID

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) SetNillableOwnerID(id *string) *CarUpdateOne

SetNillableOwnerID sets the "owner" edge to the Pet entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*CarUpdateOne) SetOwner

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) SetOwner(p *Pet) *CarUpdateOne

SetOwner sets the "owner" edge to the Pet entity.

func (*CarUpdateOne) SetOwnerID

func (cuo *CarUpdateOne) SetOwnerID(id string) *CarUpdateOne

SetOwnerID sets the "owner" edge to the Pet entity by ID.

type CarUpsert

type CarUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

CarUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

func (*CarUpsert) AddAfterID

func (u *CarUpsert) AddAfterID(v float64) *CarUpsert

AddAfterID adds v to the "after_id" field.

func (*CarUpsert) AddBeforeID

func (u *CarUpsert) AddBeforeID(v float64) *CarUpsert

AddBeforeID adds v to the "before_id" field.

func (*CarUpsert) ClearAfterID

func (u *CarUpsert) ClearAfterID() *CarUpsert

ClearAfterID clears the value of the "after_id" field.

func (*CarUpsert) ClearBeforeID

func (u *CarUpsert) ClearBeforeID() *CarUpsert

ClearBeforeID clears the value of the "before_id" field.

func (*CarUpsert) SetAfterID

func (u *CarUpsert) SetAfterID(v float64) *CarUpsert

SetAfterID sets the "after_id" field.

func (*CarUpsert) SetBeforeID

func (u *CarUpsert) SetBeforeID(v float64) *CarUpsert

SetBeforeID sets the "before_id" field.

func (*CarUpsert) SetModel

func (u *CarUpsert) SetModel(v string) *CarUpsert

SetModel sets the "model" field.

func (*CarUpsert) UpdateAfterID

func (u *CarUpsert) UpdateAfterID() *CarUpsert

UpdateAfterID sets the "after_id" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*CarUpsert) UpdateBeforeID

func (u *CarUpsert) UpdateBeforeID() *CarUpsert

UpdateBeforeID sets the "before_id" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*CarUpsert) UpdateModel

func (u *CarUpsert) UpdateModel() *CarUpsert

UpdateModel sets the "model" field to the value that was provided on create.

type CarUpsertBulk

type CarUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

CarUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of Car nodes.

func (*CarUpsertBulk) AddAfterID

func (u *CarUpsertBulk) AddAfterID(v float64) *CarUpsertBulk

AddAfterID adds v to the "after_id" field.

func (*CarUpsertBulk) AddBeforeID

func (u *CarUpsertBulk) AddBeforeID(v float64) *CarUpsertBulk

AddBeforeID adds v to the "before_id" field.

func (*CarUpsertBulk) ClearAfterID

func (u *CarUpsertBulk) ClearAfterID() *CarUpsertBulk

ClearAfterID clears the value of the "after_id" field.

func (*CarUpsertBulk) ClearBeforeID

func (u *CarUpsertBulk) ClearBeforeID() *CarUpsertBulk

ClearBeforeID clears the value of the "before_id" field.

func (*CarUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *CarUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *CarUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*CarUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *CarUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*CarUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *CarUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarUpsertBulk) Ignore

func (u *CarUpsertBulk) Ignore() *CarUpsertBulk

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Car.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*CarUpsertBulk) SetAfterID

func (u *CarUpsertBulk) SetAfterID(v float64) *CarUpsertBulk

SetAfterID sets the "after_id" field.

func (*CarUpsertBulk) SetBeforeID

func (u *CarUpsertBulk) SetBeforeID(v float64) *CarUpsertBulk

SetBeforeID sets the "before_id" field.

func (*CarUpsertBulk) SetModel

func (u *CarUpsertBulk) SetModel(v string) *CarUpsertBulk

SetModel sets the "model" field.

func (*CarUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *CarUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*CarUpsert)) *CarUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the CarCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*CarUpsertBulk) UpdateAfterID

func (u *CarUpsertBulk) UpdateAfterID() *CarUpsertBulk

UpdateAfterID sets the "after_id" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*CarUpsertBulk) UpdateBeforeID

func (u *CarUpsertBulk) UpdateBeforeID() *CarUpsertBulk

UpdateBeforeID sets the "before_id" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*CarUpsertBulk) UpdateModel

func (u *CarUpsertBulk) UpdateModel() *CarUpsertBulk

UpdateModel sets the "model" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*CarUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *CarUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *CarUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Car.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(car.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type CarUpsertOne

type CarUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

CarUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one Car node.

func (*CarUpsertOne) AddAfterID

func (u *CarUpsertOne) AddAfterID(v float64) *CarUpsertOne

AddAfterID adds v to the "after_id" field.

func (*CarUpsertOne) AddBeforeID

func (u *CarUpsertOne) AddBeforeID(v float64) *CarUpsertOne

AddBeforeID adds v to the "before_id" field.

func (*CarUpsertOne) ClearAfterID

func (u *CarUpsertOne) ClearAfterID() *CarUpsertOne

ClearAfterID clears the value of the "after_id" field.

func (*CarUpsertOne) ClearBeforeID

func (u *CarUpsertOne) ClearBeforeID() *CarUpsertOne

ClearBeforeID clears the value of the "before_id" field.

func (*CarUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *CarUpsertOne) DoNothing() *CarUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*CarUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *CarUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*CarUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *CarUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarUpsertOne) ID

func (u *CarUpsertOne) ID(ctx context.Context) (id int, err error)

Exec executes the UPSERT query and returns the inserted/updated ID.

func (*CarUpsertOne) IDX

func (u *CarUpsertOne) IDX(ctx context.Context) int

IDX is like ID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*CarUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *CarUpsertOne) Ignore() *CarUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Car.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*CarUpsertOne) SetAfterID

func (u *CarUpsertOne) SetAfterID(v float64) *CarUpsertOne

SetAfterID sets the "after_id" field.

func (*CarUpsertOne) SetBeforeID

func (u *CarUpsertOne) SetBeforeID(v float64) *CarUpsertOne

SetBeforeID sets the "before_id" field.

func (*CarUpsertOne) SetModel

func (u *CarUpsertOne) SetModel(v string) *CarUpsertOne

SetModel sets the "model" field.

func (*CarUpsertOne) Update

func (u *CarUpsertOne) Update(set func(*CarUpsert)) *CarUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the CarCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*CarUpsertOne) UpdateAfterID

func (u *CarUpsertOne) UpdateAfterID() *CarUpsertOne

UpdateAfterID sets the "after_id" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*CarUpsertOne) UpdateBeforeID

func (u *CarUpsertOne) UpdateBeforeID() *CarUpsertOne

UpdateBeforeID sets the "before_id" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*CarUpsertOne) UpdateModel

func (u *CarUpsertOne) UpdateModel() *CarUpsertOne

UpdateModel sets the "model" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*CarUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *CarUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *CarUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create except the ID field. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Car.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(car.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type Cars

type Cars []*Car

Cars is a parsable slice of Car.

type Client

type Client struct {

	// Schema is the client for creating, migrating and dropping schema.
	Schema *migrate.Schema
	// Account is the client for interacting with the Account builders.
	Account *AccountClient
	// Blob is the client for interacting with the Blob builders.
	Blob *BlobClient
	// BlobLink is the client for interacting with the BlobLink builders.
	BlobLink *BlobLinkClient
	// Car is the client for interacting with the Car builders.
	Car *CarClient
	// Device is the client for interacting with the Device builders.
	Device *DeviceClient
	// Doc is the client for interacting with the Doc builders.
	Doc *DocClient
	// Group is the client for interacting with the Group builders.
	Group *GroupClient
	// IntSID is the client for interacting with the IntSID builders.
	IntSID *IntSIDClient
	// Link is the client for interacting with the Link builders.
	Link *LinkClient
	// MixinID is the client for interacting with the MixinID builders.
	MixinID *MixinIDClient
	// Note is the client for interacting with the Note builders.
	Note *NoteClient
	// Other is the client for interacting with the Other builders.
	Other *OtherClient
	// Pet is the client for interacting with the Pet builders.
	Pet *PetClient
	// Revision is the client for interacting with the Revision builders.
	Revision *RevisionClient
	// Session is the client for interacting with the Session builders.
	Session *SessionClient
	// Token is the client for interacting with the Token builders.
	Token *TokenClient
	// User is the client for interacting with the User builders.
	User *UserClient
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Client is the client that holds all ent builders.

func FromContext

func FromContext(ctx context.Context) *Client

FromContext returns a Client stored inside a context, or nil if there isn't one.

func NewClient

func NewClient(opts ...Option) *Client

NewClient creates a new client configured with the given options.

func Open

func Open(driverName, dataSourceName string, options ...Option) (*Client, error)

Open opens a database/sql.DB specified by the driver name and the data source name, and returns a new client attached to it. Optional parameters can be added for configuring the client.

func (*Client) BeginTx

func (c *Client) BeginTx(ctx context.Context, opts *sql.TxOptions) (*Tx, error)

BeginTx returns a transactional client with specified options.

func (*Client) Close

func (c *Client) Close() error

Close closes the database connection and prevents new queries from starting.

func (*Client) Debug

func (c *Client) Debug() *Client

Debug returns a new debug-client. It's used to get verbose logging on specific operations.

client.Debug().
	Account.
	Query().
	Count(ctx)

func (*Client) Intercept

func (c *Client) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Intercept adds the query interceptors to all the entity clients. In order to add interceptors to a specific client, call: `client.Node.Intercept(...)`.

func (*Client) Mutate

func (c *Client) Mutate(ctx context.Context, m Mutation) (Value, error)

Mutate implements the ent.Mutator interface.

func (*Client) Tx

func (c *Client) Tx(ctx context.Context) (*Tx, error)

Tx returns a new transactional client. The provided context is used until the transaction is committed or rolled back.

func (*Client) Use

func (c *Client) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds the mutation hooks to all the entity clients. In order to add hooks to a specific client, call: `client.Node.Use(...)`.

type CommitFunc

type CommitFunc func(context.Context, *Tx) error

The CommitFunc type is an adapter to allow the use of ordinary function as a Committer. If f is a function with the appropriate signature, CommitFunc(f) is a Committer that calls f.

func (CommitFunc) Commit

func (f CommitFunc) Commit(ctx context.Context, tx *Tx) error

Commit calls f(ctx, m).

type CommitHook

type CommitHook func(Committer) Committer

CommitHook defines the "commit middleware". A function that gets a Committer and returns a Committer. For example:

hook := func(next ent.Committer) ent.Committer {
	return ent.CommitFunc(func(ctx context.Context, tx *ent.Tx) error {
		// Do some stuff before.
		if err := next.Commit(ctx, tx); err != nil {
			return err
		}
		// Do some stuff after.
		return nil
	})
}

type Committer

type Committer interface {
	Commit(context.Context, *Tx) error
}

Committer is the interface that wraps the Commit method.

type ConstraintError

type ConstraintError struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ConstraintError returns when trying to create/update one or more entities and one or more of their constraints failed. For example, violation of edge or field uniqueness.

func (ConstraintError) Error

func (e ConstraintError) Error() string

Error implements the error interface.

func (*ConstraintError) Unwrap

func (e *ConstraintError) Unwrap() error

Unwrap implements the errors.Wrapper interface.

type Device

type Device struct {

	// ID of the ent.
	ID schema.ID `json:"id,omitempty"`
	// Edges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.
	// The values are being populated by the DeviceQuery when eager-loading is set.
	Edges DeviceEdges `json:"edges"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Device is the model entity for the Device schema.

func (*Device) QueryActiveSession

func (d *Device) QueryActiveSession() *SessionQuery

QueryActiveSession queries the "active_session" edge of the Device entity.

func (*Device) QuerySessions

func (d *Device) QuerySessions() *SessionQuery

QuerySessions queries the "sessions" edge of the Device entity.

func (*Device) String

func (d *Device) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*Device) Unwrap

func (d *Device) Unwrap() *Device

Unwrap unwraps the Device entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*Device) Update

func (d *Device) Update() *DeviceUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this Device. Note that you need to call Device.Unwrap() before calling this method if this Device was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type DeviceClient

type DeviceClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DeviceClient is a client for the Device schema.

func NewDeviceClient

func NewDeviceClient(c config) *DeviceClient

NewDeviceClient returns a client for the Device from the given config.

func (*DeviceClient) Create

func (c *DeviceClient) Create() *DeviceCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a Device entity.

func (*DeviceClient) CreateBulk

func (c *DeviceClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*DeviceCreate) *DeviceCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of Device entities.

func (*DeviceClient) Delete

func (c *DeviceClient) Delete() *DeviceDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for Device.

func (*DeviceClient) DeleteOne

func (c *DeviceClient) DeleteOne(d *Device) *DeviceDeleteOne

DeleteOne returns a builder for deleting the given entity.

func (*DeviceClient) DeleteOneID

func (c *DeviceClient) DeleteOneID(id schema.ID) *DeviceDeleteOne

DeleteOneID returns a builder for deleting the given entity by its id.

func (*DeviceClient) Get

func (c *DeviceClient) Get(ctx context.Context, id schema.ID) (*Device, error)

Get returns a Device entity by its id.

func (*DeviceClient) GetX

func (c *DeviceClient) GetX(ctx context.Context, id schema.ID) *Device

GetX is like Get, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceClient) Hooks

func (c *DeviceClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*DeviceClient) Intercept

func (c *DeviceClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `device.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*DeviceClient) Interceptors

func (c *DeviceClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*DeviceClient) Query

func (c *DeviceClient) Query() *DeviceQuery

Query returns a query builder for Device.

func (*DeviceClient) QueryActiveSession

func (c *DeviceClient) QueryActiveSession(d *Device) *SessionQuery

QueryActiveSession queries the active_session edge of a Device.

func (*DeviceClient) QuerySessions

func (c *DeviceClient) QuerySessions(d *Device) *SessionQuery

QuerySessions queries the sessions edge of a Device.

func (*DeviceClient) Update

func (c *DeviceClient) Update() *DeviceUpdate

Update returns an update builder for Device.

func (*DeviceClient) UpdateOne

func (c *DeviceClient) UpdateOne(d *Device) *DeviceUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*DeviceClient) UpdateOneID

func (c *DeviceClient) UpdateOneID(id schema.ID) *DeviceUpdateOne

UpdateOneID returns an update builder for the given id.

func (*DeviceClient) Use

func (c *DeviceClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `device.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type DeviceCreate

type DeviceCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DeviceCreate is the builder for creating a Device entity.

func (*DeviceCreate) AddSessionIDs

func (dc *DeviceCreate) AddSessionIDs(ids ...schema.ID) *DeviceCreate

AddSessionIDs adds the "sessions" edge to the Session entity by IDs.

func (*DeviceCreate) AddSessions

func (dc *DeviceCreate) AddSessions(s ...*Session) *DeviceCreate

AddSessions adds the "sessions" edges to the Session entity.

func (*DeviceCreate) Exec

func (dc *DeviceCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*DeviceCreate) ExecX

func (dc *DeviceCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceCreate) Mutation

func (dc *DeviceCreate) Mutation() *DeviceMutation

Mutation returns the DeviceMutation object of the builder.

func (*DeviceCreate) OnConflict

func (dc *DeviceCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *DeviceUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Device.Create().
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*DeviceCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (dc *DeviceCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *DeviceUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Device.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*DeviceCreate) Save

func (dc *DeviceCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Device, error)

Save creates the Device in the database.

func (*DeviceCreate) SaveX

func (dc *DeviceCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Device

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*DeviceCreate) SetActiveSession

func (dc *DeviceCreate) SetActiveSession(s *Session) *DeviceCreate

SetActiveSession sets the "active_session" edge to the Session entity.

func (*DeviceCreate) SetActiveSessionID

func (dc *DeviceCreate) SetActiveSessionID(id schema.ID) *DeviceCreate

SetActiveSessionID sets the "active_session" edge to the Session entity by ID.

func (*DeviceCreate) SetID

func (dc *DeviceCreate) SetID(s schema.ID) *DeviceCreate

SetID sets the "id" field.

func (*DeviceCreate) SetNillableActiveSessionID

func (dc *DeviceCreate) SetNillableActiveSessionID(id *schema.ID) *DeviceCreate

SetNillableActiveSessionID sets the "active_session" edge to the Session entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*DeviceCreate) SetNillableID

func (dc *DeviceCreate) SetNillableID(s *schema.ID) *DeviceCreate

SetNillableID sets the "id" field if the given value is not nil.

type DeviceCreateBulk

type DeviceCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DeviceCreateBulk is the builder for creating many Device entities in bulk.

func (*DeviceCreateBulk) Exec

func (dcb *DeviceCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*DeviceCreateBulk) ExecX

func (dcb *DeviceCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (dcb *DeviceCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *DeviceUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Device.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*DeviceCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (dcb *DeviceCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *DeviceUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Device.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*DeviceCreateBulk) Save

func (dcb *DeviceCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*Device, error)

Save creates the Device entities in the database.

func (*DeviceCreateBulk) SaveX

func (dcb *DeviceCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*Device

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type DeviceDelete

type DeviceDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DeviceDelete is the builder for deleting a Device entity.

func (*DeviceDelete) Exec

func (dd *DeviceDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*DeviceDelete) ExecX

func (dd *DeviceDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceDelete) Where

func (dd *DeviceDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.Device) *DeviceDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the DeviceDelete builder.

type DeviceDeleteOne

type DeviceDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DeviceDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single Device entity.

func (*DeviceDeleteOne) Exec

func (ddo *DeviceDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*DeviceDeleteOne) ExecX

func (ddo *DeviceDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type DeviceEdges

type DeviceEdges struct {
	// ActiveSession holds the value of the active_session edge.
	ActiveSession *Session `json:"active_session,omitempty"`
	// Sessions holds the value of the sessions edge.
	Sessions []*Session `json:"sessions,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DeviceEdges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.

func (DeviceEdges) ActiveSessionOrErr

func (e DeviceEdges) ActiveSessionOrErr() (*Session, error)

ActiveSessionOrErr returns the ActiveSession value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading, or loaded but was not found.

func (DeviceEdges) SessionsOrErr

func (e DeviceEdges) SessionsOrErr() ([]*Session, error)

SessionsOrErr returns the Sessions value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading.

type DeviceFilter

type DeviceFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DeviceFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for DeviceQuery.

func (*DeviceFilter) Where

func (f *DeviceFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*DeviceFilter) WhereHasActiveSession

func (f *DeviceFilter) WhereHasActiveSession()

WhereHasActiveSession applies a predicate to check if query has an edge active_session.

func (*DeviceFilter) WhereHasActiveSessionWith

func (f *DeviceFilter) WhereHasActiveSessionWith(preds ...predicate.Session)

WhereHasActiveSessionWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge active_session with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*DeviceFilter) WhereHasSessions

func (f *DeviceFilter) WhereHasSessions()

WhereHasSessions applies a predicate to check if query has an edge sessions.

func (*DeviceFilter) WhereHasSessionsWith

func (f *DeviceFilter) WhereHasSessionsWith(preds ...predicate.Session)

WhereHasSessionsWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge sessions with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*DeviceFilter) WhereID

func (f *DeviceFilter) WhereID(p entql.BytesP)

WhereID applies the entql []byte predicate on the id field.

type DeviceGroupBy

type DeviceGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DeviceGroupBy is the group-by builder for Device entities.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) Aggregate

func (dgb *DeviceGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *DeviceGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) Bool

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) Bools

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) Float64

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) Int

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) IntX

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) Ints

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) Scan

func (dgb *DeviceGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) String

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) StringX

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) Strings

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DeviceGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *DeviceGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type DeviceMutation

type DeviceMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DeviceMutation represents an operation that mutates the Device nodes in the graph.

func (*DeviceMutation) ActiveSessionCleared

func (m *DeviceMutation) ActiveSessionCleared() bool

ActiveSessionCleared reports if the "active_session" edge to the Session entity was cleared.

func (*DeviceMutation) ActiveSessionID

func (m *DeviceMutation) ActiveSessionID() (id schema.ID, exists bool)

ActiveSessionID returns the "active_session" edge ID in the mutation.

func (*DeviceMutation) ActiveSessionIDs

func (m *DeviceMutation) ActiveSessionIDs() (ids []schema.ID)

ActiveSessionIDs returns the "active_session" edge IDs in the mutation. Note that IDs always returns len(IDs) <= 1 for unique edges, and you should use ActiveSessionID instead. It exists only for internal usage by the builders.

func (*DeviceMutation) AddField

func (m *DeviceMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*DeviceMutation) AddSessionIDs

func (m *DeviceMutation) AddSessionIDs(ids ...schema.ID)

AddSessionIDs adds the "sessions" edge to the Session entity by ids.

func (*DeviceMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *DeviceMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*DeviceMutation) AddedField

func (m *DeviceMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*DeviceMutation) AddedFields

func (m *DeviceMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*DeviceMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *DeviceMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*DeviceMutation) ClearActiveSession

func (m *DeviceMutation) ClearActiveSession()

ClearActiveSession clears the "active_session" edge to the Session entity.

func (*DeviceMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *DeviceMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*DeviceMutation) ClearField

func (m *DeviceMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*DeviceMutation) ClearSessions

func (m *DeviceMutation) ClearSessions()

ClearSessions clears the "sessions" edge to the Session entity.

func (*DeviceMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *DeviceMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*DeviceMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *DeviceMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (DeviceMutation) Client

func (m DeviceMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*DeviceMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *DeviceMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*DeviceMutation) Field

func (m *DeviceMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*DeviceMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *DeviceMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*DeviceMutation) Fields

func (m *DeviceMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*DeviceMutation) Filter

func (m *DeviceMutation) Filter() *DeviceFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the DeviceMutation builder.

func (*DeviceMutation) ID

func (m *DeviceMutation) ID() (id schema.ID, exists bool)

ID returns the ID value in the mutation. Note that the ID is only available if it was provided to the builder or after it was returned from the database.

func (*DeviceMutation) IDs

func (m *DeviceMutation) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]schema.ID, error)

IDs queries the database and returns the entity ids that match the mutation's predicate. That means, if the mutation is applied within a transaction with an isolation level such as sql.LevelSerializable, the returned ids match the ids of the rows that will be updated or updated by the mutation.

func (*DeviceMutation) OldField

func (m *DeviceMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*DeviceMutation) Op

func (m *DeviceMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*DeviceMutation) RemoveSessionIDs

func (m *DeviceMutation) RemoveSessionIDs(ids ...schema.ID)

RemoveSessionIDs removes the "sessions" edge to the Session entity by IDs.

func (*DeviceMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *DeviceMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*DeviceMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *DeviceMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*DeviceMutation) RemovedSessionsIDs

func (m *DeviceMutation) RemovedSessionsIDs() (ids []schema.ID)

RemovedSessions returns the removed IDs of the "sessions" edge to the Session entity.

func (*DeviceMutation) ResetActiveSession

func (m *DeviceMutation) ResetActiveSession()

ResetActiveSession resets all changes to the "active_session" edge.

func (*DeviceMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *DeviceMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*DeviceMutation) ResetField

func (m *DeviceMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*DeviceMutation) ResetSessions

func (m *DeviceMutation) ResetSessions()

ResetSessions resets all changes to the "sessions" edge.

func (*DeviceMutation) SessionsCleared

func (m *DeviceMutation) SessionsCleared() bool

SessionsCleared reports if the "sessions" edge to the Session entity was cleared.

func (*DeviceMutation) SessionsIDs

func (m *DeviceMutation) SessionsIDs() (ids []schema.ID)

SessionsIDs returns the "sessions" edge IDs in the mutation.

func (*DeviceMutation) SetActiveSessionID

func (m *DeviceMutation) SetActiveSessionID(id schema.ID)

SetActiveSessionID sets the "active_session" edge to the Session entity by id.

func (*DeviceMutation) SetField

func (m *DeviceMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*DeviceMutation) SetID

func (m *DeviceMutation) SetID(id schema.ID)

SetID sets the value of the id field. Note that this operation is only accepted on creation of Device entities.

func (*DeviceMutation) SetOp

func (m *DeviceMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (DeviceMutation) Tx

func (m DeviceMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*DeviceMutation) Type

func (m *DeviceMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (Device).

func (*DeviceMutation) Where

func (m *DeviceMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.Device)

Where appends a list predicates to the DeviceMutation builder.

func (*DeviceMutation) WhereP

func (m *DeviceMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the DeviceMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type DeviceQuery

type DeviceQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DeviceQuery is the builder for querying Device entities.

func (*DeviceQuery) Aggregate

func (dq *DeviceQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *DeviceSelect

Aggregate returns a DeviceSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*DeviceQuery) All

func (dq *DeviceQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*Device, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of Devices.

func (*DeviceQuery) AllX

func (dq *DeviceQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*Device

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceQuery) Clone

func (dq *DeviceQuery) Clone() *DeviceQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the DeviceQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*DeviceQuery) Count

func (dq *DeviceQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*DeviceQuery) CountX

func (dq *DeviceQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceQuery) Exist

func (dq *DeviceQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*DeviceQuery) ExistX

func (dq *DeviceQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceQuery) Filter

func (dq *DeviceQuery) Filter() *DeviceFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the DeviceQuery builder.

func (*DeviceQuery) First

func (dq *DeviceQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*Device, error)

First returns the first Device entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Device was found.

func (*DeviceQuery) FirstID

func (dq *DeviceQuery) FirstID(ctx context.Context) (id schema.ID, err error)

FirstID returns the first Device ID from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Device ID was found.

func (*DeviceQuery) FirstIDX

func (dq *DeviceQuery) FirstIDX(ctx context.Context) schema.ID

FirstIDX is like FirstID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceQuery) FirstX

func (dq *DeviceQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *Device

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceQuery) GroupBy

func (dq *DeviceQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *DeviceGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

func (*DeviceQuery) IDs

func (dq *DeviceQuery) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]schema.ID, error)

IDs executes the query and returns a list of Device IDs.

func (*DeviceQuery) IDsX

func (dq *DeviceQuery) IDsX(ctx context.Context) []schema.ID

IDsX is like IDs, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceQuery) Limit

func (dq *DeviceQuery) Limit(limit int) *DeviceQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*DeviceQuery) Offset

func (dq *DeviceQuery) Offset(offset int) *DeviceQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*DeviceQuery) Only

func (dq *DeviceQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*Device, error)

Only returns a single Device entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Device entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Device entities are found.

func (*DeviceQuery) OnlyID

func (dq *DeviceQuery) OnlyID(ctx context.Context) (id schema.ID, err error)

OnlyID is like Only, but returns the only Device ID in the query. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Device ID is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no entities are found.

func (*DeviceQuery) OnlyIDX

func (dq *DeviceQuery) OnlyIDX(ctx context.Context) schema.ID

OnlyIDX is like OnlyID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceQuery) OnlyX

func (dq *DeviceQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *Device

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceQuery) Order

func (dq *DeviceQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *DeviceQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (*DeviceQuery) QueryActiveSession

func (dq *DeviceQuery) QueryActiveSession() *SessionQuery

QueryActiveSession chains the current query on the "active_session" edge.

func (*DeviceQuery) QuerySessions

func (dq *DeviceQuery) QuerySessions() *SessionQuery

QuerySessions chains the current query on the "sessions" edge.

func (*DeviceQuery) Select

func (dq *DeviceQuery) Select(fields ...string) *DeviceSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

func (*DeviceQuery) Unique

func (dq *DeviceQuery) Unique(unique bool) *DeviceQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*DeviceQuery) Where

func (dq *DeviceQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.Device) *DeviceQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the DeviceQuery builder.

func (*DeviceQuery) WithActiveSession

func (dq *DeviceQuery) WithActiveSession(opts ...func(*SessionQuery)) *DeviceQuery

WithActiveSession tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "active_session" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

func (*DeviceQuery) WithSessions

func (dq *DeviceQuery) WithSessions(opts ...func(*SessionQuery)) *DeviceQuery

WithSessions tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "sessions" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

type DeviceSelect

type DeviceSelect struct {
	*DeviceQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DeviceSelect is the builder for selecting fields of Device entities.

func (*DeviceSelect) Aggregate

func (ds *DeviceSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *DeviceSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*DeviceSelect) Bool

func (s *DeviceSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DeviceSelect) BoolX

func (s *DeviceSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceSelect) Bools

func (s *DeviceSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DeviceSelect) BoolsX

func (s *DeviceSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceSelect) Float64

func (s *DeviceSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DeviceSelect) Float64X

func (s *DeviceSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceSelect) Float64s

func (s *DeviceSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DeviceSelect) Float64sX

func (s *DeviceSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceSelect) Int

func (s *DeviceSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DeviceSelect) IntX

func (s *DeviceSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceSelect) Ints

func (s *DeviceSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DeviceSelect) IntsX

func (s *DeviceSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceSelect) Scan

func (ds *DeviceSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*DeviceSelect) ScanX

func (s *DeviceSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceSelect) String

func (s *DeviceSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DeviceSelect) StringX

func (s *DeviceSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceSelect) Strings

func (s *DeviceSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DeviceSelect) StringsX

func (s *DeviceSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type DeviceUpdate

type DeviceUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DeviceUpdate is the builder for updating Device entities.

func (*DeviceUpdate) AddSessionIDs

func (du *DeviceUpdate) AddSessionIDs(ids ...schema.ID) *DeviceUpdate

AddSessionIDs adds the "sessions" edge to the Session entity by IDs.

func (*DeviceUpdate) AddSessions

func (du *DeviceUpdate) AddSessions(s ...*Session) *DeviceUpdate

AddSessions adds the "sessions" edges to the Session entity.

func (*DeviceUpdate) ClearActiveSession

func (du *DeviceUpdate) ClearActiveSession() *DeviceUpdate

ClearActiveSession clears the "active_session" edge to the Session entity.

func (*DeviceUpdate) ClearSessions

func (du *DeviceUpdate) ClearSessions() *DeviceUpdate

ClearSessions clears all "sessions" edges to the Session entity.

func (*DeviceUpdate) Exec

func (du *DeviceUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*DeviceUpdate) ExecX

func (du *DeviceUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceUpdate) Mutation

func (du *DeviceUpdate) Mutation() *DeviceMutation

Mutation returns the DeviceMutation object of the builder.

func (*DeviceUpdate) RemoveSessionIDs

func (du *DeviceUpdate) RemoveSessionIDs(ids ...schema.ID) *DeviceUpdate

RemoveSessionIDs removes the "sessions" edge to Session entities by IDs.

func (*DeviceUpdate) RemoveSessions

func (du *DeviceUpdate) RemoveSessions(s ...*Session) *DeviceUpdate

RemoveSessions removes "sessions" edges to Session entities.

func (*DeviceUpdate) Save

func (du *DeviceUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*DeviceUpdate) SaveX

func (du *DeviceUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceUpdate) SetActiveSession

func (du *DeviceUpdate) SetActiveSession(s *Session) *DeviceUpdate

SetActiveSession sets the "active_session" edge to the Session entity.

func (*DeviceUpdate) SetActiveSessionID

func (du *DeviceUpdate) SetActiveSessionID(id schema.ID) *DeviceUpdate

SetActiveSessionID sets the "active_session" edge to the Session entity by ID.

func (*DeviceUpdate) SetNillableActiveSessionID

func (du *DeviceUpdate) SetNillableActiveSessionID(id *schema.ID) *DeviceUpdate

SetNillableActiveSessionID sets the "active_session" edge to the Session entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*DeviceUpdate) Where

func (du *DeviceUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.Device) *DeviceUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the DeviceUpdate builder.

type DeviceUpdateOne

type DeviceUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DeviceUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single Device entity.

func (*DeviceUpdateOne) AddSessionIDs

func (duo *DeviceUpdateOne) AddSessionIDs(ids ...schema.ID) *DeviceUpdateOne

AddSessionIDs adds the "sessions" edge to the Session entity by IDs.

func (*DeviceUpdateOne) AddSessions

func (duo *DeviceUpdateOne) AddSessions(s ...*Session) *DeviceUpdateOne

AddSessions adds the "sessions" edges to the Session entity.

func (*DeviceUpdateOne) ClearActiveSession

func (duo *DeviceUpdateOne) ClearActiveSession() *DeviceUpdateOne

ClearActiveSession clears the "active_session" edge to the Session entity.

func (*DeviceUpdateOne) ClearSessions

func (duo *DeviceUpdateOne) ClearSessions() *DeviceUpdateOne

ClearSessions clears all "sessions" edges to the Session entity.

func (*DeviceUpdateOne) Exec

func (duo *DeviceUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*DeviceUpdateOne) ExecX

func (duo *DeviceUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceUpdateOne) Mutation

func (duo *DeviceUpdateOne) Mutation() *DeviceMutation

Mutation returns the DeviceMutation object of the builder.

func (*DeviceUpdateOne) RemoveSessionIDs

func (duo *DeviceUpdateOne) RemoveSessionIDs(ids ...schema.ID) *DeviceUpdateOne

RemoveSessionIDs removes the "sessions" edge to Session entities by IDs.

func (*DeviceUpdateOne) RemoveSessions

func (duo *DeviceUpdateOne) RemoveSessions(s ...*Session) *DeviceUpdateOne

RemoveSessions removes "sessions" edges to Session entities.

func (*DeviceUpdateOne) Save

func (duo *DeviceUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Device, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated Device entity.

func (*DeviceUpdateOne) SaveX

func (duo *DeviceUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Device

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceUpdateOne) Select

func (duo *DeviceUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *DeviceUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

func (*DeviceUpdateOne) SetActiveSession

func (duo *DeviceUpdateOne) SetActiveSession(s *Session) *DeviceUpdateOne

SetActiveSession sets the "active_session" edge to the Session entity.

func (*DeviceUpdateOne) SetActiveSessionID

func (duo *DeviceUpdateOne) SetActiveSessionID(id schema.ID) *DeviceUpdateOne

SetActiveSessionID sets the "active_session" edge to the Session entity by ID.

func (*DeviceUpdateOne) SetNillableActiveSessionID

func (duo *DeviceUpdateOne) SetNillableActiveSessionID(id *schema.ID) *DeviceUpdateOne

SetNillableActiveSessionID sets the "active_session" edge to the Session entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

type DeviceUpsert

type DeviceUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

DeviceUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

type DeviceUpsertBulk

type DeviceUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DeviceUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of Device nodes.

func (*DeviceUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *DeviceUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *DeviceUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*DeviceUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *DeviceUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*DeviceUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *DeviceUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceUpsertBulk) Ignore

func (u *DeviceUpsertBulk) Ignore() *DeviceUpsertBulk

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Device.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*DeviceUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *DeviceUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*DeviceUpsert)) *DeviceUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the DeviceCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*DeviceUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *DeviceUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *DeviceUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Device.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(device.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type DeviceUpsertOne

type DeviceUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DeviceUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one Device node.

func (*DeviceUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *DeviceUpsertOne) DoNothing() *DeviceUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*DeviceUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *DeviceUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*DeviceUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *DeviceUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceUpsertOne) ID

func (u *DeviceUpsertOne) ID(ctx context.Context) (id schema.ID, err error)

Exec executes the UPSERT query and returns the inserted/updated ID.

func (*DeviceUpsertOne) IDX

func (u *DeviceUpsertOne) IDX(ctx context.Context) schema.ID

IDX is like ID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DeviceUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *DeviceUpsertOne) Ignore() *DeviceUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Device.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*DeviceUpsertOne) Update

func (u *DeviceUpsertOne) Update(set func(*DeviceUpsert)) *DeviceUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the DeviceCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*DeviceUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *DeviceUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *DeviceUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create except the ID field. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Device.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(device.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type Devices

type Devices []*Device

Devices is a parsable slice of Device.

type Doc

type Doc struct {

	// ID of the ent.
	ID schema.DocID `json:"id,omitempty"`
	// Text holds the value of the "text" field.
	Text string `json:"text,omitempty"`
	// Edges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.
	// The values are being populated by the DocQuery when eager-loading is set.
	Edges DocEdges `json:"edges"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Doc is the model entity for the Doc schema.

func (*Doc) QueryChildren

func (d *Doc) QueryChildren() *DocQuery

QueryChildren queries the "children" edge of the Doc entity.

func (*Doc) QueryParent

func (d *Doc) QueryParent() *DocQuery

QueryParent queries the "parent" edge of the Doc entity.

func (*Doc) QueryRelated

func (d *Doc) QueryRelated() *DocQuery

QueryRelated queries the "related" edge of the Doc entity.

func (*Doc) String

func (d *Doc) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*Doc) Unwrap

func (d *Doc) Unwrap() *Doc

Unwrap unwraps the Doc entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*Doc) Update

func (d *Doc) Update() *DocUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this Doc. Note that you need to call Doc.Unwrap() before calling this method if this Doc was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type DocClient

type DocClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DocClient is a client for the Doc schema.

func NewDocClient

func NewDocClient(c config) *DocClient

NewDocClient returns a client for the Doc from the given config.

func (*DocClient) Create

func (c *DocClient) Create() *DocCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a Doc entity.

func (*DocClient) CreateBulk

func (c *DocClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*DocCreate) *DocCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of Doc entities.

func (*DocClient) Delete

func (c *DocClient) Delete() *DocDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for Doc.

func (*DocClient) DeleteOne

func (c *DocClient) DeleteOne(d *Doc) *DocDeleteOne

DeleteOne returns a builder for deleting the given entity.

func (*DocClient) DeleteOneID

func (c *DocClient) DeleteOneID(id schema.DocID) *DocDeleteOne

DeleteOneID returns a builder for deleting the given entity by its id.

func (*DocClient) Get

func (c *DocClient) Get(ctx context.Context, id schema.DocID) (*Doc, error)

Get returns a Doc entity by its id.

func (*DocClient) GetX

func (c *DocClient) GetX(ctx context.Context, id schema.DocID) *Doc

GetX is like Get, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocClient) Hooks

func (c *DocClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*DocClient) Intercept

func (c *DocClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `doc.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*DocClient) Interceptors

func (c *DocClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*DocClient) Query

func (c *DocClient) Query() *DocQuery

Query returns a query builder for Doc.

func (*DocClient) QueryChildren

func (c *DocClient) QueryChildren(d *Doc) *DocQuery

QueryChildren queries the children edge of a Doc.

func (*DocClient) QueryParent

func (c *DocClient) QueryParent(d *Doc) *DocQuery

QueryParent queries the parent edge of a Doc.

func (*DocClient) QueryRelated

func (c *DocClient) QueryRelated(d *Doc) *DocQuery

QueryRelated queries the related edge of a Doc.

func (*DocClient) Update

func (c *DocClient) Update() *DocUpdate

Update returns an update builder for Doc.

func (*DocClient) UpdateOne

func (c *DocClient) UpdateOne(d *Doc) *DocUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*DocClient) UpdateOneID

func (c *DocClient) UpdateOneID(id schema.DocID) *DocUpdateOne

UpdateOneID returns an update builder for the given id.

func (*DocClient) Use

func (c *DocClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `doc.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type DocCreate

type DocCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DocCreate is the builder for creating a Doc entity.

func (*DocCreate) AddChildIDs

func (dc *DocCreate) AddChildIDs(ids ...schema.DocID) *DocCreate

AddChildIDs adds the "children" edge to the Doc entity by IDs.

func (*DocCreate) AddChildren

func (dc *DocCreate) AddChildren(d ...*Doc) *DocCreate

AddChildren adds the "children" edges to the Doc entity.

func (*DocCreate) AddRelated

func (dc *DocCreate) AddRelated(d ...*Doc) *DocCreate

AddRelated adds the "related" edges to the Doc entity.

func (*DocCreate) AddRelatedIDs

func (dc *DocCreate) AddRelatedIDs(ids ...schema.DocID) *DocCreate

AddRelatedIDs adds the "related" edge to the Doc entity by IDs.

func (*DocCreate) Exec

func (dc *DocCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*DocCreate) ExecX

func (dc *DocCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocCreate) Mutation

func (dc *DocCreate) Mutation() *DocMutation

Mutation returns the DocMutation object of the builder.

func (*DocCreate) OnConflict

func (dc *DocCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *DocUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Doc.Create().
	SetText(v).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.DocUpsert) {
		SetText(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*DocCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (dc *DocCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *DocUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Doc.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*DocCreate) Save

func (dc *DocCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Doc, error)

Save creates the Doc in the database.

func (*DocCreate) SaveX

func (dc *DocCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Doc

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*DocCreate) SetID

func (dc *DocCreate) SetID(si schema.DocID) *DocCreate

SetID sets the "id" field.

func (*DocCreate) SetNillableID

func (dc *DocCreate) SetNillableID(si *schema.DocID) *DocCreate

SetNillableID sets the "id" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*DocCreate) SetNillableParentID

func (dc *DocCreate) SetNillableParentID(id *schema.DocID) *DocCreate

SetNillableParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Doc entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*DocCreate) SetNillableText

func (dc *DocCreate) SetNillableText(s *string) *DocCreate

SetNillableText sets the "text" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*DocCreate) SetParent

func (dc *DocCreate) SetParent(d *Doc) *DocCreate

SetParent sets the "parent" edge to the Doc entity.

func (*DocCreate) SetParentID

func (dc *DocCreate) SetParentID(id schema.DocID) *DocCreate

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Doc entity by ID.

func (*DocCreate) SetText

func (dc *DocCreate) SetText(s string) *DocCreate

SetText sets the "text" field.

type DocCreateBulk

type DocCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DocCreateBulk is the builder for creating many Doc entities in bulk.

func (*DocCreateBulk) Exec

func (dcb *DocCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*DocCreateBulk) ExecX

func (dcb *DocCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (dcb *DocCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *DocUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Doc.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.DocUpsert) {
		SetText(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*DocCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (dcb *DocCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *DocUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Doc.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*DocCreateBulk) Save

func (dcb *DocCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*Doc, error)

Save creates the Doc entities in the database.

func (*DocCreateBulk) SaveX

func (dcb *DocCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*Doc

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type DocDelete

type DocDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DocDelete is the builder for deleting a Doc entity.

func (*DocDelete) Exec

func (dd *DocDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*DocDelete) ExecX

func (dd *DocDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocDelete) Where

func (dd *DocDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.Doc) *DocDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the DocDelete builder.

type DocDeleteOne

type DocDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DocDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single Doc entity.

func (*DocDeleteOne) Exec

func (ddo *DocDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*DocDeleteOne) ExecX

func (ddo *DocDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type DocEdges

type DocEdges struct {
	// Parent holds the value of the parent edge.
	Parent *Doc `json:"parent,omitempty"`
	// Children holds the value of the children edge.
	Children []*Doc `json:"children,omitempty"`
	// Related holds the value of the related edge.
	Related []*Doc `json:"related,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DocEdges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.

func (DocEdges) ChildrenOrErr

func (e DocEdges) ChildrenOrErr() ([]*Doc, error)

ChildrenOrErr returns the Children value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading.

func (DocEdges) ParentOrErr

func (e DocEdges) ParentOrErr() (*Doc, error)

ParentOrErr returns the Parent value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading, or loaded but was not found.

func (DocEdges) RelatedOrErr

func (e DocEdges) RelatedOrErr() ([]*Doc, error)

RelatedOrErr returns the Related value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading.

type DocFilter

type DocFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DocFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for DocQuery.

func (*DocFilter) Where

func (f *DocFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*DocFilter) WhereHasChildren

func (f *DocFilter) WhereHasChildren()

WhereHasChildren applies a predicate to check if query has an edge children.

func (*DocFilter) WhereHasChildrenWith

func (f *DocFilter) WhereHasChildrenWith(preds ...predicate.Doc)

WhereHasChildrenWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge children with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*DocFilter) WhereHasParent

func (f *DocFilter) WhereHasParent()

WhereHasParent applies a predicate to check if query has an edge parent.

func (*DocFilter) WhereHasParentWith

func (f *DocFilter) WhereHasParentWith(preds ...predicate.Doc)

WhereHasParentWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge parent with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*DocFilter) WhereHasRelated

func (f *DocFilter) WhereHasRelated()

WhereHasRelated applies a predicate to check if query has an edge related.

func (*DocFilter) WhereHasRelatedWith

func (f *DocFilter) WhereHasRelatedWith(preds ...predicate.Doc)

WhereHasRelatedWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge related with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*DocFilter) WhereID

func (f *DocFilter) WhereID(p entql.StringP)

WhereID applies the entql string predicate on the id field.

func (*DocFilter) WhereText

func (f *DocFilter) WhereText(p entql.StringP)

WhereText applies the entql string predicate on the text field.

type DocGroupBy

type DocGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DocGroupBy is the group-by builder for Doc entities.

func (*DocGroupBy) Aggregate

func (dgb *DocGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *DocGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*DocGroupBy) Bool

func (s *DocGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DocGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *DocGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocGroupBy) Bools

func (s *DocGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DocGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *DocGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocGroupBy) Float64

func (s *DocGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DocGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *DocGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *DocGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DocGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *DocGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocGroupBy) Int

func (s *DocGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DocGroupBy) IntX

func (s *DocGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocGroupBy) Ints

func (s *DocGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DocGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *DocGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocGroupBy) Scan

func (dgb *DocGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*DocGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *DocGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocGroupBy) String

func (s *DocGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DocGroupBy) StringX

func (s *DocGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocGroupBy) Strings

func (s *DocGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DocGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *DocGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type DocMutation

type DocMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DocMutation represents an operation that mutates the Doc nodes in the graph.

func (*DocMutation) AddChildIDs

func (m *DocMutation) AddChildIDs(ids ...schema.DocID)

AddChildIDs adds the "children" edge to the Doc entity by ids.

func (*DocMutation) AddField

func (m *DocMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*DocMutation) AddRelatedIDs

func (m *DocMutation) AddRelatedIDs(ids ...schema.DocID)

AddRelatedIDs adds the "related" edge to the Doc entity by ids.

func (*DocMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *DocMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*DocMutation) AddedField

func (m *DocMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*DocMutation) AddedFields

func (m *DocMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*DocMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *DocMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*DocMutation) ChildrenCleared

func (m *DocMutation) ChildrenCleared() bool

ChildrenCleared reports if the "children" edge to the Doc entity was cleared.

func (*DocMutation) ChildrenIDs

func (m *DocMutation) ChildrenIDs() (ids []schema.DocID)

ChildrenIDs returns the "children" edge IDs in the mutation.

func (*DocMutation) ClearChildren

func (m *DocMutation) ClearChildren()

ClearChildren clears the "children" edge to the Doc entity.

func (*DocMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *DocMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*DocMutation) ClearField

func (m *DocMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*DocMutation) ClearParent

func (m *DocMutation) ClearParent()

ClearParent clears the "parent" edge to the Doc entity.

func (*DocMutation) ClearRelated

func (m *DocMutation) ClearRelated()

ClearRelated clears the "related" edge to the Doc entity.

func (*DocMutation) ClearText

func (m *DocMutation) ClearText()

ClearText clears the value of the "text" field.

func (*DocMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *DocMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*DocMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *DocMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (DocMutation) Client

func (m DocMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*DocMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *DocMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*DocMutation) Field

func (m *DocMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*DocMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *DocMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*DocMutation) Fields

func (m *DocMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*DocMutation) Filter

func (m *DocMutation) Filter() *DocFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the DocMutation builder.

func (*DocMutation) ID

func (m *DocMutation) ID() (id schema.DocID, exists bool)

ID returns the ID value in the mutation. Note that the ID is only available if it was provided to the builder or after it was returned from the database.

func (*DocMutation) IDs

func (m *DocMutation) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]schema.DocID, error)

IDs queries the database and returns the entity ids that match the mutation's predicate. That means, if the mutation is applied within a transaction with an isolation level such as sql.LevelSerializable, the returned ids match the ids of the rows that will be updated or updated by the mutation.

func (*DocMutation) OldField

func (m *DocMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*DocMutation) OldText

func (m *DocMutation) OldText(ctx context.Context) (v string, err error)

OldText returns the old "text" field's value of the Doc entity. If the Doc object wasn't provided to the builder, the object is fetched from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the database query fails.

func (*DocMutation) Op

func (m *DocMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*DocMutation) ParentCleared

func (m *DocMutation) ParentCleared() bool

ParentCleared reports if the "parent" edge to the Doc entity was cleared.

func (*DocMutation) ParentID

func (m *DocMutation) ParentID() (id schema.DocID, exists bool)

ParentID returns the "parent" edge ID in the mutation.

func (*DocMutation) ParentIDs

func (m *DocMutation) ParentIDs() (ids []schema.DocID)

ParentIDs returns the "parent" edge IDs in the mutation. Note that IDs always returns len(IDs) <= 1 for unique edges, and you should use ParentID instead. It exists only for internal usage by the builders.

func (*DocMutation) RelatedCleared

func (m *DocMutation) RelatedCleared() bool

RelatedCleared reports if the "related" edge to the Doc entity was cleared.

func (*DocMutation) RelatedIDs

func (m *DocMutation) RelatedIDs() (ids []schema.DocID)

RelatedIDs returns the "related" edge IDs in the mutation.

func (*DocMutation) RemoveChildIDs

func (m *DocMutation) RemoveChildIDs(ids ...schema.DocID)

RemoveChildIDs removes the "children" edge to the Doc entity by IDs.

func (*DocMutation) RemoveRelatedIDs

func (m *DocMutation) RemoveRelatedIDs(ids ...schema.DocID)

RemoveRelatedIDs removes the "related" edge to the Doc entity by IDs.

func (*DocMutation) RemovedChildrenIDs

func (m *DocMutation) RemovedChildrenIDs() (ids []schema.DocID)

RemovedChildren returns the removed IDs of the "children" edge to the Doc entity.

func (*DocMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *DocMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*DocMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *DocMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*DocMutation) RemovedRelatedIDs

func (m *DocMutation) RemovedRelatedIDs() (ids []schema.DocID)

RemovedRelated returns the removed IDs of the "related" edge to the Doc entity.

func (*DocMutation) ResetChildren

func (m *DocMutation) ResetChildren()

ResetChildren resets all changes to the "children" edge.

func (*DocMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *DocMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*DocMutation) ResetField

func (m *DocMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*DocMutation) ResetParent

func (m *DocMutation) ResetParent()

ResetParent resets all changes to the "parent" edge.

func (*DocMutation) ResetRelated

func (m *DocMutation) ResetRelated()

ResetRelated resets all changes to the "related" edge.

func (*DocMutation) ResetText

func (m *DocMutation) ResetText()

ResetText resets all changes to the "text" field.

func (*DocMutation) SetField

func (m *DocMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*DocMutation) SetID

func (m *DocMutation) SetID(id schema.DocID)

SetID sets the value of the id field. Note that this operation is only accepted on creation of Doc entities.

func (*DocMutation) SetOp

func (m *DocMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (*DocMutation) SetParentID

func (m *DocMutation) SetParentID(id schema.DocID)

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Doc entity by id.

func (*DocMutation) SetText

func (m *DocMutation) SetText(s string)

SetText sets the "text" field.

func (*DocMutation) Text

func (m *DocMutation) Text() (r string, exists bool)

Text returns the value of the "text" field in the mutation.

func (*DocMutation) TextCleared

func (m *DocMutation) TextCleared() bool

TextCleared returns if the "text" field was cleared in this mutation.

func (DocMutation) Tx

func (m DocMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*DocMutation) Type

func (m *DocMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (Doc).

func (*DocMutation) Where

func (m *DocMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.Doc)

Where appends a list predicates to the DocMutation builder.

func (*DocMutation) WhereP

func (m *DocMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the DocMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type DocQuery

type DocQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DocQuery is the builder for querying Doc entities.

func (*DocQuery) Aggregate

func (dq *DocQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *DocSelect

Aggregate returns a DocSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*DocQuery) All

func (dq *DocQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*Doc, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of Docs.

func (*DocQuery) AllX

func (dq *DocQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*Doc

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocQuery) Clone

func (dq *DocQuery) Clone() *DocQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the DocQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*DocQuery) Count

func (dq *DocQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*DocQuery) CountX

func (dq *DocQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocQuery) Exist

func (dq *DocQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*DocQuery) ExistX

func (dq *DocQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocQuery) Filter

func (dq *DocQuery) Filter() *DocFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the DocQuery builder.

func (*DocQuery) First

func (dq *DocQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*Doc, error)

First returns the first Doc entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Doc was found.

func (*DocQuery) FirstID

func (dq *DocQuery) FirstID(ctx context.Context) (id schema.DocID, err error)

FirstID returns the first Doc ID from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Doc ID was found.

func (*DocQuery) FirstIDX

func (dq *DocQuery) FirstIDX(ctx context.Context) schema.DocID

FirstIDX is like FirstID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocQuery) FirstX

func (dq *DocQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *Doc

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocQuery) GroupBy

func (dq *DocQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *DocGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

Example:

var v []struct {
	Text string `json:"text,omitempty"`
	Count int `json:"count,omitempty"`
}

client.Doc.Query().
	GroupBy(doc.FieldText).
	Aggregate(ent.Count()).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*DocQuery) IDs

func (dq *DocQuery) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]schema.DocID, error)

IDs executes the query and returns a list of Doc IDs.

func (*DocQuery) IDsX

func (dq *DocQuery) IDsX(ctx context.Context) []schema.DocID

IDsX is like IDs, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocQuery) Limit

func (dq *DocQuery) Limit(limit int) *DocQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*DocQuery) Offset

func (dq *DocQuery) Offset(offset int) *DocQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*DocQuery) Only

func (dq *DocQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*Doc, error)

Only returns a single Doc entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Doc entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Doc entities are found.

func (*DocQuery) OnlyID

func (dq *DocQuery) OnlyID(ctx context.Context) (id schema.DocID, err error)

OnlyID is like Only, but returns the only Doc ID in the query. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Doc ID is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no entities are found.

func (*DocQuery) OnlyIDX

func (dq *DocQuery) OnlyIDX(ctx context.Context) schema.DocID

OnlyIDX is like OnlyID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocQuery) OnlyX

func (dq *DocQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *Doc

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocQuery) Order

func (dq *DocQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *DocQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (*DocQuery) QueryChildren

func (dq *DocQuery) QueryChildren() *DocQuery

QueryChildren chains the current query on the "children" edge.

func (*DocQuery) QueryParent

func (dq *DocQuery) QueryParent() *DocQuery

QueryParent chains the current query on the "parent" edge.

func (*DocQuery) QueryRelated

func (dq *DocQuery) QueryRelated() *DocQuery

QueryRelated chains the current query on the "related" edge.

func (*DocQuery) Select

func (dq *DocQuery) Select(fields ...string) *DocSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

Example:

var v []struct {
	Text string `json:"text,omitempty"`
}

client.Doc.Query().
	Select(doc.FieldText).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*DocQuery) Unique

func (dq *DocQuery) Unique(unique bool) *DocQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*DocQuery) Where

func (dq *DocQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.Doc) *DocQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the DocQuery builder.

func (*DocQuery) WithChildren

func (dq *DocQuery) WithChildren(opts ...func(*DocQuery)) *DocQuery

WithChildren tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "children" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

func (*DocQuery) WithParent

func (dq *DocQuery) WithParent(opts ...func(*DocQuery)) *DocQuery

WithParent tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "parent" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

func (*DocQuery) WithRelated

func (dq *DocQuery) WithRelated(opts ...func(*DocQuery)) *DocQuery

WithRelated tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "related" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

type DocSelect

type DocSelect struct {
	*DocQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DocSelect is the builder for selecting fields of Doc entities.

func (*DocSelect) Aggregate

func (ds *DocSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *DocSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*DocSelect) Bool

func (s *DocSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DocSelect) BoolX

func (s *DocSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocSelect) Bools

func (s *DocSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DocSelect) BoolsX

func (s *DocSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocSelect) Float64

func (s *DocSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DocSelect) Float64X

func (s *DocSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocSelect) Float64s

func (s *DocSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DocSelect) Float64sX

func (s *DocSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocSelect) Int

func (s *DocSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DocSelect) IntX

func (s *DocSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocSelect) Ints

func (s *DocSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DocSelect) IntsX

func (s *DocSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocSelect) Scan

func (ds *DocSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*DocSelect) ScanX

func (s *DocSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocSelect) String

func (s *DocSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DocSelect) StringX

func (s *DocSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocSelect) Strings

func (s *DocSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*DocSelect) StringsX

func (s *DocSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type DocUpdate

type DocUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DocUpdate is the builder for updating Doc entities.

func (*DocUpdate) AddChildIDs

func (du *DocUpdate) AddChildIDs(ids ...schema.DocID) *DocUpdate

AddChildIDs adds the "children" edge to the Doc entity by IDs.

func (*DocUpdate) AddChildren

func (du *DocUpdate) AddChildren(d ...*Doc) *DocUpdate

AddChildren adds the "children" edges to the Doc entity.

func (*DocUpdate) AddRelated

func (du *DocUpdate) AddRelated(d ...*Doc) *DocUpdate

AddRelated adds the "related" edges to the Doc entity.

func (*DocUpdate) AddRelatedIDs

func (du *DocUpdate) AddRelatedIDs(ids ...schema.DocID) *DocUpdate

AddRelatedIDs adds the "related" edge to the Doc entity by IDs.

func (*DocUpdate) ClearChildren

func (du *DocUpdate) ClearChildren() *DocUpdate

ClearChildren clears all "children" edges to the Doc entity.

func (*DocUpdate) ClearParent

func (du *DocUpdate) ClearParent() *DocUpdate

ClearParent clears the "parent" edge to the Doc entity.

func (*DocUpdate) ClearRelated

func (du *DocUpdate) ClearRelated() *DocUpdate

ClearRelated clears all "related" edges to the Doc entity.

func (*DocUpdate) ClearText

func (du *DocUpdate) ClearText() *DocUpdate

ClearText clears the value of the "text" field.

func (*DocUpdate) Exec

func (du *DocUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*DocUpdate) ExecX

func (du *DocUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocUpdate) Mutation

func (du *DocUpdate) Mutation() *DocMutation

Mutation returns the DocMutation object of the builder.

func (*DocUpdate) RemoveChildIDs

func (du *DocUpdate) RemoveChildIDs(ids ...schema.DocID) *DocUpdate

RemoveChildIDs removes the "children" edge to Doc entities by IDs.

func (*DocUpdate) RemoveChildren

func (du *DocUpdate) RemoveChildren(d ...*Doc) *DocUpdate

RemoveChildren removes "children" edges to Doc entities.

func (*DocUpdate) RemoveRelated

func (du *DocUpdate) RemoveRelated(d ...*Doc) *DocUpdate

RemoveRelated removes "related" edges to Doc entities.

func (*DocUpdate) RemoveRelatedIDs

func (du *DocUpdate) RemoveRelatedIDs(ids ...schema.DocID) *DocUpdate

RemoveRelatedIDs removes the "related" edge to Doc entities by IDs.

func (*DocUpdate) Save

func (du *DocUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*DocUpdate) SaveX

func (du *DocUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocUpdate) SetNillableParentID

func (du *DocUpdate) SetNillableParentID(id *schema.DocID) *DocUpdate

SetNillableParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Doc entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*DocUpdate) SetNillableText

func (du *DocUpdate) SetNillableText(s *string) *DocUpdate

SetNillableText sets the "text" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*DocUpdate) SetParent

func (du *DocUpdate) SetParent(d *Doc) *DocUpdate

SetParent sets the "parent" edge to the Doc entity.

func (*DocUpdate) SetParentID

func (du *DocUpdate) SetParentID(id schema.DocID) *DocUpdate

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Doc entity by ID.

func (*DocUpdate) SetText

func (du *DocUpdate) SetText(s string) *DocUpdate

SetText sets the "text" field.

func (*DocUpdate) Where

func (du *DocUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.Doc) *DocUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the DocUpdate builder.

type DocUpdateOne

type DocUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DocUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single Doc entity.

func (*DocUpdateOne) AddChildIDs

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) AddChildIDs(ids ...schema.DocID) *DocUpdateOne

AddChildIDs adds the "children" edge to the Doc entity by IDs.

func (*DocUpdateOne) AddChildren

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) AddChildren(d ...*Doc) *DocUpdateOne

AddChildren adds the "children" edges to the Doc entity.

func (*DocUpdateOne) AddRelated

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) AddRelated(d ...*Doc) *DocUpdateOne

AddRelated adds the "related" edges to the Doc entity.

func (*DocUpdateOne) AddRelatedIDs

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) AddRelatedIDs(ids ...schema.DocID) *DocUpdateOne

AddRelatedIDs adds the "related" edge to the Doc entity by IDs.

func (*DocUpdateOne) ClearChildren

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) ClearChildren() *DocUpdateOne

ClearChildren clears all "children" edges to the Doc entity.

func (*DocUpdateOne) ClearParent

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) ClearParent() *DocUpdateOne

ClearParent clears the "parent" edge to the Doc entity.

func (*DocUpdateOne) ClearRelated

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) ClearRelated() *DocUpdateOne

ClearRelated clears all "related" edges to the Doc entity.

func (*DocUpdateOne) ClearText

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) ClearText() *DocUpdateOne

ClearText clears the value of the "text" field.

func (*DocUpdateOne) Exec

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*DocUpdateOne) ExecX

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocUpdateOne) Mutation

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) Mutation() *DocMutation

Mutation returns the DocMutation object of the builder.

func (*DocUpdateOne) RemoveChildIDs

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) RemoveChildIDs(ids ...schema.DocID) *DocUpdateOne

RemoveChildIDs removes the "children" edge to Doc entities by IDs.

func (*DocUpdateOne) RemoveChildren

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) RemoveChildren(d ...*Doc) *DocUpdateOne

RemoveChildren removes "children" edges to Doc entities.

func (*DocUpdateOne) RemoveRelated

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) RemoveRelated(d ...*Doc) *DocUpdateOne

RemoveRelated removes "related" edges to Doc entities.

func (*DocUpdateOne) RemoveRelatedIDs

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) RemoveRelatedIDs(ids ...schema.DocID) *DocUpdateOne

RemoveRelatedIDs removes the "related" edge to Doc entities by IDs.

func (*DocUpdateOne) Save

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Doc, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated Doc entity.

func (*DocUpdateOne) SaveX

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Doc

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocUpdateOne) Select

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *DocUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

func (*DocUpdateOne) SetNillableParentID

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) SetNillableParentID(id *schema.DocID) *DocUpdateOne

SetNillableParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Doc entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*DocUpdateOne) SetNillableText

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) SetNillableText(s *string) *DocUpdateOne

SetNillableText sets the "text" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*DocUpdateOne) SetParent

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) SetParent(d *Doc) *DocUpdateOne

SetParent sets the "parent" edge to the Doc entity.

func (*DocUpdateOne) SetParentID

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) SetParentID(id schema.DocID) *DocUpdateOne

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Doc entity by ID.

func (*DocUpdateOne) SetText

func (duo *DocUpdateOne) SetText(s string) *DocUpdateOne

SetText sets the "text" field.

type DocUpsert

type DocUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

DocUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

func (*DocUpsert) ClearText

func (u *DocUpsert) ClearText() *DocUpsert

ClearText clears the value of the "text" field.

func (*DocUpsert) SetText

func (u *DocUpsert) SetText(v string) *DocUpsert

SetText sets the "text" field.

func (*DocUpsert) UpdateText

func (u *DocUpsert) UpdateText() *DocUpsert

UpdateText sets the "text" field to the value that was provided on create.

type DocUpsertBulk

type DocUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DocUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of Doc nodes.

func (*DocUpsertBulk) ClearText

func (u *DocUpsertBulk) ClearText() *DocUpsertBulk

ClearText clears the value of the "text" field.

func (*DocUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *DocUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *DocUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*DocUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *DocUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*DocUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *DocUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocUpsertBulk) Ignore

func (u *DocUpsertBulk) Ignore() *DocUpsertBulk

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Doc.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*DocUpsertBulk) SetText

func (u *DocUpsertBulk) SetText(v string) *DocUpsertBulk

SetText sets the "text" field.

func (*DocUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *DocUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*DocUpsert)) *DocUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the DocCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*DocUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *DocUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *DocUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Doc.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(doc.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*DocUpsertBulk) UpdateText

func (u *DocUpsertBulk) UpdateText() *DocUpsertBulk

UpdateText sets the "text" field to the value that was provided on create.

type DocUpsertOne

type DocUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

DocUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one Doc node.

func (*DocUpsertOne) ClearText

func (u *DocUpsertOne) ClearText() *DocUpsertOne

ClearText clears the value of the "text" field.

func (*DocUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *DocUpsertOne) DoNothing() *DocUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*DocUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *DocUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*DocUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *DocUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocUpsertOne) ID

func (u *DocUpsertOne) ID(ctx context.Context) (id schema.DocID, err error)

Exec executes the UPSERT query and returns the inserted/updated ID.

func (*DocUpsertOne) IDX

func (u *DocUpsertOne) IDX(ctx context.Context) schema.DocID

IDX is like ID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*DocUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *DocUpsertOne) Ignore() *DocUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Doc.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*DocUpsertOne) SetText

func (u *DocUpsertOne) SetText(v string) *DocUpsertOne

SetText sets the "text" field.

func (*DocUpsertOne) Update

func (u *DocUpsertOne) Update(set func(*DocUpsert)) *DocUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the DocCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*DocUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *DocUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *DocUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create except the ID field. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Doc.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(doc.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*DocUpsertOne) UpdateText

func (u *DocUpsertOne) UpdateText() *DocUpsertOne

UpdateText sets the "text" field to the value that was provided on create.

type Docs

type Docs []*Doc

Docs is a parsable slice of Doc.

type Group

type Group struct {

	// ID of the ent.
	ID int `json:"oid,omitempty"`
	// Edges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.
	// The values are being populated by the GroupQuery when eager-loading is set.
	Edges GroupEdges `json:"edges"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Group is the model entity for the Group schema.

func (*Group) QueryUsers

func (gr *Group) QueryUsers() *UserQuery

QueryUsers queries the "users" edge of the Group entity.

func (*Group) String

func (gr *Group) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*Group) Unwrap

func (gr *Group) Unwrap() *Group

Unwrap unwraps the Group entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*Group) Update

func (gr *Group) Update() *GroupUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this Group. Note that you need to call Group.Unwrap() before calling this method if this Group was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type GroupClient

type GroupClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GroupClient is a client for the Group schema.

func NewGroupClient

func NewGroupClient(c config) *GroupClient

NewGroupClient returns a client for the Group from the given config.

func (*GroupClient) Create

func (c *GroupClient) Create() *GroupCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a Group entity.

func (*GroupClient) CreateBulk

func (c *GroupClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*GroupCreate) *GroupCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of Group entities.

func (*GroupClient) Delete

func (c *GroupClient) Delete() *GroupDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for Group.

func (*GroupClient) DeleteOne

func (c *GroupClient) DeleteOne(gr *Group) *GroupDeleteOne

DeleteOne returns a builder for deleting the given entity.

func (*GroupClient) DeleteOneID

func (c *GroupClient) DeleteOneID(id int) *GroupDeleteOne

DeleteOneID returns a builder for deleting the given entity by its id.

func (*GroupClient) Get

func (c *GroupClient) Get(ctx context.Context, id int) (*Group, error)

Get returns a Group entity by its id.

func (*GroupClient) GetX

func (c *GroupClient) GetX(ctx context.Context, id int) *Group

GetX is like Get, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupClient) Hooks

func (c *GroupClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*GroupClient) Intercept

func (c *GroupClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `group.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*GroupClient) Interceptors

func (c *GroupClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*GroupClient) Query

func (c *GroupClient) Query() *GroupQuery

Query returns a query builder for Group.

func (*GroupClient) QueryUsers

func (c *GroupClient) QueryUsers(gr *Group) *UserQuery

QueryUsers queries the users edge of a Group.

func (*GroupClient) Update

func (c *GroupClient) Update() *GroupUpdate

Update returns an update builder for Group.

func (*GroupClient) UpdateOne

func (c *GroupClient) UpdateOne(gr *Group) *GroupUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*GroupClient) UpdateOneID

func (c *GroupClient) UpdateOneID(id int) *GroupUpdateOne

UpdateOneID returns an update builder for the given id.

func (*GroupClient) Use

func (c *GroupClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `group.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type GroupCreate

type GroupCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GroupCreate is the builder for creating a Group entity.

func (*GroupCreate) AddUserIDs

func (gc *GroupCreate) AddUserIDs(ids ...int) *GroupCreate

AddUserIDs adds the "users" edge to the User entity by IDs.

func (*GroupCreate) AddUsers

func (gc *GroupCreate) AddUsers(u ...*User) *GroupCreate

AddUsers adds the "users" edges to the User entity.

func (*GroupCreate) Exec

func (gc *GroupCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*GroupCreate) ExecX

func (gc *GroupCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupCreate) Mutation

func (gc *GroupCreate) Mutation() *GroupMutation

Mutation returns the GroupMutation object of the builder.

func (*GroupCreate) OnConflict

func (gc *GroupCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *GroupUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Group.Create().
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*GroupCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (gc *GroupCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *GroupUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Group.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*GroupCreate) Save

func (gc *GroupCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Group, error)

Save creates the Group in the database.

func (*GroupCreate) SaveX

func (gc *GroupCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Group

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*GroupCreate) SetID

func (gc *GroupCreate) SetID(i int) *GroupCreate

SetID sets the "id" field.

type GroupCreateBulk

type GroupCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GroupCreateBulk is the builder for creating many Group entities in bulk.

func (*GroupCreateBulk) Exec

func (gcb *GroupCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*GroupCreateBulk) ExecX

func (gcb *GroupCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (gcb *GroupCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *GroupUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Group.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*GroupCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (gcb *GroupCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *GroupUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Group.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*GroupCreateBulk) Save

func (gcb *GroupCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*Group, error)

Save creates the Group entities in the database.

func (*GroupCreateBulk) SaveX

func (gcb *GroupCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*Group

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type GroupDelete

type GroupDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GroupDelete is the builder for deleting a Group entity.

func (*GroupDelete) Exec

func (gd *GroupDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*GroupDelete) ExecX

func (gd *GroupDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupDelete) Where

func (gd *GroupDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.Group) *GroupDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the GroupDelete builder.

type GroupDeleteOne

type GroupDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GroupDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single Group entity.

func (*GroupDeleteOne) Exec

func (gdo *GroupDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*GroupDeleteOne) ExecX

func (gdo *GroupDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type GroupEdges

type GroupEdges struct {
	// Users holds the value of the users edge.
	Users []*User `json:"users,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GroupEdges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.

func (GroupEdges) UsersOrErr

func (e GroupEdges) UsersOrErr() ([]*User, error)

UsersOrErr returns the Users value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading.

type GroupFilter

type GroupFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GroupFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for GroupQuery.

func (*GroupFilter) Where

func (f *GroupFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*GroupFilter) WhereHasUsers

func (f *GroupFilter) WhereHasUsers()

WhereHasUsers applies a predicate to check if query has an edge users.

func (*GroupFilter) WhereHasUsersWith

func (f *GroupFilter) WhereHasUsersWith(preds ...predicate.User)

WhereHasUsersWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge users with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*GroupFilter) WhereID

func (f *GroupFilter) WhereID(p entql.IntP)

WhereID applies the entql int predicate on the id field.

type GroupGroupBy

type GroupGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GroupGroupBy is the group-by builder for Group entities.

func (*GroupGroupBy) Aggregate

func (ggb *GroupGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *GroupGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*GroupGroupBy) Bool

func (s *GroupGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*GroupGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *GroupGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupGroupBy) Bools

func (s *GroupGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*GroupGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *GroupGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupGroupBy) Float64

func (s *GroupGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*GroupGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *GroupGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *GroupGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*GroupGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *GroupGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupGroupBy) Int

func (s *GroupGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*GroupGroupBy) IntX

func (s *GroupGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupGroupBy) Ints

func (s *GroupGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*GroupGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *GroupGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupGroupBy) Scan

func (ggb *GroupGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*GroupGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *GroupGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupGroupBy) String

func (s *GroupGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*GroupGroupBy) StringX

func (s *GroupGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupGroupBy) Strings

func (s *GroupGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*GroupGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *GroupGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type GroupMutation

type GroupMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GroupMutation represents an operation that mutates the Group nodes in the graph.

func (*GroupMutation) AddField

func (m *GroupMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*GroupMutation) AddUserIDs

func (m *GroupMutation) AddUserIDs(ids ...int)

AddUserIDs adds the "users" edge to the User entity by ids.

func (*GroupMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *GroupMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*GroupMutation) AddedField

func (m *GroupMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*GroupMutation) AddedFields

func (m *GroupMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*GroupMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *GroupMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*GroupMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *GroupMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*GroupMutation) ClearField

func (m *GroupMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*GroupMutation) ClearUsers

func (m *GroupMutation) ClearUsers()

ClearUsers clears the "users" edge to the User entity.

func (*GroupMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *GroupMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*GroupMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *GroupMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (GroupMutation) Client

func (m GroupMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*GroupMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *GroupMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*GroupMutation) Field

func (m *GroupMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*GroupMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *GroupMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*GroupMutation) Fields

func (m *GroupMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*GroupMutation) Filter

func (m *GroupMutation) Filter() *GroupFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the GroupMutation builder.

func (*GroupMutation) ID

func (m *GroupMutation) ID() (id int, exists bool)

ID returns the ID value in the mutation. Note that the ID is only available if it was provided to the builder or after it was returned from the database.

func (*GroupMutation) IDs

func (m *GroupMutation) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

IDs queries the database and returns the entity ids that match the mutation's predicate. That means, if the mutation is applied within a transaction with an isolation level such as sql.LevelSerializable, the returned ids match the ids of the rows that will be updated or updated by the mutation.

func (*GroupMutation) OldField

func (m *GroupMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*GroupMutation) Op

func (m *GroupMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*GroupMutation) RemoveUserIDs

func (m *GroupMutation) RemoveUserIDs(ids ...int)

RemoveUserIDs removes the "users" edge to the User entity by IDs.

func (*GroupMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *GroupMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*GroupMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *GroupMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*GroupMutation) RemovedUsersIDs

func (m *GroupMutation) RemovedUsersIDs() (ids []int)

RemovedUsers returns the removed IDs of the "users" edge to the User entity.

func (*GroupMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *GroupMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*GroupMutation) ResetField

func (m *GroupMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*GroupMutation) ResetUsers

func (m *GroupMutation) ResetUsers()

ResetUsers resets all changes to the "users" edge.

func (*GroupMutation) SetField

func (m *GroupMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*GroupMutation) SetID

func (m *GroupMutation) SetID(id int)

SetID sets the value of the id field. Note that this operation is only accepted on creation of Group entities.

func (*GroupMutation) SetOp

func (m *GroupMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (GroupMutation) Tx

func (m GroupMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*GroupMutation) Type

func (m *GroupMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (Group).

func (*GroupMutation) UsersCleared

func (m *GroupMutation) UsersCleared() bool

UsersCleared reports if the "users" edge to the User entity was cleared.

func (*GroupMutation) UsersIDs

func (m *GroupMutation) UsersIDs() (ids []int)

UsersIDs returns the "users" edge IDs in the mutation.

func (*GroupMutation) Where

func (m *GroupMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.Group)

Where appends a list predicates to the GroupMutation builder.

func (*GroupMutation) WhereP

func (m *GroupMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the GroupMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type GroupQuery

type GroupQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GroupQuery is the builder for querying Group entities.

func (*GroupQuery) Aggregate

func (gq *GroupQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *GroupSelect

Aggregate returns a GroupSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*GroupQuery) All

func (gq *GroupQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*Group, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of Groups.

func (*GroupQuery) AllX

func (gq *GroupQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*Group

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupQuery) Clone

func (gq *GroupQuery) Clone() *GroupQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the GroupQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*GroupQuery) Count

func (gq *GroupQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*GroupQuery) CountX

func (gq *GroupQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupQuery) Exist

func (gq *GroupQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*GroupQuery) ExistX

func (gq *GroupQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupQuery) Filter

func (gq *GroupQuery) Filter() *GroupFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the GroupQuery builder.

func (*GroupQuery) First

func (gq *GroupQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*Group, error)

First returns the first Group entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Group was found.

func (*GroupQuery) FirstID

func (gq *GroupQuery) FirstID(ctx context.Context) (id int, err error)

FirstID returns the first Group ID from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Group ID was found.

func (*GroupQuery) FirstIDX

func (gq *GroupQuery) FirstIDX(ctx context.Context) int

FirstIDX is like FirstID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupQuery) FirstX

func (gq *GroupQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *Group

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupQuery) GroupBy

func (gq *GroupQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *GroupGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

func (*GroupQuery) IDs

func (gq *GroupQuery) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

IDs executes the query and returns a list of Group IDs.

func (*GroupQuery) IDsX

func (gq *GroupQuery) IDsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IDsX is like IDs, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupQuery) Limit

func (gq *GroupQuery) Limit(limit int) *GroupQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*GroupQuery) Offset

func (gq *GroupQuery) Offset(offset int) *GroupQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*GroupQuery) Only

func (gq *GroupQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*Group, error)

Only returns a single Group entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Group entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Group entities are found.

func (*GroupQuery) OnlyID

func (gq *GroupQuery) OnlyID(ctx context.Context) (id int, err error)

OnlyID is like Only, but returns the only Group ID in the query. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Group ID is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no entities are found.

func (*GroupQuery) OnlyIDX

func (gq *GroupQuery) OnlyIDX(ctx context.Context) int

OnlyIDX is like OnlyID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupQuery) OnlyX

func (gq *GroupQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *Group

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupQuery) Order

func (gq *GroupQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *GroupQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (*GroupQuery) QueryUsers

func (gq *GroupQuery) QueryUsers() *UserQuery

QueryUsers chains the current query on the "users" edge.

func (*GroupQuery) Select

func (gq *GroupQuery) Select(fields ...string) *GroupSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

func (*GroupQuery) Unique

func (gq *GroupQuery) Unique(unique bool) *GroupQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*GroupQuery) Where

func (gq *GroupQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.Group) *GroupQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the GroupQuery builder.

func (*GroupQuery) WithUsers

func (gq *GroupQuery) WithUsers(opts ...func(*UserQuery)) *GroupQuery

WithUsers tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "users" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

type GroupSelect

type GroupSelect struct {
	*GroupQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GroupSelect is the builder for selecting fields of Group entities.

func (*GroupSelect) Aggregate

func (gs *GroupSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *GroupSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*GroupSelect) Bool

func (s *GroupSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*GroupSelect) BoolX

func (s *GroupSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupSelect) Bools

func (s *GroupSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*GroupSelect) BoolsX

func (s *GroupSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupSelect) Float64

func (s *GroupSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*GroupSelect) Float64X

func (s *GroupSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupSelect) Float64s

func (s *GroupSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*GroupSelect) Float64sX

func (s *GroupSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupSelect) Int

func (s *GroupSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*GroupSelect) IntX

func (s *GroupSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupSelect) Ints

func (s *GroupSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*GroupSelect) IntsX

func (s *GroupSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupSelect) Scan

func (gs *GroupSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*GroupSelect) ScanX

func (s *GroupSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupSelect) String

func (s *GroupSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*GroupSelect) StringX

func (s *GroupSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupSelect) Strings

func (s *GroupSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*GroupSelect) StringsX

func (s *GroupSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type GroupUpdate

type GroupUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GroupUpdate is the builder for updating Group entities.

func (*GroupUpdate) AddUserIDs

func (gu *GroupUpdate) AddUserIDs(ids ...int) *GroupUpdate

AddUserIDs adds the "users" edge to the User entity by IDs.

func (*GroupUpdate) AddUsers

func (gu *GroupUpdate) AddUsers(u ...*User) *GroupUpdate

AddUsers adds the "users" edges to the User entity.

func (*GroupUpdate) ClearUsers

func (gu *GroupUpdate) ClearUsers() *GroupUpdate

ClearUsers clears all "users" edges to the User entity.

func (*GroupUpdate) Exec

func (gu *GroupUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*GroupUpdate) ExecX

func (gu *GroupUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupUpdate) Mutation

func (gu *GroupUpdate) Mutation() *GroupMutation

Mutation returns the GroupMutation object of the builder.

func (*GroupUpdate) RemoveUserIDs

func (gu *GroupUpdate) RemoveUserIDs(ids ...int) *GroupUpdate

RemoveUserIDs removes the "users" edge to User entities by IDs.

func (*GroupUpdate) RemoveUsers

func (gu *GroupUpdate) RemoveUsers(u ...*User) *GroupUpdate

RemoveUsers removes "users" edges to User entities.

func (*GroupUpdate) Save

func (gu *GroupUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*GroupUpdate) SaveX

func (gu *GroupUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupUpdate) Where

func (gu *GroupUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.Group) *GroupUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the GroupUpdate builder.

type GroupUpdateOne

type GroupUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GroupUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single Group entity.

func (*GroupUpdateOne) AddUserIDs

func (guo *GroupUpdateOne) AddUserIDs(ids ...int) *GroupUpdateOne

AddUserIDs adds the "users" edge to the User entity by IDs.

func (*GroupUpdateOne) AddUsers

func (guo *GroupUpdateOne) AddUsers(u ...*User) *GroupUpdateOne

AddUsers adds the "users" edges to the User entity.

func (*GroupUpdateOne) ClearUsers

func (guo *GroupUpdateOne) ClearUsers() *GroupUpdateOne

ClearUsers clears all "users" edges to the User entity.

func (*GroupUpdateOne) Exec

func (guo *GroupUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*GroupUpdateOne) ExecX

func (guo *GroupUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupUpdateOne) Mutation

func (guo *GroupUpdateOne) Mutation() *GroupMutation

Mutation returns the GroupMutation object of the builder.

func (*GroupUpdateOne) RemoveUserIDs

func (guo *GroupUpdateOne) RemoveUserIDs(ids ...int) *GroupUpdateOne

RemoveUserIDs removes the "users" edge to User entities by IDs.

func (*GroupUpdateOne) RemoveUsers

func (guo *GroupUpdateOne) RemoveUsers(u ...*User) *GroupUpdateOne

RemoveUsers removes "users" edges to User entities.

func (*GroupUpdateOne) Save

func (guo *GroupUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Group, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated Group entity.

func (*GroupUpdateOne) SaveX

func (guo *GroupUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Group

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupUpdateOne) Select

func (guo *GroupUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *GroupUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

type GroupUpsert

type GroupUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

GroupUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

type GroupUpsertBulk

type GroupUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GroupUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of Group nodes.

func (*GroupUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *GroupUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *GroupUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*GroupUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *GroupUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*GroupUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *GroupUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupUpsertBulk) Ignore

func (u *GroupUpsertBulk) Ignore() *GroupUpsertBulk

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Group.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*GroupUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *GroupUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*GroupUpsert)) *GroupUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the GroupCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*GroupUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *GroupUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *GroupUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Group.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(group.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type GroupUpsertOne

type GroupUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

GroupUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one Group node.

func (*GroupUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *GroupUpsertOne) DoNothing() *GroupUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*GroupUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *GroupUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*GroupUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *GroupUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupUpsertOne) ID

func (u *GroupUpsertOne) ID(ctx context.Context) (id int, err error)

Exec executes the UPSERT query and returns the inserted/updated ID.

func (*GroupUpsertOne) IDX

func (u *GroupUpsertOne) IDX(ctx context.Context) int

IDX is like ID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*GroupUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *GroupUpsertOne) Ignore() *GroupUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Group.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*GroupUpsertOne) Update

func (u *GroupUpsertOne) Update(set func(*GroupUpsert)) *GroupUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the GroupCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*GroupUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *GroupUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *GroupUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create except the ID field. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Group.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(group.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type Groups

type Groups []*Group

Groups is a parsable slice of Group.

type Hook

type Hook = ent.Hook

ent aliases to avoid import conflicts in user's code.

type IntSID

type IntSID struct {

	// ID of the ent.
	ID sid.ID `json:"id,omitempty"`
	// Edges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.
	// The values are being populated by the IntSIDQuery when eager-loading is set.
	Edges IntSIDEdges `json:"edges"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

IntSID is the model entity for the IntSID schema.

func (*IntSID) QueryChildren

func (is *IntSID) QueryChildren() *IntSIDQuery

QueryChildren queries the "children" edge of the IntSID entity.

func (*IntSID) QueryParent

func (is *IntSID) QueryParent() *IntSIDQuery

QueryParent queries the "parent" edge of the IntSID entity.

func (*IntSID) String

func (is *IntSID) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*IntSID) Unwrap

func (is *IntSID) Unwrap() *IntSID

Unwrap unwraps the IntSID entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*IntSID) Update

func (is *IntSID) Update() *IntSIDUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this IntSID. Note that you need to call IntSID.Unwrap() before calling this method if this IntSID was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type IntSIDClient

type IntSIDClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

IntSIDClient is a client for the IntSID schema.

func NewIntSIDClient

func NewIntSIDClient(c config) *IntSIDClient

NewIntSIDClient returns a client for the IntSID from the given config.

func (*IntSIDClient) Create

func (c *IntSIDClient) Create() *IntSIDCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDClient) CreateBulk

func (c *IntSIDClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*IntSIDCreate) *IntSIDCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of IntSID entities.

func (*IntSIDClient) Delete

func (c *IntSIDClient) Delete() *IntSIDDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for IntSID.

func (*IntSIDClient) DeleteOne

func (c *IntSIDClient) DeleteOne(is *IntSID) *IntSIDDeleteOne

DeleteOne returns a builder for deleting the given entity.

func (*IntSIDClient) DeleteOneID

func (c *IntSIDClient) DeleteOneID(id sid.ID) *IntSIDDeleteOne

DeleteOneID returns a builder for deleting the given entity by its id.

func (*IntSIDClient) Get

func (c *IntSIDClient) Get(ctx context.Context, id sid.ID) (*IntSID, error)

Get returns a IntSID entity by its id.

func (*IntSIDClient) GetX

func (c *IntSIDClient) GetX(ctx context.Context, id sid.ID) *IntSID

GetX is like Get, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDClient) Hooks

func (c *IntSIDClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*IntSIDClient) Intercept

func (c *IntSIDClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `intsid.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*IntSIDClient) Interceptors

func (c *IntSIDClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*IntSIDClient) Query

func (c *IntSIDClient) Query() *IntSIDQuery

Query returns a query builder for IntSID.

func (*IntSIDClient) QueryChildren

func (c *IntSIDClient) QueryChildren(is *IntSID) *IntSIDQuery

QueryChildren queries the children edge of a IntSID.

func (*IntSIDClient) QueryParent

func (c *IntSIDClient) QueryParent(is *IntSID) *IntSIDQuery

QueryParent queries the parent edge of a IntSID.

func (*IntSIDClient) Update

func (c *IntSIDClient) Update() *IntSIDUpdate

Update returns an update builder for IntSID.

func (*IntSIDClient) UpdateOne

func (c *IntSIDClient) UpdateOne(is *IntSID) *IntSIDUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*IntSIDClient) UpdateOneID

func (c *IntSIDClient) UpdateOneID(id sid.ID) *IntSIDUpdateOne

UpdateOneID returns an update builder for the given id.

func (*IntSIDClient) Use

func (c *IntSIDClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `intsid.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type IntSIDCreate

type IntSIDCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

IntSIDCreate is the builder for creating a IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDCreate) AddChildIDs

func (isc *IntSIDCreate) AddChildIDs(ids ...sid.ID) *IntSIDCreate

AddChildIDs adds the "children" edge to the IntSID entity by IDs.

func (*IntSIDCreate) AddChildren

func (isc *IntSIDCreate) AddChildren(i ...*IntSID) *IntSIDCreate

AddChildren adds the "children" edges to the IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDCreate) Exec

func (isc *IntSIDCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*IntSIDCreate) ExecX

func (isc *IntSIDCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDCreate) Mutation

func (isc *IntSIDCreate) Mutation() *IntSIDMutation

Mutation returns the IntSIDMutation object of the builder.

func (*IntSIDCreate) OnConflict

func (isc *IntSIDCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *IntSIDUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.IntSID.Create().
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*IntSIDCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (isc *IntSIDCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *IntSIDUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.IntSID.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*IntSIDCreate) Save

func (isc *IntSIDCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*IntSID, error)

Save creates the IntSID in the database.

func (*IntSIDCreate) SaveX

func (isc *IntSIDCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *IntSID

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*IntSIDCreate) SetID

func (isc *IntSIDCreate) SetID(s sid.ID) *IntSIDCreate

SetID sets the "id" field.

func (*IntSIDCreate) SetNillableParentID

func (isc *IntSIDCreate) SetNillableParentID(id *sid.ID) *IntSIDCreate

SetNillableParentID sets the "parent" edge to the IntSID entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*IntSIDCreate) SetParent

func (isc *IntSIDCreate) SetParent(i *IntSID) *IntSIDCreate

SetParent sets the "parent" edge to the IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDCreate) SetParentID

func (isc *IntSIDCreate) SetParentID(id sid.ID) *IntSIDCreate

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the IntSID entity by ID.

type IntSIDCreateBulk

type IntSIDCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

IntSIDCreateBulk is the builder for creating many IntSID entities in bulk.

func (*IntSIDCreateBulk) Exec

func (iscb *IntSIDCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*IntSIDCreateBulk) ExecX

func (iscb *IntSIDCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (iscb *IntSIDCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *IntSIDUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.IntSID.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*IntSIDCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (iscb *IntSIDCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *IntSIDUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.IntSID.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*IntSIDCreateBulk) Save

func (iscb *IntSIDCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*IntSID, error)

Save creates the IntSID entities in the database.

func (*IntSIDCreateBulk) SaveX

func (iscb *IntSIDCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*IntSID

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type IntSIDDelete

type IntSIDDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

IntSIDDelete is the builder for deleting a IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDDelete) Exec

func (isd *IntSIDDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*IntSIDDelete) ExecX

func (isd *IntSIDDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDDelete) Where

func (isd *IntSIDDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.IntSID) *IntSIDDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the IntSIDDelete builder.

type IntSIDDeleteOne

type IntSIDDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

IntSIDDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDDeleteOne) Exec

func (isdo *IntSIDDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*IntSIDDeleteOne) ExecX

func (isdo *IntSIDDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type IntSIDEdges

type IntSIDEdges struct {
	// Parent holds the value of the parent edge.
	Parent *IntSID `json:"parent,omitempty"`
	// Children holds the value of the children edge.
	Children []*IntSID `json:"children,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

IntSIDEdges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.

func (IntSIDEdges) ChildrenOrErr

func (e IntSIDEdges) ChildrenOrErr() ([]*IntSID, error)

ChildrenOrErr returns the Children value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading.

func (IntSIDEdges) ParentOrErr

func (e IntSIDEdges) ParentOrErr() (*IntSID, error)

ParentOrErr returns the Parent value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading, or loaded but was not found.

type IntSIDFilter

type IntSIDFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

IntSIDFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for IntSIDQuery.

func (*IntSIDFilter) Where

func (f *IntSIDFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*IntSIDFilter) WhereHasChildren

func (f *IntSIDFilter) WhereHasChildren()

WhereHasChildren applies a predicate to check if query has an edge children.

func (*IntSIDFilter) WhereHasChildrenWith

func (f *IntSIDFilter) WhereHasChildrenWith(preds ...predicate.IntSID)

WhereHasChildrenWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge children with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*IntSIDFilter) WhereHasParent

func (f *IntSIDFilter) WhereHasParent()

WhereHasParent applies a predicate to check if query has an edge parent.

func (*IntSIDFilter) WhereHasParentWith

func (f *IntSIDFilter) WhereHasParentWith(preds ...predicate.IntSID)

WhereHasParentWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge parent with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*IntSIDFilter) WhereID

func (f *IntSIDFilter) WhereID(p entql.Int64P)

WhereID applies the entql int64 predicate on the id field.

type IntSIDGroupBy

type IntSIDGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

IntSIDGroupBy is the group-by builder for IntSID entities.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) Aggregate

func (isgb *IntSIDGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *IntSIDGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) Bool

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) Bools

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) Float64

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) Int

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) IntX

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) Ints

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) Scan

func (isgb *IntSIDGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) String

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) StringX

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) Strings

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*IntSIDGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *IntSIDGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type IntSIDMutation

type IntSIDMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

IntSIDMutation represents an operation that mutates the IntSID nodes in the graph.

func (*IntSIDMutation) AddChildIDs

func (m *IntSIDMutation) AddChildIDs(ids ...sid.ID)

AddChildIDs adds the "children" edge to the IntSID entity by ids.

func (*IntSIDMutation) AddField

func (m *IntSIDMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*IntSIDMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *IntSIDMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*IntSIDMutation) AddedField

func (m *IntSIDMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*IntSIDMutation) AddedFields

func (m *IntSIDMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*IntSIDMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *IntSIDMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*IntSIDMutation) ChildrenCleared

func (m *IntSIDMutation) ChildrenCleared() bool

ChildrenCleared reports if the "children" edge to the IntSID entity was cleared.

func (*IntSIDMutation) ChildrenIDs

func (m *IntSIDMutation) ChildrenIDs() (ids []sid.ID)

ChildrenIDs returns the "children" edge IDs in the mutation.

func (*IntSIDMutation) ClearChildren

func (m *IntSIDMutation) ClearChildren()

ClearChildren clears the "children" edge to the IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *IntSIDMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*IntSIDMutation) ClearField

func (m *IntSIDMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*IntSIDMutation) ClearParent

func (m *IntSIDMutation) ClearParent()

ClearParent clears the "parent" edge to the IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *IntSIDMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*IntSIDMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *IntSIDMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (IntSIDMutation) Client

func (m IntSIDMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*IntSIDMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *IntSIDMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*IntSIDMutation) Field

func (m *IntSIDMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*IntSIDMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *IntSIDMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*IntSIDMutation) Fields

func (m *IntSIDMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*IntSIDMutation) Filter

func (m *IntSIDMutation) Filter() *IntSIDFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the IntSIDMutation builder.

func (*IntSIDMutation) ID

func (m *IntSIDMutation) ID() (id sid.ID, exists bool)

ID returns the ID value in the mutation. Note that the ID is only available if it was provided to the builder or after it was returned from the database.

func (*IntSIDMutation) IDs

func (m *IntSIDMutation) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]sid.ID, error)

IDs queries the database and returns the entity ids that match the mutation's predicate. That means, if the mutation is applied within a transaction with an isolation level such as sql.LevelSerializable, the returned ids match the ids of the rows that will be updated or updated by the mutation.

func (*IntSIDMutation) OldField

func (m *IntSIDMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*IntSIDMutation) Op

func (m *IntSIDMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*IntSIDMutation) ParentCleared

func (m *IntSIDMutation) ParentCleared() bool

ParentCleared reports if the "parent" edge to the IntSID entity was cleared.

func (*IntSIDMutation) ParentID

func (m *IntSIDMutation) ParentID() (id sid.ID, exists bool)

ParentID returns the "parent" edge ID in the mutation.

func (*IntSIDMutation) ParentIDs

func (m *IntSIDMutation) ParentIDs() (ids []sid.ID)

ParentIDs returns the "parent" edge IDs in the mutation. Note that IDs always returns len(IDs) <= 1 for unique edges, and you should use ParentID instead. It exists only for internal usage by the builders.

func (*IntSIDMutation) RemoveChildIDs

func (m *IntSIDMutation) RemoveChildIDs(ids ...sid.ID)

RemoveChildIDs removes the "children" edge to the IntSID entity by IDs.

func (*IntSIDMutation) RemovedChildrenIDs

func (m *IntSIDMutation) RemovedChildrenIDs() (ids []sid.ID)

RemovedChildren returns the removed IDs of the "children" edge to the IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *IntSIDMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*IntSIDMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *IntSIDMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*IntSIDMutation) ResetChildren

func (m *IntSIDMutation) ResetChildren()

ResetChildren resets all changes to the "children" edge.

func (*IntSIDMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *IntSIDMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*IntSIDMutation) ResetField

func (m *IntSIDMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*IntSIDMutation) ResetParent

func (m *IntSIDMutation) ResetParent()

ResetParent resets all changes to the "parent" edge.

func (*IntSIDMutation) SetField

func (m *IntSIDMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*IntSIDMutation) SetID

func (m *IntSIDMutation) SetID(id sid.ID)

SetID sets the value of the id field. Note that this operation is only accepted on creation of IntSID entities.

func (*IntSIDMutation) SetOp

func (m *IntSIDMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (*IntSIDMutation) SetParentID

func (m *IntSIDMutation) SetParentID(id sid.ID)

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the IntSID entity by id.

func (IntSIDMutation) Tx

func (m IntSIDMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*IntSIDMutation) Type

func (m *IntSIDMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (IntSID).

func (*IntSIDMutation) Where

func (m *IntSIDMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.IntSID)

Where appends a list predicates to the IntSIDMutation builder.

func (*IntSIDMutation) WhereP

func (m *IntSIDMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the IntSIDMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type IntSIDQuery

type IntSIDQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

IntSIDQuery is the builder for querying IntSID entities.

func (*IntSIDQuery) Aggregate

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *IntSIDSelect

Aggregate returns a IntSIDSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*IntSIDQuery) All

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*IntSID, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of IntSIDs.

func (*IntSIDQuery) AllX

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*IntSID

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDQuery) Clone

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) Clone() *IntSIDQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the IntSIDQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*IntSIDQuery) Count

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*IntSIDQuery) CountX

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDQuery) Exist

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*IntSIDQuery) ExistX

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDQuery) Filter

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) Filter() *IntSIDFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the IntSIDQuery builder.

func (*IntSIDQuery) First

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*IntSID, error)

First returns the first IntSID entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no IntSID was found.

func (*IntSIDQuery) FirstID

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) FirstID(ctx context.Context) (id sid.ID, err error)

FirstID returns the first IntSID ID from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no IntSID ID was found.

func (*IntSIDQuery) FirstIDX

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) FirstIDX(ctx context.Context) sid.ID

FirstIDX is like FirstID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDQuery) FirstX

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *IntSID

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDQuery) GroupBy

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *IntSIDGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

func (*IntSIDQuery) IDs

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]sid.ID, error)

IDs executes the query and returns a list of IntSID IDs.

func (*IntSIDQuery) IDsX

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) IDsX(ctx context.Context) []sid.ID

IDsX is like IDs, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDQuery) Limit

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) Limit(limit int) *IntSIDQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*IntSIDQuery) Offset

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) Offset(offset int) *IntSIDQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*IntSIDQuery) Only

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*IntSID, error)

Only returns a single IntSID entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one IntSID entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no IntSID entities are found.

func (*IntSIDQuery) OnlyID

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) OnlyID(ctx context.Context) (id sid.ID, err error)

OnlyID is like Only, but returns the only IntSID ID in the query. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one IntSID ID is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no entities are found.

func (*IntSIDQuery) OnlyIDX

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) OnlyIDX(ctx context.Context) sid.ID

OnlyIDX is like OnlyID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDQuery) OnlyX

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *IntSID

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDQuery) Order

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *IntSIDQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (*IntSIDQuery) QueryChildren

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) QueryChildren() *IntSIDQuery

QueryChildren chains the current query on the "children" edge.

func (*IntSIDQuery) QueryParent

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) QueryParent() *IntSIDQuery

QueryParent chains the current query on the "parent" edge.

func (*IntSIDQuery) Select

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) Select(fields ...string) *IntSIDSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

func (*IntSIDQuery) Unique

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) Unique(unique bool) *IntSIDQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*IntSIDQuery) Where

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.IntSID) *IntSIDQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the IntSIDQuery builder.

func (*IntSIDQuery) WithChildren

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) WithChildren(opts ...func(*IntSIDQuery)) *IntSIDQuery

WithChildren tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "children" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

func (*IntSIDQuery) WithParent

func (isq *IntSIDQuery) WithParent(opts ...func(*IntSIDQuery)) *IntSIDQuery

WithParent tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "parent" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

type IntSIDSelect

type IntSIDSelect struct {
	*IntSIDQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

IntSIDSelect is the builder for selecting fields of IntSID entities.

func (*IntSIDSelect) Aggregate

func (iss *IntSIDSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *IntSIDSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*IntSIDSelect) Bool

func (s *IntSIDSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*IntSIDSelect) BoolX

func (s *IntSIDSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDSelect) Bools

func (s *IntSIDSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*IntSIDSelect) BoolsX

func (s *IntSIDSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDSelect) Float64

func (s *IntSIDSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*IntSIDSelect) Float64X

func (s *IntSIDSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDSelect) Float64s

func (s *IntSIDSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*IntSIDSelect) Float64sX

func (s *IntSIDSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDSelect) Int

func (s *IntSIDSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*IntSIDSelect) IntX

func (s *IntSIDSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDSelect) Ints

func (s *IntSIDSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*IntSIDSelect) IntsX

func (s *IntSIDSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDSelect) Scan

func (iss *IntSIDSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*IntSIDSelect) ScanX

func (s *IntSIDSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDSelect) String

func (s *IntSIDSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*IntSIDSelect) StringX

func (s *IntSIDSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDSelect) Strings

func (s *IntSIDSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*IntSIDSelect) StringsX

func (s *IntSIDSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type IntSIDUpdate

type IntSIDUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

IntSIDUpdate is the builder for updating IntSID entities.

func (*IntSIDUpdate) AddChildIDs

func (isu *IntSIDUpdate) AddChildIDs(ids ...sid.ID) *IntSIDUpdate

AddChildIDs adds the "children" edge to the IntSID entity by IDs.

func (*IntSIDUpdate) AddChildren

func (isu *IntSIDUpdate) AddChildren(i ...*IntSID) *IntSIDUpdate

AddChildren adds the "children" edges to the IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDUpdate) ClearChildren

func (isu *IntSIDUpdate) ClearChildren() *IntSIDUpdate

ClearChildren clears all "children" edges to the IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDUpdate) ClearParent

func (isu *IntSIDUpdate) ClearParent() *IntSIDUpdate

ClearParent clears the "parent" edge to the IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDUpdate) Exec

func (isu *IntSIDUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*IntSIDUpdate) ExecX

func (isu *IntSIDUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDUpdate) Mutation

func (isu *IntSIDUpdate) Mutation() *IntSIDMutation

Mutation returns the IntSIDMutation object of the builder.

func (*IntSIDUpdate) RemoveChildIDs

func (isu *IntSIDUpdate) RemoveChildIDs(ids ...sid.ID) *IntSIDUpdate

RemoveChildIDs removes the "children" edge to IntSID entities by IDs.

func (*IntSIDUpdate) RemoveChildren

func (isu *IntSIDUpdate) RemoveChildren(i ...*IntSID) *IntSIDUpdate

RemoveChildren removes "children" edges to IntSID entities.

func (*IntSIDUpdate) Save

func (isu *IntSIDUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*IntSIDUpdate) SaveX

func (isu *IntSIDUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDUpdate) SetNillableParentID

func (isu *IntSIDUpdate) SetNillableParentID(id *sid.ID) *IntSIDUpdate

SetNillableParentID sets the "parent" edge to the IntSID entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*IntSIDUpdate) SetParent

func (isu *IntSIDUpdate) SetParent(i *IntSID) *IntSIDUpdate

SetParent sets the "parent" edge to the IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDUpdate) SetParentID

func (isu *IntSIDUpdate) SetParentID(id sid.ID) *IntSIDUpdate

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the IntSID entity by ID.

func (*IntSIDUpdate) Where

func (isu *IntSIDUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.IntSID) *IntSIDUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the IntSIDUpdate builder.

type IntSIDUpdateOne

type IntSIDUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

IntSIDUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDUpdateOne) AddChildIDs

func (isuo *IntSIDUpdateOne) AddChildIDs(ids ...sid.ID) *IntSIDUpdateOne

AddChildIDs adds the "children" edge to the IntSID entity by IDs.

func (*IntSIDUpdateOne) AddChildren

func (isuo *IntSIDUpdateOne) AddChildren(i ...*IntSID) *IntSIDUpdateOne

AddChildren adds the "children" edges to the IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDUpdateOne) ClearChildren

func (isuo *IntSIDUpdateOne) ClearChildren() *IntSIDUpdateOne

ClearChildren clears all "children" edges to the IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDUpdateOne) ClearParent

func (isuo *IntSIDUpdateOne) ClearParent() *IntSIDUpdateOne

ClearParent clears the "parent" edge to the IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDUpdateOne) Exec

func (isuo *IntSIDUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*IntSIDUpdateOne) ExecX

func (isuo *IntSIDUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDUpdateOne) Mutation

func (isuo *IntSIDUpdateOne) Mutation() *IntSIDMutation

Mutation returns the IntSIDMutation object of the builder.

func (*IntSIDUpdateOne) RemoveChildIDs

func (isuo *IntSIDUpdateOne) RemoveChildIDs(ids ...sid.ID) *IntSIDUpdateOne

RemoveChildIDs removes the "children" edge to IntSID entities by IDs.

func (*IntSIDUpdateOne) RemoveChildren

func (isuo *IntSIDUpdateOne) RemoveChildren(i ...*IntSID) *IntSIDUpdateOne

RemoveChildren removes "children" edges to IntSID entities.

func (*IntSIDUpdateOne) Save

func (isuo *IntSIDUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*IntSID, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDUpdateOne) SaveX

func (isuo *IntSIDUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *IntSID

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDUpdateOne) Select

func (isuo *IntSIDUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *IntSIDUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

func (*IntSIDUpdateOne) SetNillableParentID

func (isuo *IntSIDUpdateOne) SetNillableParentID(id *sid.ID) *IntSIDUpdateOne

SetNillableParentID sets the "parent" edge to the IntSID entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*IntSIDUpdateOne) SetParent

func (isuo *IntSIDUpdateOne) SetParent(i *IntSID) *IntSIDUpdateOne

SetParent sets the "parent" edge to the IntSID entity.

func (*IntSIDUpdateOne) SetParentID

func (isuo *IntSIDUpdateOne) SetParentID(id sid.ID) *IntSIDUpdateOne

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the IntSID entity by ID.

type IntSIDUpsert

type IntSIDUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

IntSIDUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

type IntSIDUpsertBulk

type IntSIDUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

IntSIDUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of IntSID nodes.

func (*IntSIDUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *IntSIDUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *IntSIDUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*IntSIDUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *IntSIDUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*IntSIDUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *IntSIDUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDUpsertBulk) Ignore

func (u *IntSIDUpsertBulk) Ignore() *IntSIDUpsertBulk

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.IntSID.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*IntSIDUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *IntSIDUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*IntSIDUpsert)) *IntSIDUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the IntSIDCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*IntSIDUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *IntSIDUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *IntSIDUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.IntSID.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(intsid.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type IntSIDUpsertOne

type IntSIDUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

IntSIDUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one IntSID node.

func (*IntSIDUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *IntSIDUpsertOne) DoNothing() *IntSIDUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*IntSIDUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *IntSIDUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*IntSIDUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *IntSIDUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDUpsertOne) ID

func (u *IntSIDUpsertOne) ID(ctx context.Context) (id sid.ID, err error)

Exec executes the UPSERT query and returns the inserted/updated ID.

func (*IntSIDUpsertOne) IDX

func (u *IntSIDUpsertOne) IDX(ctx context.Context) sid.ID

IDX is like ID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*IntSIDUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *IntSIDUpsertOne) Ignore() *IntSIDUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.IntSID.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*IntSIDUpsertOne) Update

func (u *IntSIDUpsertOne) Update(set func(*IntSIDUpsert)) *IntSIDUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the IntSIDCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*IntSIDUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *IntSIDUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *IntSIDUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create except the ID field. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.IntSID.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(intsid.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type IntSIDs

type IntSIDs []*IntSID

IntSIDs is a parsable slice of IntSID.

type InterceptFunc

type InterceptFunc = ent.InterceptFunc

ent aliases to avoid import conflicts in user's code.

type Interceptor

type Interceptor = ent.Interceptor

ent aliases to avoid import conflicts in user's code.

type Link struct {

	// ID of the ent.
	ID uuidc.UUIDC `json:"id,omitempty"`
	// LinkInformation holds the value of the "link_information" field.
	LinkInformation map[string]schema.LinkInformation `json:"link_information,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Link is the model entity for the Link schema.

func (*Link) String

func (l *Link) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*Link) Unwrap

func (l *Link) Unwrap() *Link

Unwrap unwraps the Link entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*Link) Update

func (l *Link) Update() *LinkUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this Link. Note that you need to call Link.Unwrap() before calling this method if this Link was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type LinkClient

type LinkClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

LinkClient is a client for the Link schema.

func NewLinkClient

func NewLinkClient(c config) *LinkClient

NewLinkClient returns a client for the Link from the given config.

func (*LinkClient) Create

func (c *LinkClient) Create() *LinkCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a Link entity.

func (*LinkClient) CreateBulk

func (c *LinkClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*LinkCreate) *LinkCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of Link entities.

func (*LinkClient) Delete

func (c *LinkClient) Delete() *LinkDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for Link.

func (*LinkClient) DeleteOne

func (c *LinkClient) DeleteOne(l *Link) *LinkDeleteOne

DeleteOne returns a builder for deleting the given entity.

func (*LinkClient) DeleteOneID

func (c *LinkClient) DeleteOneID(id uuidc.UUIDC) *LinkDeleteOne

DeleteOneID returns a builder for deleting the given entity by its id.

func (*LinkClient) Get

func (c *LinkClient) Get(ctx context.Context, id uuidc.UUIDC) (*Link, error)

Get returns a Link entity by its id.

func (*LinkClient) GetX

func (c *LinkClient) GetX(ctx context.Context, id uuidc.UUIDC) *Link

GetX is like Get, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkClient) Hooks

func (c *LinkClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*LinkClient) Intercept

func (c *LinkClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `link.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*LinkClient) Interceptors

func (c *LinkClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*LinkClient) Query

func (c *LinkClient) Query() *LinkQuery

Query returns a query builder for Link.

func (*LinkClient) Update

func (c *LinkClient) Update() *LinkUpdate

Update returns an update builder for Link.

func (*LinkClient) UpdateOne

func (c *LinkClient) UpdateOne(l *Link) *LinkUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*LinkClient) UpdateOneID

func (c *LinkClient) UpdateOneID(id uuidc.UUIDC) *LinkUpdateOne

UpdateOneID returns an update builder for the given id.

func (*LinkClient) Use

func (c *LinkClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `link.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type LinkCreate

type LinkCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

LinkCreate is the builder for creating a Link entity.

func (*LinkCreate) Exec

func (lc *LinkCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*LinkCreate) ExecX

func (lc *LinkCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkCreate) Mutation

func (lc *LinkCreate) Mutation() *LinkMutation

Mutation returns the LinkMutation object of the builder.

func (*LinkCreate) OnConflict

func (lc *LinkCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *LinkUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Link.Create().
	SetLinkInformation(v).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.LinkUpsert) {
		SetLinkInformation(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*LinkCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (lc *LinkCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *LinkUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Link.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*LinkCreate) Save

func (lc *LinkCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Link, error)

Save creates the Link in the database.

func (*LinkCreate) SaveX

func (lc *LinkCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Link

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*LinkCreate) SetID

func (lc *LinkCreate) SetID(u uuidc.UUIDC) *LinkCreate

SetID sets the "id" field.

func (*LinkCreate) SetLinkInformation

func (lc *LinkCreate) SetLinkInformation(mi map[string]schema.LinkInformation) *LinkCreate

SetLinkInformation sets the "link_information" field.

func (*LinkCreate) SetNillableID

func (lc *LinkCreate) SetNillableID(u *uuidc.UUIDC) *LinkCreate

SetNillableID sets the "id" field if the given value is not nil.

type LinkCreateBulk

type LinkCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

LinkCreateBulk is the builder for creating many Link entities in bulk.

func (*LinkCreateBulk) Exec

func (lcb *LinkCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*LinkCreateBulk) ExecX

func (lcb *LinkCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (lcb *LinkCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *LinkUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Link.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.LinkUpsert) {
		SetLinkInformation(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*LinkCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (lcb *LinkCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *LinkUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Link.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*LinkCreateBulk) Save

func (lcb *LinkCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*Link, error)

Save creates the Link entities in the database.

func (*LinkCreateBulk) SaveX

func (lcb *LinkCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*Link

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type LinkDelete

type LinkDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

LinkDelete is the builder for deleting a Link entity.

func (*LinkDelete) Exec

func (ld *LinkDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*LinkDelete) ExecX

func (ld *LinkDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkDelete) Where

func (ld *LinkDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.Link) *LinkDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the LinkDelete builder.

type LinkDeleteOne

type LinkDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

LinkDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single Link entity.

func (*LinkDeleteOne) Exec

func (ldo *LinkDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*LinkDeleteOne) ExecX

func (ldo *LinkDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type LinkFilter

type LinkFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

LinkFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for LinkQuery.

func (*LinkFilter) Where

func (f *LinkFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*LinkFilter) WhereID

func (f *LinkFilter) WhereID(p entql.ValueP)

WhereID applies the entql [16]byte predicate on the id field.

func (*LinkFilter) WhereLinkInformation

func (f *LinkFilter) WhereLinkInformation(p entql.BytesP)

WhereLinkInformation applies the entql json.RawMessage predicate on the link_information field.

type LinkGroupBy

type LinkGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

LinkGroupBy is the group-by builder for Link entities.

func (*LinkGroupBy) Aggregate

func (lgb *LinkGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *LinkGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*LinkGroupBy) Bool

func (s *LinkGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*LinkGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *LinkGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkGroupBy) Bools

func (s *LinkGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*LinkGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *LinkGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkGroupBy) Float64

func (s *LinkGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*LinkGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *LinkGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *LinkGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*LinkGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *LinkGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkGroupBy) Int

func (s *LinkGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*LinkGroupBy) IntX

func (s *LinkGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkGroupBy) Ints

func (s *LinkGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*LinkGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *LinkGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkGroupBy) Scan

func (lgb *LinkGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*LinkGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *LinkGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkGroupBy) String

func (s *LinkGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*LinkGroupBy) StringX

func (s *LinkGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkGroupBy) Strings

func (s *LinkGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*LinkGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *LinkGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type LinkMutation

type LinkMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

LinkMutation represents an operation that mutates the Link nodes in the graph.

func (*LinkMutation) AddField

func (m *LinkMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*LinkMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *LinkMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*LinkMutation) AddedField

func (m *LinkMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*LinkMutation) AddedFields

func (m *LinkMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*LinkMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *LinkMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*LinkMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *LinkMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*LinkMutation) ClearField

func (m *LinkMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*LinkMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *LinkMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*LinkMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *LinkMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (LinkMutation) Client

func (m LinkMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*LinkMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *LinkMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*LinkMutation) Field

func (m *LinkMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*LinkMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *LinkMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*LinkMutation) Fields

func (m *LinkMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*LinkMutation) Filter

func (m *LinkMutation) Filter() *LinkFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the LinkMutation builder.

func (*LinkMutation) ID

func (m *LinkMutation) ID() (id uuidc.UUIDC, exists bool)

ID returns the ID value in the mutation. Note that the ID is only available if it was provided to the builder or after it was returned from the database.

func (*LinkMutation) IDs

func (m *LinkMutation) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]uuidc.UUIDC, error)

IDs queries the database and returns the entity ids that match the mutation's predicate. That means, if the mutation is applied within a transaction with an isolation level such as sql.LevelSerializable, the returned ids match the ids of the rows that will be updated or updated by the mutation.

func (*LinkMutation) LinkInformation

func (m *LinkMutation) LinkInformation() (r map[string]schema.LinkInformation, exists bool)

LinkInformation returns the value of the "link_information" field in the mutation.

func (*LinkMutation) OldField

func (m *LinkMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*LinkMutation) OldLinkInformation

func (m *LinkMutation) OldLinkInformation(ctx context.Context) (v map[string]schema.LinkInformation, err error)

OldLinkInformation returns the old "link_information" field's value of the Link entity. If the Link object wasn't provided to the builder, the object is fetched from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the database query fails.

func (*LinkMutation) Op

func (m *LinkMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*LinkMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *LinkMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*LinkMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *LinkMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*LinkMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *LinkMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*LinkMutation) ResetField

func (m *LinkMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*LinkMutation) ResetLinkInformation

func (m *LinkMutation) ResetLinkInformation()

ResetLinkInformation resets all changes to the "link_information" field.

func (*LinkMutation) SetField

func (m *LinkMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*LinkMutation) SetID

func (m *LinkMutation) SetID(id uuidc.UUIDC)

SetID sets the value of the id field. Note that this operation is only accepted on creation of Link entities.

func (*LinkMutation) SetLinkInformation

func (m *LinkMutation) SetLinkInformation(mi map[string]schema.LinkInformation)

SetLinkInformation sets the "link_information" field.

func (*LinkMutation) SetOp

func (m *LinkMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (LinkMutation) Tx

func (m LinkMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*LinkMutation) Type

func (m *LinkMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (Link).

func (*LinkMutation) Where

func (m *LinkMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.Link)

Where appends a list predicates to the LinkMutation builder.

func (*LinkMutation) WhereP

func (m *LinkMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the LinkMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type LinkQuery

type LinkQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

LinkQuery is the builder for querying Link entities.

func (*LinkQuery) Aggregate

func (lq *LinkQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *LinkSelect

Aggregate returns a LinkSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*LinkQuery) All

func (lq *LinkQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*Link, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of Links.

func (*LinkQuery) AllX

func (lq *LinkQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*Link

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkQuery) Clone

func (lq *LinkQuery) Clone() *LinkQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the LinkQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*LinkQuery) Count

func (lq *LinkQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*LinkQuery) CountX

func (lq *LinkQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkQuery) Exist

func (lq *LinkQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*LinkQuery) ExistX

func (lq *LinkQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkQuery) Filter

func (lq *LinkQuery) Filter() *LinkFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the LinkQuery builder.

func (*LinkQuery) First

func (lq *LinkQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*Link, error)

First returns the first Link entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Link was found.

func (*LinkQuery) FirstID

func (lq *LinkQuery) FirstID(ctx context.Context) (id uuidc.UUIDC, err error)

FirstID returns the first Link ID from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Link ID was found.

func (*LinkQuery) FirstIDX

func (lq *LinkQuery) FirstIDX(ctx context.Context) uuidc.UUIDC

FirstIDX is like FirstID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkQuery) FirstX

func (lq *LinkQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *Link

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkQuery) GroupBy

func (lq *LinkQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *LinkGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

Example:

var v []struct {
	LinkInformation map[string]schema.LinkInformation `json:"link_information,omitempty"`
	Count int `json:"count,omitempty"`
}

client.Link.Query().
	GroupBy(link.FieldLinkInformation).
	Aggregate(ent.Count()).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*LinkQuery) IDs

func (lq *LinkQuery) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]uuidc.UUIDC, error)

IDs executes the query and returns a list of Link IDs.

func (*LinkQuery) IDsX

func (lq *LinkQuery) IDsX(ctx context.Context) []uuidc.UUIDC

IDsX is like IDs, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkQuery) Limit

func (lq *LinkQuery) Limit(limit int) *LinkQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*LinkQuery) Offset

func (lq *LinkQuery) Offset(offset int) *LinkQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*LinkQuery) Only

func (lq *LinkQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*Link, error)

Only returns a single Link entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Link entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Link entities are found.

func (*LinkQuery) OnlyID

func (lq *LinkQuery) OnlyID(ctx context.Context) (id uuidc.UUIDC, err error)

OnlyID is like Only, but returns the only Link ID in the query. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Link ID is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no entities are found.

func (*LinkQuery) OnlyIDX

func (lq *LinkQuery) OnlyIDX(ctx context.Context) uuidc.UUIDC

OnlyIDX is like OnlyID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkQuery) OnlyX

func (lq *LinkQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *Link

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkQuery) Order

func (lq *LinkQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *LinkQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (*LinkQuery) Select

func (lq *LinkQuery) Select(fields ...string) *LinkSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

Example:

var v []struct {
	LinkInformation map[string]schema.LinkInformation `json:"link_information,omitempty"`
}

client.Link.Query().
	Select(link.FieldLinkInformation).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*LinkQuery) Unique

func (lq *LinkQuery) Unique(unique bool) *LinkQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*LinkQuery) Where

func (lq *LinkQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.Link) *LinkQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the LinkQuery builder.

type LinkSelect

type LinkSelect struct {
	*LinkQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

LinkSelect is the builder for selecting fields of Link entities.

func (*LinkSelect) Aggregate

func (ls *LinkSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *LinkSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*LinkSelect) Bool

func (s *LinkSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*LinkSelect) BoolX

func (s *LinkSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkSelect) Bools

func (s *LinkSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*LinkSelect) BoolsX

func (s *LinkSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkSelect) Float64

func (s *LinkSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*LinkSelect) Float64X

func (s *LinkSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkSelect) Float64s

func (s *LinkSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*LinkSelect) Float64sX

func (s *LinkSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkSelect) Int

func (s *LinkSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*LinkSelect) IntX

func (s *LinkSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkSelect) Ints

func (s *LinkSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*LinkSelect) IntsX

func (s *LinkSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkSelect) Scan

func (ls *LinkSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*LinkSelect) ScanX

func (s *LinkSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkSelect) String

func (s *LinkSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*LinkSelect) StringX

func (s *LinkSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkSelect) Strings

func (s *LinkSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*LinkSelect) StringsX

func (s *LinkSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type LinkUpdate

type LinkUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

LinkUpdate is the builder for updating Link entities.

func (*LinkUpdate) Exec

func (lu *LinkUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*LinkUpdate) ExecX

func (lu *LinkUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkUpdate) Mutation

func (lu *LinkUpdate) Mutation() *LinkMutation

Mutation returns the LinkMutation object of the builder.

func (*LinkUpdate) Save

func (lu *LinkUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*LinkUpdate) SaveX

func (lu *LinkUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkUpdate) SetLinkInformation

func (lu *LinkUpdate) SetLinkInformation(mi map[string]schema.LinkInformation) *LinkUpdate

SetLinkInformation sets the "link_information" field.

func (*LinkUpdate) Where

func (lu *LinkUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.Link) *LinkUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the LinkUpdate builder.

type LinkUpdateOne

type LinkUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

LinkUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single Link entity.

func (*LinkUpdateOne) Exec

func (luo *LinkUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*LinkUpdateOne) ExecX

func (luo *LinkUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkUpdateOne) Mutation

func (luo *LinkUpdateOne) Mutation() *LinkMutation

Mutation returns the LinkMutation object of the builder.

func (*LinkUpdateOne) Save

func (luo *LinkUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Link, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated Link entity.

func (*LinkUpdateOne) SaveX

func (luo *LinkUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Link

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkUpdateOne) Select

func (luo *LinkUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *LinkUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

func (*LinkUpdateOne) SetLinkInformation

func (luo *LinkUpdateOne) SetLinkInformation(mi map[string]schema.LinkInformation) *LinkUpdateOne

SetLinkInformation sets the "link_information" field.

type LinkUpsert

type LinkUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

LinkUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

func (*LinkUpsert) SetLinkInformation

func (u *LinkUpsert) SetLinkInformation(v map[string]schema.LinkInformation) *LinkUpsert

SetLinkInformation sets the "link_information" field.

func (*LinkUpsert) UpdateLinkInformation

func (u *LinkUpsert) UpdateLinkInformation() *LinkUpsert

UpdateLinkInformation sets the "link_information" field to the value that was provided on create.

type LinkUpsertBulk

type LinkUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

LinkUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of Link nodes.

func (*LinkUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *LinkUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *LinkUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*LinkUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *LinkUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*LinkUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *LinkUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkUpsertBulk) Ignore

func (u *LinkUpsertBulk) Ignore() *LinkUpsertBulk

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Link.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*LinkUpsertBulk) SetLinkInformation

func (u *LinkUpsertBulk) SetLinkInformation(v map[string]schema.LinkInformation) *LinkUpsertBulk

SetLinkInformation sets the "link_information" field.

func (*LinkUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *LinkUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*LinkUpsert)) *LinkUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the LinkCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*LinkUpsertBulk) UpdateLinkInformation

func (u *LinkUpsertBulk) UpdateLinkInformation() *LinkUpsertBulk

UpdateLinkInformation sets the "link_information" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*LinkUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *LinkUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *LinkUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Link.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(link.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type LinkUpsertOne

type LinkUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

LinkUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one Link node.

func (*LinkUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *LinkUpsertOne) DoNothing() *LinkUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*LinkUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *LinkUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*LinkUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *LinkUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkUpsertOne) ID

func (u *LinkUpsertOne) ID(ctx context.Context) (id uuidc.UUIDC, err error)

Exec executes the UPSERT query and returns the inserted/updated ID.

func (*LinkUpsertOne) IDX

func (u *LinkUpsertOne) IDX(ctx context.Context) uuidc.UUIDC

IDX is like ID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*LinkUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *LinkUpsertOne) Ignore() *LinkUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Link.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*LinkUpsertOne) SetLinkInformation

func (u *LinkUpsertOne) SetLinkInformation(v map[string]schema.LinkInformation) *LinkUpsertOne

SetLinkInformation sets the "link_information" field.

func (*LinkUpsertOne) Update

func (u *LinkUpsertOne) Update(set func(*LinkUpsert)) *LinkUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the LinkCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*LinkUpsertOne) UpdateLinkInformation

func (u *LinkUpsertOne) UpdateLinkInformation() *LinkUpsertOne

UpdateLinkInformation sets the "link_information" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*LinkUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *LinkUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *LinkUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create except the ID field. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Link.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(link.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)
type Links []*Link

Links is a parsable slice of Link.

type MixinID

type MixinID struct {

	// ID of the ent.
	ID uuid.UUID `json:"id,omitempty"`
	// SomeField holds the value of the "some_field" field.
	SomeField string `json:"some_field,omitempty"`
	// MixinField holds the value of the "mixin_field" field.
	MixinField string `json:"mixin_field,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

MixinID is the model entity for the MixinID schema.

func (*MixinID) String

func (mi *MixinID) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*MixinID) Unwrap

func (mi *MixinID) Unwrap() *MixinID

Unwrap unwraps the MixinID entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*MixinID) Update

func (mi *MixinID) Update() *MixinIDUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this MixinID. Note that you need to call MixinID.Unwrap() before calling this method if this MixinID was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type MixinIDClient

type MixinIDClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

MixinIDClient is a client for the MixinID schema.

func NewMixinIDClient

func NewMixinIDClient(c config) *MixinIDClient

NewMixinIDClient returns a client for the MixinID from the given config.

func (*MixinIDClient) Create

func (c *MixinIDClient) Create() *MixinIDCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a MixinID entity.

func (*MixinIDClient) CreateBulk

func (c *MixinIDClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*MixinIDCreate) *MixinIDCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of MixinID entities.

func (*MixinIDClient) Delete

func (c *MixinIDClient) Delete() *MixinIDDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for MixinID.

func (*MixinIDClient) DeleteOne

func (c *MixinIDClient) DeleteOne(mi *MixinID) *MixinIDDeleteOne

DeleteOne returns a builder for deleting the given entity.

func (*MixinIDClient) DeleteOneID

func (c *MixinIDClient) DeleteOneID(id uuid.UUID) *MixinIDDeleteOne

DeleteOneID returns a builder for deleting the given entity by its id.

func (*MixinIDClient) Get

func (c *MixinIDClient) Get(ctx context.Context, id uuid.UUID) (*MixinID, error)

Get returns a MixinID entity by its id.

func (*MixinIDClient) GetX

func (c *MixinIDClient) GetX(ctx context.Context, id uuid.UUID) *MixinID

GetX is like Get, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDClient) Hooks

func (c *MixinIDClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*MixinIDClient) Intercept

func (c *MixinIDClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `mixinid.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*MixinIDClient) Interceptors

func (c *MixinIDClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*MixinIDClient) Query

func (c *MixinIDClient) Query() *MixinIDQuery

Query returns a query builder for MixinID.

func (*MixinIDClient) Update

func (c *MixinIDClient) Update() *MixinIDUpdate

Update returns an update builder for MixinID.

func (*MixinIDClient) UpdateOne

func (c *MixinIDClient) UpdateOne(mi *MixinID) *MixinIDUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*MixinIDClient) UpdateOneID

func (c *MixinIDClient) UpdateOneID(id uuid.UUID) *MixinIDUpdateOne

UpdateOneID returns an update builder for the given id.

func (*MixinIDClient) Use

func (c *MixinIDClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `mixinid.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type MixinIDCreate

type MixinIDCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

MixinIDCreate is the builder for creating a MixinID entity.

func (*MixinIDCreate) Exec

func (mic *MixinIDCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*MixinIDCreate) ExecX

func (mic *MixinIDCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDCreate) Mutation

func (mic *MixinIDCreate) Mutation() *MixinIDMutation

Mutation returns the MixinIDMutation object of the builder.

func (*MixinIDCreate) OnConflict

func (mic *MixinIDCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *MixinIDUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.MixinID.Create().
	SetSomeField(v).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.MixinIDUpsert) {
		SetSomeField(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*MixinIDCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (mic *MixinIDCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *MixinIDUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.MixinID.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*MixinIDCreate) Save

func (mic *MixinIDCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*MixinID, error)

Save creates the MixinID in the database.

func (*MixinIDCreate) SaveX

func (mic *MixinIDCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *MixinID

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*MixinIDCreate) SetID

func (mic *MixinIDCreate) SetID(u uuid.UUID) *MixinIDCreate

SetID sets the "id" field.

func (*MixinIDCreate) SetMixinField

func (mic *MixinIDCreate) SetMixinField(s string) *MixinIDCreate

SetMixinField sets the "mixin_field" field.

func (*MixinIDCreate) SetNillableID

func (mic *MixinIDCreate) SetNillableID(u *uuid.UUID) *MixinIDCreate

SetNillableID sets the "id" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*MixinIDCreate) SetSomeField

func (mic *MixinIDCreate) SetSomeField(s string) *MixinIDCreate

SetSomeField sets the "some_field" field.

type MixinIDCreateBulk

type MixinIDCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

MixinIDCreateBulk is the builder for creating many MixinID entities in bulk.

func (*MixinIDCreateBulk) Exec

func (micb *MixinIDCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*MixinIDCreateBulk) ExecX

func (micb *MixinIDCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (micb *MixinIDCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *MixinIDUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.MixinID.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.MixinIDUpsert) {
		SetSomeField(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*MixinIDCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (micb *MixinIDCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *MixinIDUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.MixinID.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*MixinIDCreateBulk) Save

func (micb *MixinIDCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*MixinID, error)

Save creates the MixinID entities in the database.

func (*MixinIDCreateBulk) SaveX

func (micb *MixinIDCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*MixinID

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type MixinIDDelete

type MixinIDDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

MixinIDDelete is the builder for deleting a MixinID entity.

func (*MixinIDDelete) Exec

func (mid *MixinIDDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*MixinIDDelete) ExecX

func (mid *MixinIDDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDDelete) Where

func (mid *MixinIDDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.MixinID) *MixinIDDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the MixinIDDelete builder.

type MixinIDDeleteOne

type MixinIDDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

MixinIDDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single MixinID entity.

func (*MixinIDDeleteOne) Exec

func (mido *MixinIDDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*MixinIDDeleteOne) ExecX

func (mido *MixinIDDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type MixinIDFilter

type MixinIDFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

MixinIDFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for MixinIDQuery.

func (*MixinIDFilter) Where

func (f *MixinIDFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*MixinIDFilter) WhereID

func (f *MixinIDFilter) WhereID(p entql.ValueP)

WhereID applies the entql [16]byte predicate on the id field.

func (*MixinIDFilter) WhereMixinField

func (f *MixinIDFilter) WhereMixinField(p entql.StringP)

WhereMixinField applies the entql string predicate on the mixin_field field.

func (*MixinIDFilter) WhereSomeField

func (f *MixinIDFilter) WhereSomeField(p entql.StringP)

WhereSomeField applies the entql string predicate on the some_field field.

type MixinIDGroupBy

type MixinIDGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

MixinIDGroupBy is the group-by builder for MixinID entities.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) Aggregate

func (migb *MixinIDGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *MixinIDGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) Bool

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) Bools

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) Float64

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) Int

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) IntX

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) Ints

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) Scan

func (migb *MixinIDGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) String

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) StringX

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) Strings

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*MixinIDGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *MixinIDGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type MixinIDMutation

type MixinIDMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

MixinIDMutation represents an operation that mutates the MixinID nodes in the graph.

func (*MixinIDMutation) AddField

func (m *MixinIDMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*MixinIDMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *MixinIDMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*MixinIDMutation) AddedField

func (m *MixinIDMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*MixinIDMutation) AddedFields

func (m *MixinIDMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*MixinIDMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *MixinIDMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*MixinIDMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *MixinIDMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*MixinIDMutation) ClearField

func (m *MixinIDMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*MixinIDMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *MixinIDMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*MixinIDMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *MixinIDMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (MixinIDMutation) Client

func (m MixinIDMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*MixinIDMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *MixinIDMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*MixinIDMutation) Field

func (m *MixinIDMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*MixinIDMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *MixinIDMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*MixinIDMutation) Fields

func (m *MixinIDMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*MixinIDMutation) Filter

func (m *MixinIDMutation) Filter() *MixinIDFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the MixinIDMutation builder.

func (*MixinIDMutation) ID

func (m *MixinIDMutation) ID() (id uuid.UUID, exists bool)

ID returns the ID value in the mutation. Note that the ID is only available if it was provided to the builder or after it was returned from the database.

func (*MixinIDMutation) IDs

func (m *MixinIDMutation) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]uuid.UUID, error)

IDs queries the database and returns the entity ids that match the mutation's predicate. That means, if the mutation is applied within a transaction with an isolation level such as sql.LevelSerializable, the returned ids match the ids of the rows that will be updated or updated by the mutation.

func (*MixinIDMutation) MixinField

func (m *MixinIDMutation) MixinField() (r string, exists bool)

MixinField returns the value of the "mixin_field" field in the mutation.

func (*MixinIDMutation) OldField

func (m *MixinIDMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*MixinIDMutation) OldMixinField

func (m *MixinIDMutation) OldMixinField(ctx context.Context) (v string, err error)

OldMixinField returns the old "mixin_field" field's value of the MixinID entity. If the MixinID object wasn't provided to the builder, the object is fetched from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the database query fails.

func (*MixinIDMutation) OldSomeField

func (m *MixinIDMutation) OldSomeField(ctx context.Context) (v string, err error)

OldSomeField returns the old "some_field" field's value of the MixinID entity. If the MixinID object wasn't provided to the builder, the object is fetched from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the database query fails.

func (*MixinIDMutation) Op

func (m *MixinIDMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*MixinIDMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *MixinIDMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*MixinIDMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *MixinIDMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*MixinIDMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *MixinIDMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*MixinIDMutation) ResetField

func (m *MixinIDMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*MixinIDMutation) ResetMixinField

func (m *MixinIDMutation) ResetMixinField()

ResetMixinField resets all changes to the "mixin_field" field.

func (*MixinIDMutation) ResetSomeField

func (m *MixinIDMutation) ResetSomeField()

ResetSomeField resets all changes to the "some_field" field.

func (*MixinIDMutation) SetField

func (m *MixinIDMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*MixinIDMutation) SetID

func (m *MixinIDMutation) SetID(id uuid.UUID)

SetID sets the value of the id field. Note that this operation is only accepted on creation of MixinID entities.

func (*MixinIDMutation) SetMixinField

func (m *MixinIDMutation) SetMixinField(s string)

SetMixinField sets the "mixin_field" field.

func (*MixinIDMutation) SetOp

func (m *MixinIDMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (*MixinIDMutation) SetSomeField

func (m *MixinIDMutation) SetSomeField(s string)

SetSomeField sets the "some_field" field.

func (*MixinIDMutation) SomeField

func (m *MixinIDMutation) SomeField() (r string, exists bool)

SomeField returns the value of the "some_field" field in the mutation.

func (MixinIDMutation) Tx

func (m MixinIDMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*MixinIDMutation) Type

func (m *MixinIDMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (MixinID).

func (*MixinIDMutation) Where

func (m *MixinIDMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.MixinID)

Where appends a list predicates to the MixinIDMutation builder.

func (*MixinIDMutation) WhereP

func (m *MixinIDMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the MixinIDMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type MixinIDQuery

type MixinIDQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

MixinIDQuery is the builder for querying MixinID entities.

func (*MixinIDQuery) Aggregate

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *MixinIDSelect

Aggregate returns a MixinIDSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*MixinIDQuery) All

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*MixinID, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of MixinIDs.

func (*MixinIDQuery) AllX

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*MixinID

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDQuery) Clone

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) Clone() *MixinIDQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the MixinIDQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*MixinIDQuery) Count

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*MixinIDQuery) CountX

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDQuery) Exist

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*MixinIDQuery) ExistX

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDQuery) Filter

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) Filter() *MixinIDFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the MixinIDQuery builder.

func (*MixinIDQuery) First

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*MixinID, error)

First returns the first MixinID entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no MixinID was found.

func (*MixinIDQuery) FirstID

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) FirstID(ctx context.Context) (id uuid.UUID, err error)

FirstID returns the first MixinID ID from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no MixinID ID was found.

func (*MixinIDQuery) FirstIDX

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) FirstIDX(ctx context.Context) uuid.UUID

FirstIDX is like FirstID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDQuery) FirstX

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *MixinID

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDQuery) GroupBy

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *MixinIDGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

Example:

var v []struct {
	SomeField string `json:"some_field,omitempty"`
	Count int `json:"count,omitempty"`
}

client.MixinID.Query().
	GroupBy(mixinid.FieldSomeField).
	Aggregate(ent.Count()).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*MixinIDQuery) IDs

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]uuid.UUID, error)

IDs executes the query and returns a list of MixinID IDs.

func (*MixinIDQuery) IDsX

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) IDsX(ctx context.Context) []uuid.UUID

IDsX is like IDs, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDQuery) Limit

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) Limit(limit int) *MixinIDQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*MixinIDQuery) Offset

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) Offset(offset int) *MixinIDQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*MixinIDQuery) Only

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*MixinID, error)

Only returns a single MixinID entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one MixinID entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no MixinID entities are found.

func (*MixinIDQuery) OnlyID

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) OnlyID(ctx context.Context) (id uuid.UUID, err error)

OnlyID is like Only, but returns the only MixinID ID in the query. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one MixinID ID is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no entities are found.

func (*MixinIDQuery) OnlyIDX

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) OnlyIDX(ctx context.Context) uuid.UUID

OnlyIDX is like OnlyID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDQuery) OnlyX

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *MixinID

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDQuery) Order

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *MixinIDQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (*MixinIDQuery) Select

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) Select(fields ...string) *MixinIDSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

Example:

var v []struct {
	SomeField string `json:"some_field,omitempty"`
}

client.MixinID.Query().
	Select(mixinid.FieldSomeField).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*MixinIDQuery) Unique

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) Unique(unique bool) *MixinIDQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*MixinIDQuery) Where

func (miq *MixinIDQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.MixinID) *MixinIDQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the MixinIDQuery builder.

type MixinIDSelect

type MixinIDSelect struct {
	*MixinIDQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

MixinIDSelect is the builder for selecting fields of MixinID entities.

func (*MixinIDSelect) Aggregate

func (mis *MixinIDSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *MixinIDSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*MixinIDSelect) Bool

func (s *MixinIDSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*MixinIDSelect) BoolX

func (s *MixinIDSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDSelect) Bools

func (s *MixinIDSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*MixinIDSelect) BoolsX

func (s *MixinIDSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDSelect) Float64

func (s *MixinIDSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*MixinIDSelect) Float64X

func (s *MixinIDSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDSelect) Float64s

func (s *MixinIDSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*MixinIDSelect) Float64sX

func (s *MixinIDSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDSelect) Int

func (s *MixinIDSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*MixinIDSelect) IntX

func (s *MixinIDSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDSelect) Ints

func (s *MixinIDSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*MixinIDSelect) IntsX

func (s *MixinIDSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDSelect) Scan

func (mis *MixinIDSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*MixinIDSelect) ScanX

func (s *MixinIDSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDSelect) String

func (s *MixinIDSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*MixinIDSelect) StringX

func (s *MixinIDSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDSelect) Strings

func (s *MixinIDSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*MixinIDSelect) StringsX

func (s *MixinIDSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type MixinIDUpdate

type MixinIDUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

MixinIDUpdate is the builder for updating MixinID entities.

func (*MixinIDUpdate) Exec

func (miu *MixinIDUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*MixinIDUpdate) ExecX

func (miu *MixinIDUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDUpdate) Mutation

func (miu *MixinIDUpdate) Mutation() *MixinIDMutation

Mutation returns the MixinIDMutation object of the builder.

func (*MixinIDUpdate) Save

func (miu *MixinIDUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*MixinIDUpdate) SaveX

func (miu *MixinIDUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDUpdate) SetMixinField

func (miu *MixinIDUpdate) SetMixinField(s string) *MixinIDUpdate

SetMixinField sets the "mixin_field" field.

func (*MixinIDUpdate) SetSomeField

func (miu *MixinIDUpdate) SetSomeField(s string) *MixinIDUpdate

SetSomeField sets the "some_field" field.

func (*MixinIDUpdate) Where

func (miu *MixinIDUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.MixinID) *MixinIDUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the MixinIDUpdate builder.

type MixinIDUpdateOne

type MixinIDUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

MixinIDUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single MixinID entity.

func (*MixinIDUpdateOne) Exec

func (miuo *MixinIDUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*MixinIDUpdateOne) ExecX

func (miuo *MixinIDUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDUpdateOne) Mutation

func (miuo *MixinIDUpdateOne) Mutation() *MixinIDMutation

Mutation returns the MixinIDMutation object of the builder.

func (*MixinIDUpdateOne) Save

func (miuo *MixinIDUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*MixinID, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated MixinID entity.

func (*MixinIDUpdateOne) SaveX

func (miuo *MixinIDUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *MixinID

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDUpdateOne) Select

func (miuo *MixinIDUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *MixinIDUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

func (*MixinIDUpdateOne) SetMixinField

func (miuo *MixinIDUpdateOne) SetMixinField(s string) *MixinIDUpdateOne

SetMixinField sets the "mixin_field" field.

func (*MixinIDUpdateOne) SetSomeField

func (miuo *MixinIDUpdateOne) SetSomeField(s string) *MixinIDUpdateOne

SetSomeField sets the "some_field" field.

type MixinIDUpsert

type MixinIDUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

MixinIDUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

func (*MixinIDUpsert) SetMixinField

func (u *MixinIDUpsert) SetMixinField(v string) *MixinIDUpsert

SetMixinField sets the "mixin_field" field.

func (*MixinIDUpsert) SetSomeField

func (u *MixinIDUpsert) SetSomeField(v string) *MixinIDUpsert

SetSomeField sets the "some_field" field.

func (*MixinIDUpsert) UpdateMixinField

func (u *MixinIDUpsert) UpdateMixinField() *MixinIDUpsert

UpdateMixinField sets the "mixin_field" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*MixinIDUpsert) UpdateSomeField

func (u *MixinIDUpsert) UpdateSomeField() *MixinIDUpsert

UpdateSomeField sets the "some_field" field to the value that was provided on create.

type MixinIDUpsertBulk

type MixinIDUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

MixinIDUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of MixinID nodes.

func (*MixinIDUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *MixinIDUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *MixinIDUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*MixinIDUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *MixinIDUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*MixinIDUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *MixinIDUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDUpsertBulk) Ignore

func (u *MixinIDUpsertBulk) Ignore() *MixinIDUpsertBulk

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.MixinID.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*MixinIDUpsertBulk) SetMixinField

func (u *MixinIDUpsertBulk) SetMixinField(v string) *MixinIDUpsertBulk

SetMixinField sets the "mixin_field" field.

func (*MixinIDUpsertBulk) SetSomeField

func (u *MixinIDUpsertBulk) SetSomeField(v string) *MixinIDUpsertBulk

SetSomeField sets the "some_field" field.

func (*MixinIDUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *MixinIDUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*MixinIDUpsert)) *MixinIDUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the MixinIDCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*MixinIDUpsertBulk) UpdateMixinField

func (u *MixinIDUpsertBulk) UpdateMixinField() *MixinIDUpsertBulk

UpdateMixinField sets the "mixin_field" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*MixinIDUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *MixinIDUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *MixinIDUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.MixinID.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(mixinid.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*MixinIDUpsertBulk) UpdateSomeField

func (u *MixinIDUpsertBulk) UpdateSomeField() *MixinIDUpsertBulk

UpdateSomeField sets the "some_field" field to the value that was provided on create.

type MixinIDUpsertOne

type MixinIDUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

MixinIDUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one MixinID node.

func (*MixinIDUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *MixinIDUpsertOne) DoNothing() *MixinIDUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*MixinIDUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *MixinIDUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*MixinIDUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *MixinIDUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDUpsertOne) ID

func (u *MixinIDUpsertOne) ID(ctx context.Context) (id uuid.UUID, err error)

Exec executes the UPSERT query and returns the inserted/updated ID.

func (*MixinIDUpsertOne) IDX

IDX is like ID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*MixinIDUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *MixinIDUpsertOne) Ignore() *MixinIDUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.MixinID.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*MixinIDUpsertOne) SetMixinField

func (u *MixinIDUpsertOne) SetMixinField(v string) *MixinIDUpsertOne

SetMixinField sets the "mixin_field" field.

func (*MixinIDUpsertOne) SetSomeField

func (u *MixinIDUpsertOne) SetSomeField(v string) *MixinIDUpsertOne

SetSomeField sets the "some_field" field.

func (*MixinIDUpsertOne) Update

func (u *MixinIDUpsertOne) Update(set func(*MixinIDUpsert)) *MixinIDUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the MixinIDCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*MixinIDUpsertOne) UpdateMixinField

func (u *MixinIDUpsertOne) UpdateMixinField() *MixinIDUpsertOne

UpdateMixinField sets the "mixin_field" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*MixinIDUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *MixinIDUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *MixinIDUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create except the ID field. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.MixinID.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(mixinid.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*MixinIDUpsertOne) UpdateSomeField

func (u *MixinIDUpsertOne) UpdateSomeField() *MixinIDUpsertOne

UpdateSomeField sets the "some_field" field to the value that was provided on create.

type MixinIDs

type MixinIDs []*MixinID

MixinIDs is a parsable slice of MixinID.

type MutateFunc

type MutateFunc = ent.MutateFunc

ent aliases to avoid import conflicts in user's code.

type Mutation

type Mutation = ent.Mutation

ent aliases to avoid import conflicts in user's code.

type Mutator

type Mutator = ent.Mutator

ent aliases to avoid import conflicts in user's code.

type NotFoundError

type NotFoundError struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NotFoundError returns when trying to fetch a specific entity and it was not found in the database.

func (*NotFoundError) Error

func (e *NotFoundError) Error() string

Error implements the error interface.

type NotLoadedError

type NotLoadedError struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NotLoadedError returns when trying to get a node that was not loaded by the query.

func (*NotLoadedError) Error

func (e *NotLoadedError) Error() string

Error implements the error interface.

type NotSingularError

type NotSingularError struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NotSingularError returns when trying to fetch a singular entity and more then one was found in the database.

func (*NotSingularError) Error

func (e *NotSingularError) Error() string

Error implements the error interface.

type Note

type Note struct {

	// ID of the ent.
	ID schema.NoteID `json:"id,omitempty"`
	// Text holds the value of the "text" field.
	Text string `json:"text,omitempty"`
	// Edges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.
	// The values are being populated by the NoteQuery when eager-loading is set.
	Edges NoteEdges `json:"edges"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Note is the model entity for the Note schema.

func (*Note) QueryChildren

func (n *Note) QueryChildren() *NoteQuery

QueryChildren queries the "children" edge of the Note entity.

func (*Note) QueryParent

func (n *Note) QueryParent() *NoteQuery

QueryParent queries the "parent" edge of the Note entity.

func (*Note) String

func (n *Note) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*Note) Unwrap

func (n *Note) Unwrap() *Note

Unwrap unwraps the Note entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*Note) Update

func (n *Note) Update() *NoteUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this Note. Note that you need to call Note.Unwrap() before calling this method if this Note was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type NoteClient

type NoteClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NoteClient is a client for the Note schema.

func NewNoteClient

func NewNoteClient(c config) *NoteClient

NewNoteClient returns a client for the Note from the given config.

func (*NoteClient) Create

func (c *NoteClient) Create() *NoteCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a Note entity.

func (*NoteClient) CreateBulk

func (c *NoteClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*NoteCreate) *NoteCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of Note entities.

func (*NoteClient) Delete

func (c *NoteClient) Delete() *NoteDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for Note.

func (*NoteClient) DeleteOne

func (c *NoteClient) DeleteOne(n *Note) *NoteDeleteOne

DeleteOne returns a builder for deleting the given entity.

func (*NoteClient) DeleteOneID

func (c *NoteClient) DeleteOneID(id schema.NoteID) *NoteDeleteOne

DeleteOneID returns a builder for deleting the given entity by its id.

func (*NoteClient) Get

func (c *NoteClient) Get(ctx context.Context, id schema.NoteID) (*Note, error)

Get returns a Note entity by its id.

func (*NoteClient) GetX

func (c *NoteClient) GetX(ctx context.Context, id schema.NoteID) *Note

GetX is like Get, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteClient) Hooks

func (c *NoteClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*NoteClient) Intercept

func (c *NoteClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `note.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*NoteClient) Interceptors

func (c *NoteClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*NoteClient) Query

func (c *NoteClient) Query() *NoteQuery

Query returns a query builder for Note.

func (*NoteClient) QueryChildren

func (c *NoteClient) QueryChildren(n *Note) *NoteQuery

QueryChildren queries the children edge of a Note.

func (*NoteClient) QueryParent

func (c *NoteClient) QueryParent(n *Note) *NoteQuery

QueryParent queries the parent edge of a Note.

func (*NoteClient) Update

func (c *NoteClient) Update() *NoteUpdate

Update returns an update builder for Note.

func (*NoteClient) UpdateOne

func (c *NoteClient) UpdateOne(n *Note) *NoteUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*NoteClient) UpdateOneID

func (c *NoteClient) UpdateOneID(id schema.NoteID) *NoteUpdateOne

UpdateOneID returns an update builder for the given id.

func (*NoteClient) Use

func (c *NoteClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `note.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type NoteCreate

type NoteCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NoteCreate is the builder for creating a Note entity.

func (*NoteCreate) AddChildIDs

func (nc *NoteCreate) AddChildIDs(ids ...schema.NoteID) *NoteCreate

AddChildIDs adds the "children" edge to the Note entity by IDs.

func (*NoteCreate) AddChildren

func (nc *NoteCreate) AddChildren(n ...*Note) *NoteCreate

AddChildren adds the "children" edges to the Note entity.

func (*NoteCreate) Exec

func (nc *NoteCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*NoteCreate) ExecX

func (nc *NoteCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteCreate) Mutation

func (nc *NoteCreate) Mutation() *NoteMutation

Mutation returns the NoteMutation object of the builder.

func (*NoteCreate) OnConflict

func (nc *NoteCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *NoteUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Note.Create().
	SetText(v).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.NoteUpsert) {
		SetText(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*NoteCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (nc *NoteCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *NoteUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Note.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*NoteCreate) Save

func (nc *NoteCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Note, error)

Save creates the Note in the database.

func (*NoteCreate) SaveX

func (nc *NoteCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Note

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*NoteCreate) SetID

func (nc *NoteCreate) SetID(si schema.NoteID) *NoteCreate

SetID sets the "id" field.

func (*NoteCreate) SetNillableID

func (nc *NoteCreate) SetNillableID(si *schema.NoteID) *NoteCreate

SetNillableID sets the "id" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*NoteCreate) SetNillableParentID

func (nc *NoteCreate) SetNillableParentID(id *schema.NoteID) *NoteCreate

SetNillableParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Note entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*NoteCreate) SetNillableText

func (nc *NoteCreate) SetNillableText(s *string) *NoteCreate

SetNillableText sets the "text" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*NoteCreate) SetParent

func (nc *NoteCreate) SetParent(n *Note) *NoteCreate

SetParent sets the "parent" edge to the Note entity.

func (*NoteCreate) SetParentID

func (nc *NoteCreate) SetParentID(id schema.NoteID) *NoteCreate

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Note entity by ID.

func (*NoteCreate) SetText

func (nc *NoteCreate) SetText(s string) *NoteCreate

SetText sets the "text" field.

type NoteCreateBulk

type NoteCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NoteCreateBulk is the builder for creating many Note entities in bulk.

func (*NoteCreateBulk) Exec

func (ncb *NoteCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*NoteCreateBulk) ExecX

func (ncb *NoteCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (ncb *NoteCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *NoteUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Note.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.NoteUpsert) {
		SetText(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*NoteCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (ncb *NoteCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *NoteUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Note.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*NoteCreateBulk) Save

func (ncb *NoteCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*Note, error)

Save creates the Note entities in the database.

func (*NoteCreateBulk) SaveX

func (ncb *NoteCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*Note

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type NoteDelete

type NoteDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NoteDelete is the builder for deleting a Note entity.

func (*NoteDelete) Exec

func (nd *NoteDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*NoteDelete) ExecX

func (nd *NoteDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteDelete) Where

func (nd *NoteDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.Note) *NoteDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the NoteDelete builder.

type NoteDeleteOne

type NoteDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NoteDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single Note entity.

func (*NoteDeleteOne) Exec

func (ndo *NoteDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*NoteDeleteOne) ExecX

func (ndo *NoteDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type NoteEdges

type NoteEdges struct {
	// Parent holds the value of the parent edge.
	Parent *Note `json:"parent,omitempty"`
	// Children holds the value of the children edge.
	Children []*Note `json:"children,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NoteEdges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.

func (NoteEdges) ChildrenOrErr

func (e NoteEdges) ChildrenOrErr() ([]*Note, error)

ChildrenOrErr returns the Children value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading.

func (NoteEdges) ParentOrErr

func (e NoteEdges) ParentOrErr() (*Note, error)

ParentOrErr returns the Parent value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading, or loaded but was not found.

type NoteFilter

type NoteFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NoteFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for NoteQuery.

func (*NoteFilter) Where

func (f *NoteFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*NoteFilter) WhereHasChildren

func (f *NoteFilter) WhereHasChildren()

WhereHasChildren applies a predicate to check if query has an edge children.

func (*NoteFilter) WhereHasChildrenWith

func (f *NoteFilter) WhereHasChildrenWith(preds ...predicate.Note)

WhereHasChildrenWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge children with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*NoteFilter) WhereHasParent

func (f *NoteFilter) WhereHasParent()

WhereHasParent applies a predicate to check if query has an edge parent.

func (*NoteFilter) WhereHasParentWith

func (f *NoteFilter) WhereHasParentWith(preds ...predicate.Note)

WhereHasParentWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge parent with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*NoteFilter) WhereID

func (f *NoteFilter) WhereID(p entql.StringP)

WhereID applies the entql string predicate on the id field.

func (*NoteFilter) WhereText

func (f *NoteFilter) WhereText(p entql.StringP)

WhereText applies the entql string predicate on the text field.

type NoteGroupBy

type NoteGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NoteGroupBy is the group-by builder for Note entities.

func (*NoteGroupBy) Aggregate

func (ngb *NoteGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *NoteGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*NoteGroupBy) Bool

func (s *NoteGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*NoteGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *NoteGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteGroupBy) Bools

func (s *NoteGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*NoteGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *NoteGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteGroupBy) Float64

func (s *NoteGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*NoteGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *NoteGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *NoteGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*NoteGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *NoteGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteGroupBy) Int

func (s *NoteGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*NoteGroupBy) IntX

func (s *NoteGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteGroupBy) Ints

func (s *NoteGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*NoteGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *NoteGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteGroupBy) Scan

func (ngb *NoteGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*NoteGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *NoteGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteGroupBy) String

func (s *NoteGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*NoteGroupBy) StringX

func (s *NoteGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteGroupBy) Strings

func (s *NoteGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*NoteGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *NoteGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type NoteMutation

type NoteMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NoteMutation represents an operation that mutates the Note nodes in the graph.

func (*NoteMutation) AddChildIDs

func (m *NoteMutation) AddChildIDs(ids ...schema.NoteID)

AddChildIDs adds the "children" edge to the Note entity by ids.

func (*NoteMutation) AddField

func (m *NoteMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*NoteMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *NoteMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*NoteMutation) AddedField

func (m *NoteMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*NoteMutation) AddedFields

func (m *NoteMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*NoteMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *NoteMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*NoteMutation) ChildrenCleared

func (m *NoteMutation) ChildrenCleared() bool

ChildrenCleared reports if the "children" edge to the Note entity was cleared.

func (*NoteMutation) ChildrenIDs

func (m *NoteMutation) ChildrenIDs() (ids []schema.NoteID)

ChildrenIDs returns the "children" edge IDs in the mutation.

func (*NoteMutation) ClearChildren

func (m *NoteMutation) ClearChildren()

ClearChildren clears the "children" edge to the Note entity.

func (*NoteMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *NoteMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*NoteMutation) ClearField

func (m *NoteMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*NoteMutation) ClearParent

func (m *NoteMutation) ClearParent()

ClearParent clears the "parent" edge to the Note entity.

func (*NoteMutation) ClearText

func (m *NoteMutation) ClearText()

ClearText clears the value of the "text" field.

func (*NoteMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *NoteMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*NoteMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *NoteMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (NoteMutation) Client

func (m NoteMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*NoteMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *NoteMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*NoteMutation) Field

func (m *NoteMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*NoteMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *NoteMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*NoteMutation) Fields

func (m *NoteMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*NoteMutation) Filter

func (m *NoteMutation) Filter() *NoteFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the NoteMutation builder.

func (*NoteMutation) ID

func (m *NoteMutation) ID() (id schema.NoteID, exists bool)

ID returns the ID value in the mutation. Note that the ID is only available if it was provided to the builder or after it was returned from the database.

func (*NoteMutation) IDs

func (m *NoteMutation) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]schema.NoteID, error)

IDs queries the database and returns the entity ids that match the mutation's predicate. That means, if the mutation is applied within a transaction with an isolation level such as sql.LevelSerializable, the returned ids match the ids of the rows that will be updated or updated by the mutation.

func (*NoteMutation) OldField

func (m *NoteMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*NoteMutation) OldText

func (m *NoteMutation) OldText(ctx context.Context) (v string, err error)

OldText returns the old "text" field's value of the Note entity. If the Note object wasn't provided to the builder, the object is fetched from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the database query fails.

func (*NoteMutation) Op

func (m *NoteMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*NoteMutation) ParentCleared

func (m *NoteMutation) ParentCleared() bool

ParentCleared reports if the "parent" edge to the Note entity was cleared.

func (*NoteMutation) ParentID

func (m *NoteMutation) ParentID() (id schema.NoteID, exists bool)

ParentID returns the "parent" edge ID in the mutation.

func (*NoteMutation) ParentIDs

func (m *NoteMutation) ParentIDs() (ids []schema.NoteID)

ParentIDs returns the "parent" edge IDs in the mutation. Note that IDs always returns len(IDs) <= 1 for unique edges, and you should use ParentID instead. It exists only for internal usage by the builders.

func (*NoteMutation) RemoveChildIDs

func (m *NoteMutation) RemoveChildIDs(ids ...schema.NoteID)

RemoveChildIDs removes the "children" edge to the Note entity by IDs.

func (*NoteMutation) RemovedChildrenIDs

func (m *NoteMutation) RemovedChildrenIDs() (ids []schema.NoteID)

RemovedChildren returns the removed IDs of the "children" edge to the Note entity.

func (*NoteMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *NoteMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*NoteMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *NoteMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*NoteMutation) ResetChildren

func (m *NoteMutation) ResetChildren()

ResetChildren resets all changes to the "children" edge.

func (*NoteMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *NoteMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*NoteMutation) ResetField

func (m *NoteMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*NoteMutation) ResetParent

func (m *NoteMutation) ResetParent()

ResetParent resets all changes to the "parent" edge.

func (*NoteMutation) ResetText

func (m *NoteMutation) ResetText()

ResetText resets all changes to the "text" field.

func (*NoteMutation) SetField

func (m *NoteMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*NoteMutation) SetID

func (m *NoteMutation) SetID(id schema.NoteID)

SetID sets the value of the id field. Note that this operation is only accepted on creation of Note entities.

func (*NoteMutation) SetOp

func (m *NoteMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (*NoteMutation) SetParentID

func (m *NoteMutation) SetParentID(id schema.NoteID)

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Note entity by id.

func (*NoteMutation) SetText

func (m *NoteMutation) SetText(s string)

SetText sets the "text" field.

func (*NoteMutation) Text

func (m *NoteMutation) Text() (r string, exists bool)

Text returns the value of the "text" field in the mutation.

func (*NoteMutation) TextCleared

func (m *NoteMutation) TextCleared() bool

TextCleared returns if the "text" field was cleared in this mutation.

func (NoteMutation) Tx

func (m NoteMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*NoteMutation) Type

func (m *NoteMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (Note).

func (*NoteMutation) Where

func (m *NoteMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.Note)

Where appends a list predicates to the NoteMutation builder.

func (*NoteMutation) WhereP

func (m *NoteMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the NoteMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type NoteQuery

type NoteQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NoteQuery is the builder for querying Note entities.

func (*NoteQuery) Aggregate

func (nq *NoteQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *NoteSelect

Aggregate returns a NoteSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*NoteQuery) All

func (nq *NoteQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*Note, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of Notes.

func (*NoteQuery) AllX

func (nq *NoteQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*Note

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteQuery) Clone

func (nq *NoteQuery) Clone() *NoteQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the NoteQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*NoteQuery) Count

func (nq *NoteQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*NoteQuery) CountX

func (nq *NoteQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteQuery) Exist

func (nq *NoteQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*NoteQuery) ExistX

func (nq *NoteQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteQuery) Filter

func (nq *NoteQuery) Filter() *NoteFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the NoteQuery builder.

func (*NoteQuery) First

func (nq *NoteQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*Note, error)

First returns the first Note entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Note was found.

func (*NoteQuery) FirstID

func (nq *NoteQuery) FirstID(ctx context.Context) (id schema.NoteID, err error)

FirstID returns the first Note ID from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Note ID was found.

func (*NoteQuery) FirstIDX

func (nq *NoteQuery) FirstIDX(ctx context.Context) schema.NoteID

FirstIDX is like FirstID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteQuery) FirstX

func (nq *NoteQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *Note

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteQuery) GroupBy

func (nq *NoteQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *NoteGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

Example:

var v []struct {
	Text string `json:"text,omitempty"`
	Count int `json:"count,omitempty"`
}

client.Note.Query().
	GroupBy(note.FieldText).
	Aggregate(ent.Count()).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*NoteQuery) IDs

func (nq *NoteQuery) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]schema.NoteID, error)

IDs executes the query and returns a list of Note IDs.

func (*NoteQuery) IDsX

func (nq *NoteQuery) IDsX(ctx context.Context) []schema.NoteID

IDsX is like IDs, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteQuery) Limit

func (nq *NoteQuery) Limit(limit int) *NoteQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*NoteQuery) Offset

func (nq *NoteQuery) Offset(offset int) *NoteQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*NoteQuery) Only

func (nq *NoteQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*Note, error)

Only returns a single Note entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Note entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Note entities are found.

func (*NoteQuery) OnlyID

func (nq *NoteQuery) OnlyID(ctx context.Context) (id schema.NoteID, err error)

OnlyID is like Only, but returns the only Note ID in the query. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Note ID is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no entities are found.

func (*NoteQuery) OnlyIDX

func (nq *NoteQuery) OnlyIDX(ctx context.Context) schema.NoteID

OnlyIDX is like OnlyID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteQuery) OnlyX

func (nq *NoteQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *Note

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteQuery) Order

func (nq *NoteQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *NoteQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (*NoteQuery) QueryChildren

func (nq *NoteQuery) QueryChildren() *NoteQuery

QueryChildren chains the current query on the "children" edge.

func (*NoteQuery) QueryParent

func (nq *NoteQuery) QueryParent() *NoteQuery

QueryParent chains the current query on the "parent" edge.

func (*NoteQuery) Select

func (nq *NoteQuery) Select(fields ...string) *NoteSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

Example:

var v []struct {
	Text string `json:"text,omitempty"`
}

client.Note.Query().
	Select(note.FieldText).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*NoteQuery) Unique

func (nq *NoteQuery) Unique(unique bool) *NoteQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*NoteQuery) Where

func (nq *NoteQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.Note) *NoteQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the NoteQuery builder.

func (*NoteQuery) WithChildren

func (nq *NoteQuery) WithChildren(opts ...func(*NoteQuery)) *NoteQuery

WithChildren tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "children" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

func (*NoteQuery) WithParent

func (nq *NoteQuery) WithParent(opts ...func(*NoteQuery)) *NoteQuery

WithParent tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "parent" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

type NoteSelect

type NoteSelect struct {
	*NoteQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NoteSelect is the builder for selecting fields of Note entities.

func (*NoteSelect) Aggregate

func (ns *NoteSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *NoteSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*NoteSelect) Bool

func (s *NoteSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*NoteSelect) BoolX

func (s *NoteSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteSelect) Bools

func (s *NoteSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*NoteSelect) BoolsX

func (s *NoteSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteSelect) Float64

func (s *NoteSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*NoteSelect) Float64X

func (s *NoteSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteSelect) Float64s

func (s *NoteSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*NoteSelect) Float64sX

func (s *NoteSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteSelect) Int

func (s *NoteSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*NoteSelect) IntX

func (s *NoteSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteSelect) Ints

func (s *NoteSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*NoteSelect) IntsX

func (s *NoteSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteSelect) Scan

func (ns *NoteSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*NoteSelect) ScanX

func (s *NoteSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteSelect) String

func (s *NoteSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*NoteSelect) StringX

func (s *NoteSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteSelect) Strings

func (s *NoteSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*NoteSelect) StringsX

func (s *NoteSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type NoteUpdate

type NoteUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NoteUpdate is the builder for updating Note entities.

func (*NoteUpdate) AddChildIDs

func (nu *NoteUpdate) AddChildIDs(ids ...schema.NoteID) *NoteUpdate

AddChildIDs adds the "children" edge to the Note entity by IDs.

func (*NoteUpdate) AddChildren

func (nu *NoteUpdate) AddChildren(n ...*Note) *NoteUpdate

AddChildren adds the "children" edges to the Note entity.

func (*NoteUpdate) ClearChildren

func (nu *NoteUpdate) ClearChildren() *NoteUpdate

ClearChildren clears all "children" edges to the Note entity.

func (*NoteUpdate) ClearParent

func (nu *NoteUpdate) ClearParent() *NoteUpdate

ClearParent clears the "parent" edge to the Note entity.

func (*NoteUpdate) ClearText

func (nu *NoteUpdate) ClearText() *NoteUpdate

ClearText clears the value of the "text" field.

func (*NoteUpdate) Exec

func (nu *NoteUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*NoteUpdate) ExecX

func (nu *NoteUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteUpdate) Mutation

func (nu *NoteUpdate) Mutation() *NoteMutation

Mutation returns the NoteMutation object of the builder.

func (*NoteUpdate) RemoveChildIDs

func (nu *NoteUpdate) RemoveChildIDs(ids ...schema.NoteID) *NoteUpdate

RemoveChildIDs removes the "children" edge to Note entities by IDs.

func (*NoteUpdate) RemoveChildren

func (nu *NoteUpdate) RemoveChildren(n ...*Note) *NoteUpdate

RemoveChildren removes "children" edges to Note entities.

func (*NoteUpdate) Save

func (nu *NoteUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*NoteUpdate) SaveX

func (nu *NoteUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteUpdate) SetNillableParentID

func (nu *NoteUpdate) SetNillableParentID(id *schema.NoteID) *NoteUpdate

SetNillableParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Note entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*NoteUpdate) SetNillableText

func (nu *NoteUpdate) SetNillableText(s *string) *NoteUpdate

SetNillableText sets the "text" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*NoteUpdate) SetParent

func (nu *NoteUpdate) SetParent(n *Note) *NoteUpdate

SetParent sets the "parent" edge to the Note entity.

func (*NoteUpdate) SetParentID

func (nu *NoteUpdate) SetParentID(id schema.NoteID) *NoteUpdate

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Note entity by ID.

func (*NoteUpdate) SetText

func (nu *NoteUpdate) SetText(s string) *NoteUpdate

SetText sets the "text" field.

func (*NoteUpdate) Where

func (nu *NoteUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.Note) *NoteUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the NoteUpdate builder.

type NoteUpdateOne

type NoteUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NoteUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single Note entity.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) AddChildIDs

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) AddChildIDs(ids ...schema.NoteID) *NoteUpdateOne

AddChildIDs adds the "children" edge to the Note entity by IDs.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) AddChildren

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) AddChildren(n ...*Note) *NoteUpdateOne

AddChildren adds the "children" edges to the Note entity.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) ClearChildren

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) ClearChildren() *NoteUpdateOne

ClearChildren clears all "children" edges to the Note entity.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) ClearParent

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) ClearParent() *NoteUpdateOne

ClearParent clears the "parent" edge to the Note entity.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) ClearText

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) ClearText() *NoteUpdateOne

ClearText clears the value of the "text" field.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) Exec

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) ExecX

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) Mutation

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) Mutation() *NoteMutation

Mutation returns the NoteMutation object of the builder.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) RemoveChildIDs

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) RemoveChildIDs(ids ...schema.NoteID) *NoteUpdateOne

RemoveChildIDs removes the "children" edge to Note entities by IDs.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) RemoveChildren

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) RemoveChildren(n ...*Note) *NoteUpdateOne

RemoveChildren removes "children" edges to Note entities.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) Save

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Note, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated Note entity.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) SaveX

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Note

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) Select

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *NoteUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) SetNillableParentID

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) SetNillableParentID(id *schema.NoteID) *NoteUpdateOne

SetNillableParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Note entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) SetNillableText

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) SetNillableText(s *string) *NoteUpdateOne

SetNillableText sets the "text" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) SetParent

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) SetParent(n *Note) *NoteUpdateOne

SetParent sets the "parent" edge to the Note entity.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) SetParentID

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) SetParentID(id schema.NoteID) *NoteUpdateOne

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the Note entity by ID.

func (*NoteUpdateOne) SetText

func (nuo *NoteUpdateOne) SetText(s string) *NoteUpdateOne

SetText sets the "text" field.

type NoteUpsert

type NoteUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

NoteUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

func (*NoteUpsert) ClearText

func (u *NoteUpsert) ClearText() *NoteUpsert

ClearText clears the value of the "text" field.

func (*NoteUpsert) SetText

func (u *NoteUpsert) SetText(v string) *NoteUpsert

SetText sets the "text" field.

func (*NoteUpsert) UpdateText

func (u *NoteUpsert) UpdateText() *NoteUpsert

UpdateText sets the "text" field to the value that was provided on create.

type NoteUpsertBulk

type NoteUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NoteUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of Note nodes.

func (*NoteUpsertBulk) ClearText

func (u *NoteUpsertBulk) ClearText() *NoteUpsertBulk

ClearText clears the value of the "text" field.

func (*NoteUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *NoteUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *NoteUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*NoteUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *NoteUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*NoteUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *NoteUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteUpsertBulk) Ignore

func (u *NoteUpsertBulk) Ignore() *NoteUpsertBulk

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Note.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*NoteUpsertBulk) SetText

func (u *NoteUpsertBulk) SetText(v string) *NoteUpsertBulk

SetText sets the "text" field.

func (*NoteUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *NoteUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*NoteUpsert)) *NoteUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the NoteCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*NoteUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *NoteUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *NoteUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Note.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(note.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*NoteUpsertBulk) UpdateText

func (u *NoteUpsertBulk) UpdateText() *NoteUpsertBulk

UpdateText sets the "text" field to the value that was provided on create.

type NoteUpsertOne

type NoteUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

NoteUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one Note node.

func (*NoteUpsertOne) ClearText

func (u *NoteUpsertOne) ClearText() *NoteUpsertOne

ClearText clears the value of the "text" field.

func (*NoteUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *NoteUpsertOne) DoNothing() *NoteUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*NoteUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *NoteUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*NoteUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *NoteUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteUpsertOne) ID

func (u *NoteUpsertOne) ID(ctx context.Context) (id schema.NoteID, err error)

Exec executes the UPSERT query and returns the inserted/updated ID.

func (*NoteUpsertOne) IDX

IDX is like ID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*NoteUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *NoteUpsertOne) Ignore() *NoteUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Note.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*NoteUpsertOne) SetText

func (u *NoteUpsertOne) SetText(v string) *NoteUpsertOne

SetText sets the "text" field.

func (*NoteUpsertOne) Update

func (u *NoteUpsertOne) Update(set func(*NoteUpsert)) *NoteUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the NoteCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*NoteUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *NoteUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *NoteUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create except the ID field. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Note.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(note.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*NoteUpsertOne) UpdateText

func (u *NoteUpsertOne) UpdateText() *NoteUpsertOne

UpdateText sets the "text" field to the value that was provided on create.

type Notes

type Notes []*Note

Notes is a parsable slice of Note.

type Op

type Op = ent.Op

ent aliases to avoid import conflicts in user's code.

type Option

type Option func(*config)

Option function to configure the client.

func Debug

func Debug() Option

Debug enables debug logging on the ent.Driver.

func Driver

func Driver(driver dialect.Driver) Option

Driver configures the client driver.

func Log

func Log(fn func(...any)) Option

Log sets the logging function for debug mode.

type OrderFunc

type OrderFunc func(*sql.Selector)

OrderFunc applies an ordering on the sql selector.

func Asc

func Asc(fields ...string) OrderFunc

Asc applies the given fields in ASC order.

func Desc

func Desc(fields ...string) OrderFunc

Desc applies the given fields in DESC order.

type Other

type Other struct {

	// ID of the ent.
	ID sid.ID `json:"id,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Other is the model entity for the Other schema.

func (*Other) String

func (o *Other) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*Other) Unwrap

func (o *Other) Unwrap() *Other

Unwrap unwraps the Other entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*Other) Update

func (o *Other) Update() *OtherUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this Other. Note that you need to call Other.Unwrap() before calling this method if this Other was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type OtherClient

type OtherClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

OtherClient is a client for the Other schema.

func NewOtherClient

func NewOtherClient(c config) *OtherClient

NewOtherClient returns a client for the Other from the given config.

func (*OtherClient) Create

func (c *OtherClient) Create() *OtherCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a Other entity.

func (*OtherClient) CreateBulk

func (c *OtherClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*OtherCreate) *OtherCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of Other entities.

func (*OtherClient) Delete

func (c *OtherClient) Delete() *OtherDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for Other.

func (*OtherClient) DeleteOne

func (c *OtherClient) DeleteOne(o *Other) *OtherDeleteOne

DeleteOne returns a builder for deleting the given entity.

func (*OtherClient) DeleteOneID

func (c *OtherClient) DeleteOneID(id sid.ID) *OtherDeleteOne

DeleteOneID returns a builder for deleting the given entity by its id.

func (*OtherClient) Get

func (c *OtherClient) Get(ctx context.Context, id sid.ID) (*Other, error)

Get returns a Other entity by its id.

func (*OtherClient) GetX

func (c *OtherClient) GetX(ctx context.Context, id sid.ID) *Other

GetX is like Get, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherClient) Hooks

func (c *OtherClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*OtherClient) Intercept

func (c *OtherClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `other.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*OtherClient) Interceptors

func (c *OtherClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*OtherClient) Query

func (c *OtherClient) Query() *OtherQuery

Query returns a query builder for Other.

func (*OtherClient) Update

func (c *OtherClient) Update() *OtherUpdate

Update returns an update builder for Other.

func (*OtherClient) UpdateOne

func (c *OtherClient) UpdateOne(o *Other) *OtherUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*OtherClient) UpdateOneID

func (c *OtherClient) UpdateOneID(id sid.ID) *OtherUpdateOne

UpdateOneID returns an update builder for the given id.

func (*OtherClient) Use

func (c *OtherClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `other.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type OtherCreate

type OtherCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

OtherCreate is the builder for creating a Other entity.

func (*OtherCreate) Exec

func (oc *OtherCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*OtherCreate) ExecX

func (oc *OtherCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherCreate) Mutation

func (oc *OtherCreate) Mutation() *OtherMutation

Mutation returns the OtherMutation object of the builder.

func (*OtherCreate) OnConflict

func (oc *OtherCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *OtherUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Other.Create().
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*OtherCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (oc *OtherCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *OtherUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Other.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*OtherCreate) Save

func (oc *OtherCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Other, error)

Save creates the Other in the database.

func (*OtherCreate) SaveX

func (oc *OtherCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Other

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*OtherCreate) SetID

func (oc *OtherCreate) SetID(s sid.ID) *OtherCreate

SetID sets the "id" field.

func (*OtherCreate) SetNillableID

func (oc *OtherCreate) SetNillableID(s *sid.ID) *OtherCreate

SetNillableID sets the "id" field if the given value is not nil.

type OtherCreateBulk

type OtherCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

OtherCreateBulk is the builder for creating many Other entities in bulk.

func (*OtherCreateBulk) Exec

func (ocb *OtherCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*OtherCreateBulk) ExecX

func (ocb *OtherCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (ocb *OtherCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *OtherUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Other.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*OtherCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (ocb *OtherCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *OtherUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Other.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*OtherCreateBulk) Save

func (ocb *OtherCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*Other, error)

Save creates the Other entities in the database.

func (*OtherCreateBulk) SaveX

func (ocb *OtherCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*Other

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type OtherDelete

type OtherDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

OtherDelete is the builder for deleting a Other entity.

func (*OtherDelete) Exec

func (od *OtherDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*OtherDelete) ExecX

func (od *OtherDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherDelete) Where

func (od *OtherDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.Other) *OtherDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the OtherDelete builder.

type OtherDeleteOne

type OtherDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

OtherDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single Other entity.

func (*OtherDeleteOne) Exec

func (odo *OtherDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*OtherDeleteOne) ExecX

func (odo *OtherDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type OtherFilter

type OtherFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

OtherFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for OtherQuery.

func (*OtherFilter) Where

func (f *OtherFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*OtherFilter) WhereID

func (f *OtherFilter) WhereID(p entql.OtherP)

WhereID applies the entql other predicate on the id field.

type OtherGroupBy

type OtherGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

OtherGroupBy is the group-by builder for Other entities.

func (*OtherGroupBy) Aggregate

func (ogb *OtherGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *OtherGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*OtherGroupBy) Bool

func (s *OtherGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*OtherGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *OtherGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherGroupBy) Bools

func (s *OtherGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*OtherGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *OtherGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherGroupBy) Float64

func (s *OtherGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*OtherGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *OtherGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *OtherGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*OtherGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *OtherGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherGroupBy) Int

func (s *OtherGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*OtherGroupBy) IntX

func (s *OtherGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherGroupBy) Ints

func (s *OtherGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*OtherGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *OtherGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherGroupBy) Scan

func (ogb *OtherGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*OtherGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *OtherGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherGroupBy) String

func (s *OtherGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*OtherGroupBy) StringX

func (s *OtherGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherGroupBy) Strings

func (s *OtherGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*OtherGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *OtherGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type OtherMutation

type OtherMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

OtherMutation represents an operation that mutates the Other nodes in the graph.

func (*OtherMutation) AddField

func (m *OtherMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*OtherMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *OtherMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*OtherMutation) AddedField

func (m *OtherMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*OtherMutation) AddedFields

func (m *OtherMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*OtherMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *OtherMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*OtherMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *OtherMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*OtherMutation) ClearField

func (m *OtherMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*OtherMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *OtherMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*OtherMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *OtherMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (OtherMutation) Client

func (m OtherMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*OtherMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *OtherMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*OtherMutation) Field

func (m *OtherMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*OtherMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *OtherMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*OtherMutation) Fields

func (m *OtherMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*OtherMutation) Filter

func (m *OtherMutation) Filter() *OtherFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the OtherMutation builder.

func (*OtherMutation) ID

func (m *OtherMutation) ID() (id sid.ID, exists bool)

ID returns the ID value in the mutation. Note that the ID is only available if it was provided to the builder or after it was returned from the database.

func (*OtherMutation) IDs

func (m *OtherMutation) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]sid.ID, error)

IDs queries the database and returns the entity ids that match the mutation's predicate. That means, if the mutation is applied within a transaction with an isolation level such as sql.LevelSerializable, the returned ids match the ids of the rows that will be updated or updated by the mutation.

func (*OtherMutation) OldField

func (m *OtherMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*OtherMutation) Op

func (m *OtherMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*OtherMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *OtherMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*OtherMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *OtherMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*OtherMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *OtherMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*OtherMutation) ResetField

func (m *OtherMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*OtherMutation) SetField

func (m *OtherMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*OtherMutation) SetID

func (m *OtherMutation) SetID(id sid.ID)

SetID sets the value of the id field. Note that this operation is only accepted on creation of Other entities.

func (*OtherMutation) SetOp

func (m *OtherMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (OtherMutation) Tx

func (m OtherMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*OtherMutation) Type

func (m *OtherMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (Other).

func (*OtherMutation) Where

func (m *OtherMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.Other)

Where appends a list predicates to the OtherMutation builder.

func (*OtherMutation) WhereP

func (m *OtherMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the OtherMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type OtherQuery

type OtherQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

OtherQuery is the builder for querying Other entities.

func (*OtherQuery) Aggregate

func (oq *OtherQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *OtherSelect

Aggregate returns a OtherSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*OtherQuery) All

func (oq *OtherQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*Other, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of Others.

func (*OtherQuery) AllX

func (oq *OtherQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*Other

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherQuery) Clone

func (oq *OtherQuery) Clone() *OtherQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the OtherQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*OtherQuery) Count

func (oq *OtherQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*OtherQuery) CountX

func (oq *OtherQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherQuery) Exist

func (oq *OtherQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*OtherQuery) ExistX

func (oq *OtherQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherQuery) Filter

func (oq *OtherQuery) Filter() *OtherFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the OtherQuery builder.

func (*OtherQuery) First

func (oq *OtherQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*Other, error)

First returns the first Other entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Other was found.

func (*OtherQuery) FirstID

func (oq *OtherQuery) FirstID(ctx context.Context) (id sid.ID, err error)

FirstID returns the first Other ID from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Other ID was found.

func (*OtherQuery) FirstIDX

func (oq *OtherQuery) FirstIDX(ctx context.Context) sid.ID

FirstIDX is like FirstID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherQuery) FirstX

func (oq *OtherQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *Other

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherQuery) GroupBy

func (oq *OtherQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *OtherGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

func (*OtherQuery) IDs

func (oq *OtherQuery) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]sid.ID, error)

IDs executes the query and returns a list of Other IDs.

func (*OtherQuery) IDsX

func (oq *OtherQuery) IDsX(ctx context.Context) []sid.ID

IDsX is like IDs, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherQuery) Limit

func (oq *OtherQuery) Limit(limit int) *OtherQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*OtherQuery) Offset

func (oq *OtherQuery) Offset(offset int) *OtherQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*OtherQuery) Only

func (oq *OtherQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*Other, error)

Only returns a single Other entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Other entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Other entities are found.

func (*OtherQuery) OnlyID

func (oq *OtherQuery) OnlyID(ctx context.Context) (id sid.ID, err error)

OnlyID is like Only, but returns the only Other ID in the query. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Other ID is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no entities are found.

func (*OtherQuery) OnlyIDX

func (oq *OtherQuery) OnlyIDX(ctx context.Context) sid.ID

OnlyIDX is like OnlyID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherQuery) OnlyX

func (oq *OtherQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *Other

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherQuery) Order

func (oq *OtherQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *OtherQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (*OtherQuery) Select

func (oq *OtherQuery) Select(fields ...string) *OtherSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

func (*OtherQuery) Unique

func (oq *OtherQuery) Unique(unique bool) *OtherQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*OtherQuery) Where

func (oq *OtherQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.Other) *OtherQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the OtherQuery builder.

type OtherSelect

type OtherSelect struct {
	*OtherQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

OtherSelect is the builder for selecting fields of Other entities.

func (*OtherSelect) Aggregate

func (os *OtherSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *OtherSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*OtherSelect) Bool

func (s *OtherSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*OtherSelect) BoolX

func (s *OtherSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherSelect) Bools

func (s *OtherSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*OtherSelect) BoolsX

func (s *OtherSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherSelect) Float64

func (s *OtherSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*OtherSelect) Float64X

func (s *OtherSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherSelect) Float64s

func (s *OtherSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*OtherSelect) Float64sX

func (s *OtherSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherSelect) Int

func (s *OtherSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*OtherSelect) IntX

func (s *OtherSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherSelect) Ints

func (s *OtherSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*OtherSelect) IntsX

func (s *OtherSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherSelect) Scan

func (os *OtherSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*OtherSelect) ScanX

func (s *OtherSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherSelect) String

func (s *OtherSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*OtherSelect) StringX

func (s *OtherSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherSelect) Strings

func (s *OtherSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*OtherSelect) StringsX

func (s *OtherSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type OtherUpdate

type OtherUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

OtherUpdate is the builder for updating Other entities.

func (*OtherUpdate) Exec

func (ou *OtherUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*OtherUpdate) ExecX

func (ou *OtherUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherUpdate) Mutation

func (ou *OtherUpdate) Mutation() *OtherMutation

Mutation returns the OtherMutation object of the builder.

func (*OtherUpdate) Save

func (ou *OtherUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*OtherUpdate) SaveX

func (ou *OtherUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherUpdate) Where

func (ou *OtherUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.Other) *OtherUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the OtherUpdate builder.

type OtherUpdateOne

type OtherUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

OtherUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single Other entity.

func (*OtherUpdateOne) Exec

func (ouo *OtherUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*OtherUpdateOne) ExecX

func (ouo *OtherUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherUpdateOne) Mutation

func (ouo *OtherUpdateOne) Mutation() *OtherMutation

Mutation returns the OtherMutation object of the builder.

func (*OtherUpdateOne) Save

func (ouo *OtherUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Other, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated Other entity.

func (*OtherUpdateOne) SaveX

func (ouo *OtherUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Other

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherUpdateOne) Select

func (ouo *OtherUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *OtherUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

type OtherUpsert

type OtherUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

OtherUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

type OtherUpsertBulk

type OtherUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

OtherUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of Other nodes.

func (*OtherUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *OtherUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *OtherUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*OtherUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *OtherUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*OtherUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *OtherUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherUpsertBulk) Ignore

func (u *OtherUpsertBulk) Ignore() *OtherUpsertBulk

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Other.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*OtherUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *OtherUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*OtherUpsert)) *OtherUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the OtherCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*OtherUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *OtherUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *OtherUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Other.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(other.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type OtherUpsertOne

type OtherUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

OtherUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one Other node.

func (*OtherUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *OtherUpsertOne) DoNothing() *OtherUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*OtherUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *OtherUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*OtherUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *OtherUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherUpsertOne) ID

func (u *OtherUpsertOne) ID(ctx context.Context) (id sid.ID, err error)

Exec executes the UPSERT query and returns the inserted/updated ID.

func (*OtherUpsertOne) IDX

func (u *OtherUpsertOne) IDX(ctx context.Context) sid.ID

IDX is like ID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*OtherUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *OtherUpsertOne) Ignore() *OtherUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Other.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*OtherUpsertOne) Update

func (u *OtherUpsertOne) Update(set func(*OtherUpsert)) *OtherUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the OtherCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*OtherUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *OtherUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *OtherUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create except the ID field. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Other.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(other.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type Others

type Others []*Other

Others is a parsable slice of Other.

type Pet

type Pet struct {

	// ID of the ent.
	ID string `json:"id,omitempty"`
	// Edges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.
	// The values are being populated by the PetQuery when eager-loading is set.
	Edges PetEdges `json:"edges"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Pet is the model entity for the Pet schema.

func (*Pet) QueryBestFriend

func (pe *Pet) QueryBestFriend() *PetQuery

QueryBestFriend queries the "best_friend" edge of the Pet entity.

func (*Pet) QueryCars

func (pe *Pet) QueryCars() *CarQuery

QueryCars queries the "cars" edge of the Pet entity.

func (*Pet) QueryFriends

func (pe *Pet) QueryFriends() *PetQuery

QueryFriends queries the "friends" edge of the Pet entity.

func (*Pet) QueryOwner

func (pe *Pet) QueryOwner() *UserQuery

QueryOwner queries the "owner" edge of the Pet entity.

func (*Pet) String

func (pe *Pet) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*Pet) Unwrap

func (pe *Pet) Unwrap() *Pet

Unwrap unwraps the Pet entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*Pet) Update

func (pe *Pet) Update() *PetUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this Pet. Note that you need to call Pet.Unwrap() before calling this method if this Pet was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type PetClient

type PetClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

PetClient is a client for the Pet schema.

func NewPetClient

func NewPetClient(c config) *PetClient

NewPetClient returns a client for the Pet from the given config.

func (*PetClient) Create

func (c *PetClient) Create() *PetCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a Pet entity.

func (*PetClient) CreateBulk

func (c *PetClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*PetCreate) *PetCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of Pet entities.

func (*PetClient) Delete

func (c *PetClient) Delete() *PetDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for Pet.

func (*PetClient) DeleteOne

func (c *PetClient) DeleteOne(pe *Pet) *PetDeleteOne

DeleteOne returns a builder for deleting the given entity.

func (*PetClient) DeleteOneID

func (c *PetClient) DeleteOneID(id string) *PetDeleteOne

DeleteOneID returns a builder for deleting the given entity by its id.

func (*PetClient) Get

func (c *PetClient) Get(ctx context.Context, id string) (*Pet, error)

Get returns a Pet entity by its id.

func (*PetClient) GetX

func (c *PetClient) GetX(ctx context.Context, id string) *Pet

GetX is like Get, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetClient) Hooks

func (c *PetClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*PetClient) Intercept

func (c *PetClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `pet.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*PetClient) Interceptors

func (c *PetClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*PetClient) Query

func (c *PetClient) Query() *PetQuery

Query returns a query builder for Pet.

func (*PetClient) QueryBestFriend

func (c *PetClient) QueryBestFriend(pe *Pet) *PetQuery

QueryBestFriend queries the best_friend edge of a Pet.

func (*PetClient) QueryCars

func (c *PetClient) QueryCars(pe *Pet) *CarQuery

QueryCars queries the cars edge of a Pet.

func (*PetClient) QueryFriends

func (c *PetClient) QueryFriends(pe *Pet) *PetQuery

QueryFriends queries the friends edge of a Pet.

func (*PetClient) QueryOwner

func (c *PetClient) QueryOwner(pe *Pet) *UserQuery

QueryOwner queries the owner edge of a Pet.

func (*PetClient) Update

func (c *PetClient) Update() *PetUpdate

Update returns an update builder for Pet.

func (*PetClient) UpdateOne

func (c *PetClient) UpdateOne(pe *Pet) *PetUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*PetClient) UpdateOneID

func (c *PetClient) UpdateOneID(id string) *PetUpdateOne

UpdateOneID returns an update builder for the given id.

func (*PetClient) Use

func (c *PetClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `pet.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type PetCreate

type PetCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

PetCreate is the builder for creating a Pet entity.

func (*PetCreate) AddCarIDs

func (pc *PetCreate) AddCarIDs(ids ...int) *PetCreate

AddCarIDs adds the "cars" edge to the Car entity by IDs.

func (*PetCreate) AddCars

func (pc *PetCreate) AddCars(c ...*Car) *PetCreate

AddCars adds the "cars" edges to the Car entity.

func (*PetCreate) AddFriendIDs

func (pc *PetCreate) AddFriendIDs(ids ...string) *PetCreate

AddFriendIDs adds the "friends" edge to the Pet entity by IDs.

func (*PetCreate) AddFriends

func (pc *PetCreate) AddFriends(p ...*Pet) *PetCreate

AddFriends adds the "friends" edges to the Pet entity.

func (*PetCreate) Exec

func (pc *PetCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*PetCreate) ExecX

func (pc *PetCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetCreate) Mutation

func (pc *PetCreate) Mutation() *PetMutation

Mutation returns the PetMutation object of the builder.

func (*PetCreate) OnConflict

func (pc *PetCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *PetUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Pet.Create().
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*PetCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (pc *PetCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *PetUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Pet.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*PetCreate) Save

func (pc *PetCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Pet, error)

Save creates the Pet in the database.

func (*PetCreate) SaveX

func (pc *PetCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Pet

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*PetCreate) SetBestFriend

func (pc *PetCreate) SetBestFriend(p *Pet) *PetCreate

SetBestFriend sets the "best_friend" edge to the Pet entity.

func (*PetCreate) SetBestFriendID

func (pc *PetCreate) SetBestFriendID(id string) *PetCreate

SetBestFriendID sets the "best_friend" edge to the Pet entity by ID.

func (*PetCreate) SetID

func (pc *PetCreate) SetID(s string) *PetCreate

SetID sets the "id" field.

func (*PetCreate) SetNillableBestFriendID

func (pc *PetCreate) SetNillableBestFriendID(id *string) *PetCreate

SetNillableBestFriendID sets the "best_friend" edge to the Pet entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*PetCreate) SetNillableID

func (pc *PetCreate) SetNillableID(s *string) *PetCreate

SetNillableID sets the "id" field if the given value is not nil.

func (*PetCreate) SetNillableOwnerID

func (pc *PetCreate) SetNillableOwnerID(id *int) *PetCreate

SetNillableOwnerID sets the "owner" edge to the User entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*PetCreate) SetOwner

func (pc *PetCreate) SetOwner(u *User) *PetCreate

SetOwner sets the "owner" edge to the User entity.

func (*PetCreate) SetOwnerID

func (pc *PetCreate) SetOwnerID(id int) *PetCreate

SetOwnerID sets the "owner" edge to the User entity by ID.

type PetCreateBulk

type PetCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

PetCreateBulk is the builder for creating many Pet entities in bulk.

func (*PetCreateBulk) Exec

func (pcb *PetCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*PetCreateBulk) ExecX

func (pcb *PetCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (pcb *PetCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *PetUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Pet.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*PetCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (pcb *PetCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *PetUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Pet.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*PetCreateBulk) Save

func (pcb *PetCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*Pet, error)

Save creates the Pet entities in the database.

func (*PetCreateBulk) SaveX

func (pcb *PetCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*Pet

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type PetDelete

type PetDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

PetDelete is the builder for deleting a Pet entity.

func (*PetDelete) Exec

func (pd *PetDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*PetDelete) ExecX

func (pd *PetDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetDelete) Where

func (pd *PetDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.Pet) *PetDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the PetDelete builder.

type PetDeleteOne

type PetDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

PetDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single Pet entity.

func (*PetDeleteOne) Exec

func (pdo *PetDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*PetDeleteOne) ExecX

func (pdo *PetDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type PetEdges

type PetEdges struct {
	// Owner holds the value of the owner edge.
	Owner *User `json:"owner,omitempty"`
	// Cars holds the value of the cars edge.
	Cars []*Car `json:"cars,omitempty"`
	// Friends holds the value of the friends edge.
	Friends []*Pet `json:"friends,omitempty"`
	// BestFriend holds the value of the best_friend edge.
	BestFriend *Pet `json:"best_friend,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

PetEdges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.

func (PetEdges) BestFriendOrErr

func (e PetEdges) BestFriendOrErr() (*Pet, error)

BestFriendOrErr returns the BestFriend value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading, or loaded but was not found.

func (PetEdges) CarsOrErr

func (e PetEdges) CarsOrErr() ([]*Car, error)

CarsOrErr returns the Cars value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading.

func (PetEdges) FriendsOrErr

func (e PetEdges) FriendsOrErr() ([]*Pet, error)

FriendsOrErr returns the Friends value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading.

func (PetEdges) OwnerOrErr

func (e PetEdges) OwnerOrErr() (*User, error)

OwnerOrErr returns the Owner value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading, or loaded but was not found.

type PetFilter

type PetFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

PetFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for PetQuery.

func (*PetFilter) Where

func (f *PetFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*PetFilter) WhereHasBestFriend

func (f *PetFilter) WhereHasBestFriend()

WhereHasBestFriend applies a predicate to check if query has an edge best_friend.

func (*PetFilter) WhereHasBestFriendWith

func (f *PetFilter) WhereHasBestFriendWith(preds ...predicate.Pet)

WhereHasBestFriendWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge best_friend with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*PetFilter) WhereHasCars

func (f *PetFilter) WhereHasCars()

WhereHasCars applies a predicate to check if query has an edge cars.

func (*PetFilter) WhereHasCarsWith

func (f *PetFilter) WhereHasCarsWith(preds ...predicate.Car)

WhereHasCarsWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge cars with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*PetFilter) WhereHasFriends

func (f *PetFilter) WhereHasFriends()

WhereHasFriends applies a predicate to check if query has an edge friends.

func (*PetFilter) WhereHasFriendsWith

func (f *PetFilter) WhereHasFriendsWith(preds ...predicate.Pet)

WhereHasFriendsWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge friends with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*PetFilter) WhereHasOwner

func (f *PetFilter) WhereHasOwner()

WhereHasOwner applies a predicate to check if query has an edge owner.

func (*PetFilter) WhereHasOwnerWith

func (f *PetFilter) WhereHasOwnerWith(preds ...predicate.User)

WhereHasOwnerWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge owner with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*PetFilter) WhereID

func (f *PetFilter) WhereID(p entql.StringP)

WhereID applies the entql string predicate on the id field.

type PetGroupBy

type PetGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

PetGroupBy is the group-by builder for Pet entities.

func (*PetGroupBy) Aggregate

func (pgb *PetGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *PetGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*PetGroupBy) Bool

func (s *PetGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*PetGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *PetGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetGroupBy) Bools

func (s *PetGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*PetGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *PetGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetGroupBy) Float64

func (s *PetGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*PetGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *PetGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *PetGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*PetGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *PetGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetGroupBy) Int

func (s *PetGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*PetGroupBy) IntX

func (s *PetGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetGroupBy) Ints

func (s *PetGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*PetGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *PetGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetGroupBy) Scan

func (pgb *PetGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*PetGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *PetGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetGroupBy) String

func (s *PetGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*PetGroupBy) StringX

func (s *PetGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetGroupBy) Strings

func (s *PetGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*PetGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *PetGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type PetMutation

type PetMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

PetMutation represents an operation that mutates the Pet nodes in the graph.

func (*PetMutation) AddCarIDs

func (m *PetMutation) AddCarIDs(ids ...int)

AddCarIDs adds the "cars" edge to the Car entity by ids.

func (*PetMutation) AddField

func (m *PetMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*PetMutation) AddFriendIDs

func (m *PetMutation) AddFriendIDs(ids ...string)

AddFriendIDs adds the "friends" edge to the Pet entity by ids.

func (*PetMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *PetMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*PetMutation) AddedField

func (m *PetMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*PetMutation) AddedFields

func (m *PetMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*PetMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *PetMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*PetMutation) BestFriendCleared

func (m *PetMutation) BestFriendCleared() bool

BestFriendCleared reports if the "best_friend" edge to the Pet entity was cleared.

func (*PetMutation) BestFriendID

func (m *PetMutation) BestFriendID() (id string, exists bool)

BestFriendID returns the "best_friend" edge ID in the mutation.

func (*PetMutation) BestFriendIDs

func (m *PetMutation) BestFriendIDs() (ids []string)

BestFriendIDs returns the "best_friend" edge IDs in the mutation. Note that IDs always returns len(IDs) <= 1 for unique edges, and you should use BestFriendID instead. It exists only for internal usage by the builders.

func (*PetMutation) CarsCleared

func (m *PetMutation) CarsCleared() bool

CarsCleared reports if the "cars" edge to the Car entity was cleared.

func (*PetMutation) CarsIDs

func (m *PetMutation) CarsIDs() (ids []int)

CarsIDs returns the "cars" edge IDs in the mutation.

func (*PetMutation) ClearBestFriend

func (m *PetMutation) ClearBestFriend()

ClearBestFriend clears the "best_friend" edge to the Pet entity.

func (*PetMutation) ClearCars

func (m *PetMutation) ClearCars()

ClearCars clears the "cars" edge to the Car entity.

func (*PetMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *PetMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*PetMutation) ClearField

func (m *PetMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*PetMutation) ClearFriends

func (m *PetMutation) ClearFriends()

ClearFriends clears the "friends" edge to the Pet entity.

func (*PetMutation) ClearOwner

func (m *PetMutation) ClearOwner()

ClearOwner clears the "owner" edge to the User entity.

func (*PetMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *PetMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*PetMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *PetMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (PetMutation) Client

func (m PetMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*PetMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *PetMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*PetMutation) Field

func (m *PetMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*PetMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *PetMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*PetMutation) Fields

func (m *PetMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*PetMutation) Filter

func (m *PetMutation) Filter() *PetFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the PetMutation builder.

func (*PetMutation) FriendsCleared

func (m *PetMutation) FriendsCleared() bool

FriendsCleared reports if the "friends" edge to the Pet entity was cleared.

func (*PetMutation) FriendsIDs

func (m *PetMutation) FriendsIDs() (ids []string)

FriendsIDs returns the "friends" edge IDs in the mutation.

func (*PetMutation) ID

func (m *PetMutation) ID() (id string, exists bool)

ID returns the ID value in the mutation. Note that the ID is only available if it was provided to the builder or after it was returned from the database.

func (*PetMutation) IDs

func (m *PetMutation) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

IDs queries the database and returns the entity ids that match the mutation's predicate. That means, if the mutation is applied within a transaction with an isolation level such as sql.LevelSerializable, the returned ids match the ids of the rows that will be updated or updated by the mutation.

func (*PetMutation) OldField

func (m *PetMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*PetMutation) Op

func (m *PetMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*PetMutation) OwnerCleared

func (m *PetMutation) OwnerCleared() bool

OwnerCleared reports if the "owner" edge to the User entity was cleared.

func (*PetMutation) OwnerID

func (m *PetMutation) OwnerID() (id int, exists bool)

OwnerID returns the "owner" edge ID in the mutation.

func (*PetMutation) OwnerIDs

func (m *PetMutation) OwnerIDs() (ids []int)

OwnerIDs returns the "owner" edge IDs in the mutation. Note that IDs always returns len(IDs) <= 1 for unique edges, and you should use OwnerID instead. It exists only for internal usage by the builders.

func (*PetMutation) RemoveCarIDs

func (m *PetMutation) RemoveCarIDs(ids ...int)

RemoveCarIDs removes the "cars" edge to the Car entity by IDs.

func (*PetMutation) RemoveFriendIDs

func (m *PetMutation) RemoveFriendIDs(ids ...string)

RemoveFriendIDs removes the "friends" edge to the Pet entity by IDs.

func (*PetMutation) RemovedCarsIDs

func (m *PetMutation) RemovedCarsIDs() (ids []int)

RemovedCars returns the removed IDs of the "cars" edge to the Car entity.

func (*PetMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *PetMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*PetMutation) RemovedFriendsIDs

func (m *PetMutation) RemovedFriendsIDs() (ids []string)

RemovedFriends returns the removed IDs of the "friends" edge to the Pet entity.

func (*PetMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *PetMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*PetMutation) ResetBestFriend

func (m *PetMutation) ResetBestFriend()

ResetBestFriend resets all changes to the "best_friend" edge.

func (*PetMutation) ResetCars

func (m *PetMutation) ResetCars()

ResetCars resets all changes to the "cars" edge.

func (*PetMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *PetMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*PetMutation) ResetField

func (m *PetMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*PetMutation) ResetFriends

func (m *PetMutation) ResetFriends()

ResetFriends resets all changes to the "friends" edge.

func (*PetMutation) ResetOwner

func (m *PetMutation) ResetOwner()

ResetOwner resets all changes to the "owner" edge.

func (*PetMutation) SetBestFriendID

func (m *PetMutation) SetBestFriendID(id string)

SetBestFriendID sets the "best_friend" edge to the Pet entity by id.

func (*PetMutation) SetField

func (m *PetMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*PetMutation) SetID

func (m *PetMutation) SetID(id string)

SetID sets the value of the id field. Note that this operation is only accepted on creation of Pet entities.

func (*PetMutation) SetOp

func (m *PetMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (*PetMutation) SetOwnerID

func (m *PetMutation) SetOwnerID(id int)

SetOwnerID sets the "owner" edge to the User entity by id.

func (PetMutation) Tx

func (m PetMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*PetMutation) Type

func (m *PetMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (Pet).

func (*PetMutation) Where

func (m *PetMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.Pet)

Where appends a list predicates to the PetMutation builder.

func (*PetMutation) WhereP

func (m *PetMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the PetMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type PetQuery

type PetQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

PetQuery is the builder for querying Pet entities.

func (*PetQuery) Aggregate

func (pq *PetQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *PetSelect

Aggregate returns a PetSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*PetQuery) All

func (pq *PetQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*Pet, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of Pets.

func (*PetQuery) AllX

func (pq *PetQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*Pet

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetQuery) Clone

func (pq *PetQuery) Clone() *PetQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the PetQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*PetQuery) Count

func (pq *PetQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*PetQuery) CountX

func (pq *PetQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetQuery) Exist

func (pq *PetQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*PetQuery) ExistX

func (pq *PetQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetQuery) Filter

func (pq *PetQuery) Filter() *PetFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the PetQuery builder.

func (*PetQuery) First

func (pq *PetQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*Pet, error)

First returns the first Pet entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Pet was found.

func (*PetQuery) FirstID

func (pq *PetQuery) FirstID(ctx context.Context) (id string, err error)

FirstID returns the first Pet ID from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Pet ID was found.

func (*PetQuery) FirstIDX

func (pq *PetQuery) FirstIDX(ctx context.Context) string

FirstIDX is like FirstID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetQuery) FirstX

func (pq *PetQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *Pet

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetQuery) GroupBy

func (pq *PetQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *PetGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

func (*PetQuery) IDs

func (pq *PetQuery) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

IDs executes the query and returns a list of Pet IDs.

func (*PetQuery) IDsX

func (pq *PetQuery) IDsX(ctx context.Context) []string

IDsX is like IDs, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetQuery) Limit

func (pq *PetQuery) Limit(limit int) *PetQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*PetQuery) Offset

func (pq *PetQuery) Offset(offset int) *PetQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*PetQuery) Only

func (pq *PetQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*Pet, error)

Only returns a single Pet entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Pet entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Pet entities are found.

func (*PetQuery) OnlyID

func (pq *PetQuery) OnlyID(ctx context.Context) (id string, err error)

OnlyID is like Only, but returns the only Pet ID in the query. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Pet ID is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no entities are found.

func (*PetQuery) OnlyIDX

func (pq *PetQuery) OnlyIDX(ctx context.Context) string

OnlyIDX is like OnlyID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetQuery) OnlyX

func (pq *PetQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *Pet

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetQuery) Order

func (pq *PetQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *PetQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (*PetQuery) QueryBestFriend

func (pq *PetQuery) QueryBestFriend() *PetQuery

QueryBestFriend chains the current query on the "best_friend" edge.

func (*PetQuery) QueryCars

func (pq *PetQuery) QueryCars() *CarQuery

QueryCars chains the current query on the "cars" edge.

func (*PetQuery) QueryFriends

func (pq *PetQuery) QueryFriends() *PetQuery

QueryFriends chains the current query on the "friends" edge.

func (*PetQuery) QueryOwner

func (pq *PetQuery) QueryOwner() *UserQuery

QueryOwner chains the current query on the "owner" edge.

func (*PetQuery) Select

func (pq *PetQuery) Select(fields ...string) *PetSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

func (*PetQuery) Unique

func (pq *PetQuery) Unique(unique bool) *PetQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*PetQuery) Where

func (pq *PetQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.Pet) *PetQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the PetQuery builder.

func (*PetQuery) WithBestFriend

func (pq *PetQuery) WithBestFriend(opts ...func(*PetQuery)) *PetQuery

WithBestFriend tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "best_friend" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

func (*PetQuery) WithCars

func (pq *PetQuery) WithCars(opts ...func(*CarQuery)) *PetQuery

WithCars tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "cars" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

func (*PetQuery) WithFriends

func (pq *PetQuery) WithFriends(opts ...func(*PetQuery)) *PetQuery

WithFriends tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "friends" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

func (*PetQuery) WithOwner

func (pq *PetQuery) WithOwner(opts ...func(*UserQuery)) *PetQuery

WithOwner tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "owner" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

type PetSelect

type PetSelect struct {
	*PetQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

PetSelect is the builder for selecting fields of Pet entities.

func (*PetSelect) Aggregate

func (ps *PetSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *PetSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*PetSelect) Bool

func (s *PetSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*PetSelect) BoolX

func (s *PetSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetSelect) Bools

func (s *PetSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*PetSelect) BoolsX

func (s *PetSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetSelect) Float64

func (s *PetSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*PetSelect) Float64X

func (s *PetSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetSelect) Float64s

func (s *PetSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*PetSelect) Float64sX

func (s *PetSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetSelect) Int

func (s *PetSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*PetSelect) IntX

func (s *PetSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetSelect) Ints

func (s *PetSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*PetSelect) IntsX

func (s *PetSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetSelect) Scan

func (ps *PetSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*PetSelect) ScanX

func (s *PetSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetSelect) String

func (s *PetSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*PetSelect) StringX

func (s *PetSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetSelect) Strings

func (s *PetSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*PetSelect) StringsX

func (s *PetSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type PetUpdate

type PetUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

PetUpdate is the builder for updating Pet entities.

func (*PetUpdate) AddCarIDs

func (pu *PetUpdate) AddCarIDs(ids ...int) *PetUpdate

AddCarIDs adds the "cars" edge to the Car entity by IDs.

func (*PetUpdate) AddCars

func (pu *PetUpdate) AddCars(c ...*Car) *PetUpdate

AddCars adds the "cars" edges to the Car entity.

func (*PetUpdate) AddFriendIDs

func (pu *PetUpdate) AddFriendIDs(ids ...string) *PetUpdate

AddFriendIDs adds the "friends" edge to the Pet entity by IDs.

func (*PetUpdate) AddFriends

func (pu *PetUpdate) AddFriends(p ...*Pet) *PetUpdate

AddFriends adds the "friends" edges to the Pet entity.

func (*PetUpdate) ClearBestFriend

func (pu *PetUpdate) ClearBestFriend() *PetUpdate

ClearBestFriend clears the "best_friend" edge to the Pet entity.

func (*PetUpdate) ClearCars

func (pu *PetUpdate) ClearCars() *PetUpdate

ClearCars clears all "cars" edges to the Car entity.

func (*PetUpdate) ClearFriends

func (pu *PetUpdate) ClearFriends() *PetUpdate

ClearFriends clears all "friends" edges to the Pet entity.

func (*PetUpdate) ClearOwner

func (pu *PetUpdate) ClearOwner() *PetUpdate

ClearOwner clears the "owner" edge to the User entity.

func (*PetUpdate) Exec

func (pu *PetUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*PetUpdate) ExecX

func (pu *PetUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetUpdate) Mutation

func (pu *PetUpdate) Mutation() *PetMutation

Mutation returns the PetMutation object of the builder.

func (*PetUpdate) RemoveCarIDs

func (pu *PetUpdate) RemoveCarIDs(ids ...int) *PetUpdate

RemoveCarIDs removes the "cars" edge to Car entities by IDs.

func (*PetUpdate) RemoveCars

func (pu *PetUpdate) RemoveCars(c ...*Car) *PetUpdate

RemoveCars removes "cars" edges to Car entities.

func (*PetUpdate) RemoveFriendIDs

func (pu *PetUpdate) RemoveFriendIDs(ids ...string) *PetUpdate

RemoveFriendIDs removes the "friends" edge to Pet entities by IDs.

func (*PetUpdate) RemoveFriends

func (pu *PetUpdate) RemoveFriends(p ...*Pet) *PetUpdate

RemoveFriends removes "friends" edges to Pet entities.

func (*PetUpdate) Save

func (pu *PetUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*PetUpdate) SaveX

func (pu *PetUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetUpdate) SetBestFriend

func (pu *PetUpdate) SetBestFriend(p *Pet) *PetUpdate

SetBestFriend sets the "best_friend" edge to the Pet entity.

func (*PetUpdate) SetBestFriendID

func (pu *PetUpdate) SetBestFriendID(id string) *PetUpdate

SetBestFriendID sets the "best_friend" edge to the Pet entity by ID.

func (*PetUpdate) SetNillableBestFriendID

func (pu *PetUpdate) SetNillableBestFriendID(id *string) *PetUpdate

SetNillableBestFriendID sets the "best_friend" edge to the Pet entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*PetUpdate) SetNillableOwnerID

func (pu *PetUpdate) SetNillableOwnerID(id *int) *PetUpdate

SetNillableOwnerID sets the "owner" edge to the User entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*PetUpdate) SetOwner

func (pu *PetUpdate) SetOwner(u *User) *PetUpdate

SetOwner sets the "owner" edge to the User entity.

func (*PetUpdate) SetOwnerID

func (pu *PetUpdate) SetOwnerID(id int) *PetUpdate

SetOwnerID sets the "owner" edge to the User entity by ID.

func (*PetUpdate) Where

func (pu *PetUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.Pet) *PetUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the PetUpdate builder.

type PetUpdateOne

type PetUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

PetUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single Pet entity.

func (*PetUpdateOne) AddCarIDs

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) AddCarIDs(ids ...int) *PetUpdateOne

AddCarIDs adds the "cars" edge to the Car entity by IDs.

func (*PetUpdateOne) AddCars

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) AddCars(c ...*Car) *PetUpdateOne

AddCars adds the "cars" edges to the Car entity.

func (*PetUpdateOne) AddFriendIDs

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) AddFriendIDs(ids ...string) *PetUpdateOne

AddFriendIDs adds the "friends" edge to the Pet entity by IDs.

func (*PetUpdateOne) AddFriends

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) AddFriends(p ...*Pet) *PetUpdateOne

AddFriends adds the "friends" edges to the Pet entity.

func (*PetUpdateOne) ClearBestFriend

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) ClearBestFriend() *PetUpdateOne

ClearBestFriend clears the "best_friend" edge to the Pet entity.

func (*PetUpdateOne) ClearCars

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) ClearCars() *PetUpdateOne

ClearCars clears all "cars" edges to the Car entity.

func (*PetUpdateOne) ClearFriends

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) ClearFriends() *PetUpdateOne

ClearFriends clears all "friends" edges to the Pet entity.

func (*PetUpdateOne) ClearOwner

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) ClearOwner() *PetUpdateOne

ClearOwner clears the "owner" edge to the User entity.

func (*PetUpdateOne) Exec

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*PetUpdateOne) ExecX

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetUpdateOne) Mutation

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) Mutation() *PetMutation

Mutation returns the PetMutation object of the builder.

func (*PetUpdateOne) RemoveCarIDs

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) RemoveCarIDs(ids ...int) *PetUpdateOne

RemoveCarIDs removes the "cars" edge to Car entities by IDs.

func (*PetUpdateOne) RemoveCars

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) RemoveCars(c ...*Car) *PetUpdateOne

RemoveCars removes "cars" edges to Car entities.

func (*PetUpdateOne) RemoveFriendIDs

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) RemoveFriendIDs(ids ...string) *PetUpdateOne

RemoveFriendIDs removes the "friends" edge to Pet entities by IDs.

func (*PetUpdateOne) RemoveFriends

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) RemoveFriends(p ...*Pet) *PetUpdateOne

RemoveFriends removes "friends" edges to Pet entities.

func (*PetUpdateOne) Save

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Pet, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated Pet entity.

func (*PetUpdateOne) SaveX

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Pet

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetUpdateOne) Select

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *PetUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

func (*PetUpdateOne) SetBestFriend

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) SetBestFriend(p *Pet) *PetUpdateOne

SetBestFriend sets the "best_friend" edge to the Pet entity.

func (*PetUpdateOne) SetBestFriendID

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) SetBestFriendID(id string) *PetUpdateOne

SetBestFriendID sets the "best_friend" edge to the Pet entity by ID.

func (*PetUpdateOne) SetNillableBestFriendID

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) SetNillableBestFriendID(id *string) *PetUpdateOne

SetNillableBestFriendID sets the "best_friend" edge to the Pet entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*PetUpdateOne) SetNillableOwnerID

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) SetNillableOwnerID(id *int) *PetUpdateOne

SetNillableOwnerID sets the "owner" edge to the User entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*PetUpdateOne) SetOwner

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) SetOwner(u *User) *PetUpdateOne

SetOwner sets the "owner" edge to the User entity.

func (*PetUpdateOne) SetOwnerID

func (puo *PetUpdateOne) SetOwnerID(id int) *PetUpdateOne

SetOwnerID sets the "owner" edge to the User entity by ID.

type PetUpsert

type PetUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

PetUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

type PetUpsertBulk

type PetUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

PetUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of Pet nodes.

func (*PetUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *PetUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *PetUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*PetUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *PetUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*PetUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *PetUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetUpsertBulk) Ignore

func (u *PetUpsertBulk) Ignore() *PetUpsertBulk

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Pet.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*PetUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *PetUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*PetUpsert)) *PetUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the PetCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*PetUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *PetUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *PetUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Pet.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(pet.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type PetUpsertOne

type PetUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

PetUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one Pet node.

func (*PetUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *PetUpsertOne) DoNothing() *PetUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*PetUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *PetUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*PetUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *PetUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetUpsertOne) ID

func (u *PetUpsertOne) ID(ctx context.Context) (id string, err error)

Exec executes the UPSERT query and returns the inserted/updated ID.

func (*PetUpsertOne) IDX

func (u *PetUpsertOne) IDX(ctx context.Context) string

IDX is like ID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*PetUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *PetUpsertOne) Ignore() *PetUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Pet.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*PetUpsertOne) Update

func (u *PetUpsertOne) Update(set func(*PetUpsert)) *PetUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the PetCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*PetUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *PetUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *PetUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create except the ID field. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Pet.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(pet.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type Pets

type Pets []*Pet

Pets is a parsable slice of Pet.

type Policy

type Policy = ent.Policy

ent aliases to avoid import conflicts in user's code.

type Querier

type Querier = ent.Querier

ent aliases to avoid import conflicts in user's code.

type QuerierFunc

type QuerierFunc = ent.QuerierFunc

ent aliases to avoid import conflicts in user's code.

type Query

type Query = ent.Query

ent aliases to avoid import conflicts in user's code.

type Revision

type Revision struct {

	// ID of the ent.
	ID string `json:"id,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Revision is the model entity for the Revision schema.

func (*Revision) String

func (r *Revision) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*Revision) Unwrap

func (r *Revision) Unwrap() *Revision

Unwrap unwraps the Revision entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*Revision) Update

func (r *Revision) Update() *RevisionUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this Revision. Note that you need to call Revision.Unwrap() before calling this method if this Revision was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type RevisionClient

type RevisionClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

RevisionClient is a client for the Revision schema.

func NewRevisionClient

func NewRevisionClient(c config) *RevisionClient

NewRevisionClient returns a client for the Revision from the given config.

func (*RevisionClient) Create

func (c *RevisionClient) Create() *RevisionCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a Revision entity.

func (*RevisionClient) CreateBulk

func (c *RevisionClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*RevisionCreate) *RevisionCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of Revision entities.

func (*RevisionClient) Delete

func (c *RevisionClient) Delete() *RevisionDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for Revision.

func (*RevisionClient) DeleteOne

func (c *RevisionClient) DeleteOne(r *Revision) *RevisionDeleteOne

DeleteOne returns a builder for deleting the given entity.

func (*RevisionClient) DeleteOneID

func (c *RevisionClient) DeleteOneID(id string) *RevisionDeleteOne

DeleteOneID returns a builder for deleting the given entity by its id.

func (*RevisionClient) Get

func (c *RevisionClient) Get(ctx context.Context, id string) (*Revision, error)

Get returns a Revision entity by its id.

func (*RevisionClient) GetX

func (c *RevisionClient) GetX(ctx context.Context, id string) *Revision

GetX is like Get, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionClient) Hooks

func (c *RevisionClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*RevisionClient) Intercept

func (c *RevisionClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `revision.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*RevisionClient) Interceptors

func (c *RevisionClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*RevisionClient) Query

func (c *RevisionClient) Query() *RevisionQuery

Query returns a query builder for Revision.

func (*RevisionClient) Update

func (c *RevisionClient) Update() *RevisionUpdate

Update returns an update builder for Revision.

func (*RevisionClient) UpdateOne

func (c *RevisionClient) UpdateOne(r *Revision) *RevisionUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*RevisionClient) UpdateOneID

func (c *RevisionClient) UpdateOneID(id string) *RevisionUpdateOne

UpdateOneID returns an update builder for the given id.

func (*RevisionClient) Use

func (c *RevisionClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `revision.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type RevisionCreate

type RevisionCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

RevisionCreate is the builder for creating a Revision entity.

func (*RevisionCreate) Exec

func (rc *RevisionCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*RevisionCreate) ExecX

func (rc *RevisionCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionCreate) Mutation

func (rc *RevisionCreate) Mutation() *RevisionMutation

Mutation returns the RevisionMutation object of the builder.

func (*RevisionCreate) OnConflict

func (rc *RevisionCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *RevisionUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Revision.Create().
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*RevisionCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (rc *RevisionCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *RevisionUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Revision.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*RevisionCreate) Save

func (rc *RevisionCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Revision, error)

Save creates the Revision in the database.

func (*RevisionCreate) SaveX

func (rc *RevisionCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Revision

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*RevisionCreate) SetID

func (rc *RevisionCreate) SetID(s string) *RevisionCreate

SetID sets the "id" field.

type RevisionCreateBulk

type RevisionCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

RevisionCreateBulk is the builder for creating many Revision entities in bulk.

func (*RevisionCreateBulk) Exec

func (rcb *RevisionCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*RevisionCreateBulk) ExecX

func (rcb *RevisionCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (rcb *RevisionCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *RevisionUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Revision.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*RevisionCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (rcb *RevisionCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *RevisionUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Revision.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*RevisionCreateBulk) Save

func (rcb *RevisionCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*Revision, error)

Save creates the Revision entities in the database.

func (*RevisionCreateBulk) SaveX

func (rcb *RevisionCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*Revision

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type RevisionDelete

type RevisionDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

RevisionDelete is the builder for deleting a Revision entity.

func (*RevisionDelete) Exec

func (rd *RevisionDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*RevisionDelete) ExecX

func (rd *RevisionDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionDelete) Where

func (rd *RevisionDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.Revision) *RevisionDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the RevisionDelete builder.

type RevisionDeleteOne

type RevisionDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

RevisionDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single Revision entity.

func (*RevisionDeleteOne) Exec

func (rdo *RevisionDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*RevisionDeleteOne) ExecX

func (rdo *RevisionDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type RevisionFilter

type RevisionFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

RevisionFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for RevisionQuery.

func (*RevisionFilter) Where

func (f *RevisionFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*RevisionFilter) WhereID

func (f *RevisionFilter) WhereID(p entql.StringP)

WhereID applies the entql string predicate on the id field.

type RevisionGroupBy

type RevisionGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

RevisionGroupBy is the group-by builder for Revision entities.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) Aggregate

func (rgb *RevisionGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *RevisionGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) Bool

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) Bools

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) Float64

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) Int

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) IntX

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) Ints

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) Scan

func (rgb *RevisionGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) String

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) StringX

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) Strings

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*RevisionGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *RevisionGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type RevisionMutation

type RevisionMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

RevisionMutation represents an operation that mutates the Revision nodes in the graph.

func (*RevisionMutation) AddField

func (m *RevisionMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*RevisionMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *RevisionMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*RevisionMutation) AddedField

func (m *RevisionMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*RevisionMutation) AddedFields

func (m *RevisionMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*RevisionMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *RevisionMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*RevisionMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *RevisionMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*RevisionMutation) ClearField

func (m *RevisionMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*RevisionMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *RevisionMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*RevisionMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *RevisionMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (RevisionMutation) Client

func (m RevisionMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*RevisionMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *RevisionMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*RevisionMutation) Field

func (m *RevisionMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*RevisionMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *RevisionMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*RevisionMutation) Fields

func (m *RevisionMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*RevisionMutation) Filter

func (m *RevisionMutation) Filter() *RevisionFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the RevisionMutation builder.

func (*RevisionMutation) ID

func (m *RevisionMutation) ID() (id string, exists bool)

ID returns the ID value in the mutation. Note that the ID is only available if it was provided to the builder or after it was returned from the database.

func (*RevisionMutation) IDs

func (m *RevisionMutation) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

IDs queries the database and returns the entity ids that match the mutation's predicate. That means, if the mutation is applied within a transaction with an isolation level such as sql.LevelSerializable, the returned ids match the ids of the rows that will be updated or updated by the mutation.

func (*RevisionMutation) OldField

func (m *RevisionMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*RevisionMutation) Op

func (m *RevisionMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*RevisionMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *RevisionMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*RevisionMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *RevisionMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*RevisionMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *RevisionMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*RevisionMutation) ResetField

func (m *RevisionMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*RevisionMutation) SetField

func (m *RevisionMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*RevisionMutation) SetID

func (m *RevisionMutation) SetID(id string)

SetID sets the value of the id field. Note that this operation is only accepted on creation of Revision entities.

func (*RevisionMutation) SetOp

func (m *RevisionMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (RevisionMutation) Tx

func (m RevisionMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*RevisionMutation) Type

func (m *RevisionMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (Revision).

func (*RevisionMutation) Where

func (m *RevisionMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.Revision)

Where appends a list predicates to the RevisionMutation builder.

func (*RevisionMutation) WhereP

func (m *RevisionMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the RevisionMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type RevisionQuery

type RevisionQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

RevisionQuery is the builder for querying Revision entities.

func (*RevisionQuery) Aggregate

func (rq *RevisionQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *RevisionSelect

Aggregate returns a RevisionSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*RevisionQuery) All

func (rq *RevisionQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*Revision, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of Revisions.

func (*RevisionQuery) AllX

func (rq *RevisionQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*Revision

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionQuery) Clone

func (rq *RevisionQuery) Clone() *RevisionQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the RevisionQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*RevisionQuery) Count

func (rq *RevisionQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*RevisionQuery) CountX

func (rq *RevisionQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionQuery) Exist

func (rq *RevisionQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*RevisionQuery) ExistX

func (rq *RevisionQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionQuery) Filter

func (rq *RevisionQuery) Filter() *RevisionFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the RevisionQuery builder.

func (*RevisionQuery) First

func (rq *RevisionQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*Revision, error)

First returns the first Revision entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Revision was found.

func (*RevisionQuery) FirstID

func (rq *RevisionQuery) FirstID(ctx context.Context) (id string, err error)

FirstID returns the first Revision ID from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Revision ID was found.

func (*RevisionQuery) FirstIDX

func (rq *RevisionQuery) FirstIDX(ctx context.Context) string

FirstIDX is like FirstID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionQuery) FirstX

func (rq *RevisionQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *Revision

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionQuery) GroupBy

func (rq *RevisionQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *RevisionGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

func (*RevisionQuery) IDs

func (rq *RevisionQuery) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

IDs executes the query and returns a list of Revision IDs.

func (*RevisionQuery) IDsX

func (rq *RevisionQuery) IDsX(ctx context.Context) []string

IDsX is like IDs, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionQuery) Limit

func (rq *RevisionQuery) Limit(limit int) *RevisionQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*RevisionQuery) Offset

func (rq *RevisionQuery) Offset(offset int) *RevisionQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*RevisionQuery) Only

func (rq *RevisionQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*Revision, error)

Only returns a single Revision entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Revision entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Revision entities are found.

func (*RevisionQuery) OnlyID

func (rq *RevisionQuery) OnlyID(ctx context.Context) (id string, err error)

OnlyID is like Only, but returns the only Revision ID in the query. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Revision ID is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no entities are found.

func (*RevisionQuery) OnlyIDX

func (rq *RevisionQuery) OnlyIDX(ctx context.Context) string

OnlyIDX is like OnlyID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionQuery) OnlyX

func (rq *RevisionQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *Revision

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionQuery) Order

func (rq *RevisionQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *RevisionQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (*RevisionQuery) Select

func (rq *RevisionQuery) Select(fields ...string) *RevisionSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

func (*RevisionQuery) Unique

func (rq *RevisionQuery) Unique(unique bool) *RevisionQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*RevisionQuery) Where

func (rq *RevisionQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.Revision) *RevisionQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the RevisionQuery builder.

type RevisionSelect

type RevisionSelect struct {
	*RevisionQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

RevisionSelect is the builder for selecting fields of Revision entities.

func (*RevisionSelect) Aggregate

func (rs *RevisionSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *RevisionSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*RevisionSelect) Bool

func (s *RevisionSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*RevisionSelect) BoolX

func (s *RevisionSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionSelect) Bools

func (s *RevisionSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*RevisionSelect) BoolsX

func (s *RevisionSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionSelect) Float64

func (s *RevisionSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*RevisionSelect) Float64X

func (s *RevisionSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionSelect) Float64s

func (s *RevisionSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*RevisionSelect) Float64sX

func (s *RevisionSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionSelect) Int

func (s *RevisionSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*RevisionSelect) IntX

func (s *RevisionSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionSelect) Ints

func (s *RevisionSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*RevisionSelect) IntsX

func (s *RevisionSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionSelect) Scan

func (rs *RevisionSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*RevisionSelect) ScanX

func (s *RevisionSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionSelect) String

func (s *RevisionSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*RevisionSelect) StringX

func (s *RevisionSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionSelect) Strings

func (s *RevisionSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*RevisionSelect) StringsX

func (s *RevisionSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type RevisionUpdate

type RevisionUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

RevisionUpdate is the builder for updating Revision entities.

func (*RevisionUpdate) Exec

func (ru *RevisionUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*RevisionUpdate) ExecX

func (ru *RevisionUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionUpdate) Mutation

func (ru *RevisionUpdate) Mutation() *RevisionMutation

Mutation returns the RevisionMutation object of the builder.

func (*RevisionUpdate) Save

func (ru *RevisionUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*RevisionUpdate) SaveX

func (ru *RevisionUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionUpdate) Where

func (ru *RevisionUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.Revision) *RevisionUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the RevisionUpdate builder.

type RevisionUpdateOne

type RevisionUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

RevisionUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single Revision entity.

func (*RevisionUpdateOne) Exec

func (ruo *RevisionUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*RevisionUpdateOne) ExecX

func (ruo *RevisionUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionUpdateOne) Mutation

func (ruo *RevisionUpdateOne) Mutation() *RevisionMutation

Mutation returns the RevisionMutation object of the builder.

func (*RevisionUpdateOne) Save

func (ruo *RevisionUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Revision, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated Revision entity.

func (*RevisionUpdateOne) SaveX

func (ruo *RevisionUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Revision

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionUpdateOne) Select

func (ruo *RevisionUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *RevisionUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

type RevisionUpsert

type RevisionUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

RevisionUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

type RevisionUpsertBulk

type RevisionUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

RevisionUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of Revision nodes.

func (*RevisionUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *RevisionUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *RevisionUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*RevisionUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *RevisionUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*RevisionUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *RevisionUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionUpsertBulk) Ignore

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Revision.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*RevisionUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *RevisionUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*RevisionUpsert)) *RevisionUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the RevisionCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*RevisionUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *RevisionUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *RevisionUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Revision.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(revision.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type RevisionUpsertOne

type RevisionUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

RevisionUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one Revision node.

func (*RevisionUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *RevisionUpsertOne) DoNothing() *RevisionUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*RevisionUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *RevisionUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*RevisionUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *RevisionUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionUpsertOne) ID

func (u *RevisionUpsertOne) ID(ctx context.Context) (id string, err error)

Exec executes the UPSERT query and returns the inserted/updated ID.

func (*RevisionUpsertOne) IDX

IDX is like ID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*RevisionUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *RevisionUpsertOne) Ignore() *RevisionUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Revision.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*RevisionUpsertOne) Update

func (u *RevisionUpsertOne) Update(set func(*RevisionUpsert)) *RevisionUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the RevisionCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*RevisionUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *RevisionUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *RevisionUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create except the ID field. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Revision.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(revision.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type Revisions

type Revisions []*Revision

Revisions is a parsable slice of Revision.

type RollbackFunc

type RollbackFunc func(context.Context, *Tx) error

The RollbackFunc type is an adapter to allow the use of ordinary function as a Rollbacker. If f is a function with the appropriate signature, RollbackFunc(f) is a Rollbacker that calls f.

func (RollbackFunc) Rollback

func (f RollbackFunc) Rollback(ctx context.Context, tx *Tx) error

Rollback calls f(ctx, m).

type RollbackHook

type RollbackHook func(Rollbacker) Rollbacker

RollbackHook defines the "rollback middleware". A function that gets a Rollbacker and returns a Rollbacker. For example:

hook := func(next ent.Rollbacker) ent.Rollbacker {
	return ent.RollbackFunc(func(ctx context.Context, tx *ent.Tx) error {
		// Do some stuff before.
		if err := next.Rollback(ctx, tx); err != nil {
			return err
		}
		// Do some stuff after.
		return nil
	})
}

type Rollbacker

type Rollbacker interface {
	Rollback(context.Context, *Tx) error
}

Rollbacker is the interface that wraps the Rollback method.

type Session

type Session struct {

	// ID of the ent.
	ID schema.ID `json:"id,omitempty"`
	// Edges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.
	// The values are being populated by the SessionQuery when eager-loading is set.
	Edges SessionEdges `json:"edges"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Session is the model entity for the Session schema.

func (*Session) QueryDevice

func (s *Session) QueryDevice() *DeviceQuery

QueryDevice queries the "device" edge of the Session entity.

func (*Session) String

func (s *Session) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*Session) Unwrap

func (s *Session) Unwrap() *Session

Unwrap unwraps the Session entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*Session) Update

func (s *Session) Update() *SessionUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this Session. Note that you need to call Session.Unwrap() before calling this method if this Session was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type SessionClient

type SessionClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SessionClient is a client for the Session schema.

func NewSessionClient

func NewSessionClient(c config) *SessionClient

NewSessionClient returns a client for the Session from the given config.

func (*SessionClient) Create

func (c *SessionClient) Create() *SessionCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a Session entity.

func (*SessionClient) CreateBulk

func (c *SessionClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*SessionCreate) *SessionCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of Session entities.

func (*SessionClient) Delete

func (c *SessionClient) Delete() *SessionDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for Session.

func (*SessionClient) DeleteOne

func (c *SessionClient) DeleteOne(s *Session) *SessionDeleteOne

DeleteOne returns a builder for deleting the given entity.

func (*SessionClient) DeleteOneID

func (c *SessionClient) DeleteOneID(id schema.ID) *SessionDeleteOne

DeleteOneID returns a builder for deleting the given entity by its id.

func (*SessionClient) Get

func (c *SessionClient) Get(ctx context.Context, id schema.ID) (*Session, error)

Get returns a Session entity by its id.

func (*SessionClient) GetX

func (c *SessionClient) GetX(ctx context.Context, id schema.ID) *Session

GetX is like Get, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionClient) Hooks

func (c *SessionClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*SessionClient) Intercept

func (c *SessionClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `session.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*SessionClient) Interceptors

func (c *SessionClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*SessionClient) Query

func (c *SessionClient) Query() *SessionQuery

Query returns a query builder for Session.

func (*SessionClient) QueryDevice

func (c *SessionClient) QueryDevice(s *Session) *DeviceQuery

QueryDevice queries the device edge of a Session.

func (*SessionClient) Update

func (c *SessionClient) Update() *SessionUpdate

Update returns an update builder for Session.

func (*SessionClient) UpdateOne

func (c *SessionClient) UpdateOne(s *Session) *SessionUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*SessionClient) UpdateOneID

func (c *SessionClient) UpdateOneID(id schema.ID) *SessionUpdateOne

UpdateOneID returns an update builder for the given id.

func (*SessionClient) Use

func (c *SessionClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `session.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type SessionCreate

type SessionCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SessionCreate is the builder for creating a Session entity.

func (*SessionCreate) Exec

func (sc *SessionCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*SessionCreate) ExecX

func (sc *SessionCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionCreate) Mutation

func (sc *SessionCreate) Mutation() *SessionMutation

Mutation returns the SessionMutation object of the builder.

func (*SessionCreate) OnConflict

func (sc *SessionCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *SessionUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Session.Create().
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*SessionCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (sc *SessionCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *SessionUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Session.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*SessionCreate) Save

func (sc *SessionCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Session, error)

Save creates the Session in the database.

func (*SessionCreate) SaveX

func (sc *SessionCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Session

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*SessionCreate) SetDevice

func (sc *SessionCreate) SetDevice(d *Device) *SessionCreate

SetDevice sets the "device" edge to the Device entity.

func (*SessionCreate) SetDeviceID

func (sc *SessionCreate) SetDeviceID(id schema.ID) *SessionCreate

SetDeviceID sets the "device" edge to the Device entity by ID.

func (*SessionCreate) SetID

func (sc *SessionCreate) SetID(s schema.ID) *SessionCreate

SetID sets the "id" field.

func (*SessionCreate) SetNillableDeviceID

func (sc *SessionCreate) SetNillableDeviceID(id *schema.ID) *SessionCreate

SetNillableDeviceID sets the "device" edge to the Device entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*SessionCreate) SetNillableID

func (sc *SessionCreate) SetNillableID(s *schema.ID) *SessionCreate

SetNillableID sets the "id" field if the given value is not nil.

type SessionCreateBulk

type SessionCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SessionCreateBulk is the builder for creating many Session entities in bulk.

func (*SessionCreateBulk) Exec

func (scb *SessionCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*SessionCreateBulk) ExecX

func (scb *SessionCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (scb *SessionCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *SessionUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Session.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*SessionCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (scb *SessionCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *SessionUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Session.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*SessionCreateBulk) Save

func (scb *SessionCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*Session, error)

Save creates the Session entities in the database.

func (*SessionCreateBulk) SaveX

func (scb *SessionCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*Session

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type SessionDelete

type SessionDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SessionDelete is the builder for deleting a Session entity.

func (*SessionDelete) Exec

func (sd *SessionDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*SessionDelete) ExecX

func (sd *SessionDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionDelete) Where

func (sd *SessionDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.Session) *SessionDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the SessionDelete builder.

type SessionDeleteOne

type SessionDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SessionDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single Session entity.

func (*SessionDeleteOne) Exec

func (sdo *SessionDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*SessionDeleteOne) ExecX

func (sdo *SessionDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type SessionEdges

type SessionEdges struct {
	// Device holds the value of the device edge.
	Device *Device `json:"device,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SessionEdges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.

func (SessionEdges) DeviceOrErr

func (e SessionEdges) DeviceOrErr() (*Device, error)

DeviceOrErr returns the Device value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading, or loaded but was not found.

type SessionFilter

type SessionFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SessionFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for SessionQuery.

func (*SessionFilter) Where

func (f *SessionFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*SessionFilter) WhereHasDevice

func (f *SessionFilter) WhereHasDevice()

WhereHasDevice applies a predicate to check if query has an edge device.

func (*SessionFilter) WhereHasDeviceWith

func (f *SessionFilter) WhereHasDeviceWith(preds ...predicate.Device)

WhereHasDeviceWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge device with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*SessionFilter) WhereID

func (f *SessionFilter) WhereID(p entql.BytesP)

WhereID applies the entql []byte predicate on the id field.

type SessionGroupBy

type SessionGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SessionGroupBy is the group-by builder for Session entities.

func (*SessionGroupBy) Aggregate

func (sgb *SessionGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *SessionGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*SessionGroupBy) Bool

func (s *SessionGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*SessionGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *SessionGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionGroupBy) Bools

func (s *SessionGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*SessionGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *SessionGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionGroupBy) Float64

func (s *SessionGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*SessionGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *SessionGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *SessionGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*SessionGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *SessionGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionGroupBy) Int

func (s *SessionGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*SessionGroupBy) IntX

func (s *SessionGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionGroupBy) Ints

func (s *SessionGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*SessionGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *SessionGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionGroupBy) Scan

func (sgb *SessionGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*SessionGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *SessionGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionGroupBy) String

func (s *SessionGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*SessionGroupBy) StringX

func (s *SessionGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionGroupBy) Strings

func (s *SessionGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*SessionGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *SessionGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type SessionMutation

type SessionMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SessionMutation represents an operation that mutates the Session nodes in the graph.

func (*SessionMutation) AddField

func (m *SessionMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*SessionMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *SessionMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*SessionMutation) AddedField

func (m *SessionMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*SessionMutation) AddedFields

func (m *SessionMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*SessionMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *SessionMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*SessionMutation) ClearDevice

func (m *SessionMutation) ClearDevice()

ClearDevice clears the "device" edge to the Device entity.

func (*SessionMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *SessionMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*SessionMutation) ClearField

func (m *SessionMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*SessionMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *SessionMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*SessionMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *SessionMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (SessionMutation) Client

func (m SessionMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*SessionMutation) DeviceCleared

func (m *SessionMutation) DeviceCleared() bool

DeviceCleared reports if the "device" edge to the Device entity was cleared.

func (*SessionMutation) DeviceID

func (m *SessionMutation) DeviceID() (id schema.ID, exists bool)

DeviceID returns the "device" edge ID in the mutation.

func (*SessionMutation) DeviceIDs

func (m *SessionMutation) DeviceIDs() (ids []schema.ID)

DeviceIDs returns the "device" edge IDs in the mutation. Note that IDs always returns len(IDs) <= 1 for unique edges, and you should use DeviceID instead. It exists only for internal usage by the builders.

func (*SessionMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *SessionMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*SessionMutation) Field

func (m *SessionMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*SessionMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *SessionMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*SessionMutation) Fields

func (m *SessionMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*SessionMutation) Filter

func (m *SessionMutation) Filter() *SessionFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the SessionMutation builder.

func (*SessionMutation) ID

func (m *SessionMutation) ID() (id schema.ID, exists bool)

ID returns the ID value in the mutation. Note that the ID is only available if it was provided to the builder or after it was returned from the database.

func (*SessionMutation) IDs

func (m *SessionMutation) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]schema.ID, error)

IDs queries the database and returns the entity ids that match the mutation's predicate. That means, if the mutation is applied within a transaction with an isolation level such as sql.LevelSerializable, the returned ids match the ids of the rows that will be updated or updated by the mutation.

func (*SessionMutation) OldField

func (m *SessionMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*SessionMutation) Op

func (m *SessionMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*SessionMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *SessionMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*SessionMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *SessionMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*SessionMutation) ResetDevice

func (m *SessionMutation) ResetDevice()

ResetDevice resets all changes to the "device" edge.

func (*SessionMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *SessionMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*SessionMutation) ResetField

func (m *SessionMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*SessionMutation) SetDeviceID

func (m *SessionMutation) SetDeviceID(id schema.ID)

SetDeviceID sets the "device" edge to the Device entity by id.

func (*SessionMutation) SetField

func (m *SessionMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*SessionMutation) SetID

func (m *SessionMutation) SetID(id schema.ID)

SetID sets the value of the id field. Note that this operation is only accepted on creation of Session entities.

func (*SessionMutation) SetOp

func (m *SessionMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (SessionMutation) Tx

func (m SessionMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*SessionMutation) Type

func (m *SessionMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (Session).

func (*SessionMutation) Where

func (m *SessionMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.Session)

Where appends a list predicates to the SessionMutation builder.

func (*SessionMutation) WhereP

func (m *SessionMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the SessionMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type SessionQuery

type SessionQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SessionQuery is the builder for querying Session entities.

func (*SessionQuery) Aggregate

func (sq *SessionQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *SessionSelect

Aggregate returns a SessionSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*SessionQuery) All

func (sq *SessionQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*Session, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of Sessions.

func (*SessionQuery) AllX

func (sq *SessionQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*Session

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionQuery) Clone

func (sq *SessionQuery) Clone() *SessionQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the SessionQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*SessionQuery) Count

func (sq *SessionQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*SessionQuery) CountX

func (sq *SessionQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionQuery) Exist

func (sq *SessionQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*SessionQuery) ExistX

func (sq *SessionQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionQuery) Filter

func (sq *SessionQuery) Filter() *SessionFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the SessionQuery builder.

func (*SessionQuery) First

func (sq *SessionQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*Session, error)

First returns the first Session entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Session was found.

func (*SessionQuery) FirstID

func (sq *SessionQuery) FirstID(ctx context.Context) (id schema.ID, err error)

FirstID returns the first Session ID from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Session ID was found.

func (*SessionQuery) FirstIDX

func (sq *SessionQuery) FirstIDX(ctx context.Context) schema.ID

FirstIDX is like FirstID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionQuery) FirstX

func (sq *SessionQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *Session

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionQuery) GroupBy

func (sq *SessionQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *SessionGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

func (*SessionQuery) IDs

func (sq *SessionQuery) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]schema.ID, error)

IDs executes the query and returns a list of Session IDs.

func (*SessionQuery) IDsX

func (sq *SessionQuery) IDsX(ctx context.Context) []schema.ID

IDsX is like IDs, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionQuery) Limit

func (sq *SessionQuery) Limit(limit int) *SessionQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*SessionQuery) Offset

func (sq *SessionQuery) Offset(offset int) *SessionQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*SessionQuery) Only

func (sq *SessionQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*Session, error)

Only returns a single Session entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Session entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Session entities are found.

func (*SessionQuery) OnlyID

func (sq *SessionQuery) OnlyID(ctx context.Context) (id schema.ID, err error)

OnlyID is like Only, but returns the only Session ID in the query. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Session ID is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no entities are found.

func (*SessionQuery) OnlyIDX

func (sq *SessionQuery) OnlyIDX(ctx context.Context) schema.ID

OnlyIDX is like OnlyID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionQuery) OnlyX

func (sq *SessionQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *Session

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionQuery) Order

func (sq *SessionQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *SessionQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (*SessionQuery) QueryDevice

func (sq *SessionQuery) QueryDevice() *DeviceQuery

QueryDevice chains the current query on the "device" edge.

func (*SessionQuery) Select

func (sq *SessionQuery) Select(fields ...string) *SessionSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

func (*SessionQuery) Unique

func (sq *SessionQuery) Unique(unique bool) *SessionQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*SessionQuery) Where

func (sq *SessionQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.Session) *SessionQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the SessionQuery builder.

func (*SessionQuery) WithDevice

func (sq *SessionQuery) WithDevice(opts ...func(*DeviceQuery)) *SessionQuery

WithDevice tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "device" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

type SessionSelect

type SessionSelect struct {
	*SessionQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SessionSelect is the builder for selecting fields of Session entities.

func (*SessionSelect) Aggregate

func (ss *SessionSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *SessionSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*SessionSelect) Bool

func (s *SessionSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*SessionSelect) BoolX

func (s *SessionSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionSelect) Bools

func (s *SessionSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*SessionSelect) BoolsX

func (s *SessionSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionSelect) Float64

func (s *SessionSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*SessionSelect) Float64X

func (s *SessionSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionSelect) Float64s

func (s *SessionSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*SessionSelect) Float64sX

func (s *SessionSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionSelect) Int

func (s *SessionSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*SessionSelect) IntX

func (s *SessionSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionSelect) Ints

func (s *SessionSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*SessionSelect) IntsX

func (s *SessionSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionSelect) Scan

func (ss *SessionSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*SessionSelect) ScanX

func (s *SessionSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionSelect) String

func (s *SessionSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*SessionSelect) StringX

func (s *SessionSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionSelect) Strings

func (s *SessionSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*SessionSelect) StringsX

func (s *SessionSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type SessionUpdate

type SessionUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SessionUpdate is the builder for updating Session entities.

func (*SessionUpdate) ClearDevice

func (su *SessionUpdate) ClearDevice() *SessionUpdate

ClearDevice clears the "device" edge to the Device entity.

func (*SessionUpdate) Exec

func (su *SessionUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*SessionUpdate) ExecX

func (su *SessionUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionUpdate) Mutation

func (su *SessionUpdate) Mutation() *SessionMutation

Mutation returns the SessionMutation object of the builder.

func (*SessionUpdate) Save

func (su *SessionUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*SessionUpdate) SaveX

func (su *SessionUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionUpdate) SetDevice

func (su *SessionUpdate) SetDevice(d *Device) *SessionUpdate

SetDevice sets the "device" edge to the Device entity.

func (*SessionUpdate) SetDeviceID

func (su *SessionUpdate) SetDeviceID(id schema.ID) *SessionUpdate

SetDeviceID sets the "device" edge to the Device entity by ID.

func (*SessionUpdate) SetNillableDeviceID

func (su *SessionUpdate) SetNillableDeviceID(id *schema.ID) *SessionUpdate

SetNillableDeviceID sets the "device" edge to the Device entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*SessionUpdate) Where

func (su *SessionUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.Session) *SessionUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the SessionUpdate builder.

type SessionUpdateOne

type SessionUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SessionUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single Session entity.

func (*SessionUpdateOne) ClearDevice

func (suo *SessionUpdateOne) ClearDevice() *SessionUpdateOne

ClearDevice clears the "device" edge to the Device entity.

func (*SessionUpdateOne) Exec

func (suo *SessionUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*SessionUpdateOne) ExecX

func (suo *SessionUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionUpdateOne) Mutation

func (suo *SessionUpdateOne) Mutation() *SessionMutation

Mutation returns the SessionMutation object of the builder.

func (*SessionUpdateOne) Save

func (suo *SessionUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Session, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated Session entity.

func (*SessionUpdateOne) SaveX

func (suo *SessionUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Session

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionUpdateOne) Select

func (suo *SessionUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *SessionUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

func (*SessionUpdateOne) SetDevice

func (suo *SessionUpdateOne) SetDevice(d *Device) *SessionUpdateOne

SetDevice sets the "device" edge to the Device entity.

func (*SessionUpdateOne) SetDeviceID

func (suo *SessionUpdateOne) SetDeviceID(id schema.ID) *SessionUpdateOne

SetDeviceID sets the "device" edge to the Device entity by ID.

func (*SessionUpdateOne) SetNillableDeviceID

func (suo *SessionUpdateOne) SetNillableDeviceID(id *schema.ID) *SessionUpdateOne

SetNillableDeviceID sets the "device" edge to the Device entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

type SessionUpsert

type SessionUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

SessionUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

type SessionUpsertBulk

type SessionUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SessionUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of Session nodes.

func (*SessionUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *SessionUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *SessionUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*SessionUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *SessionUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*SessionUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *SessionUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionUpsertBulk) Ignore

func (u *SessionUpsertBulk) Ignore() *SessionUpsertBulk

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Session.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*SessionUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *SessionUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*SessionUpsert)) *SessionUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the SessionCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*SessionUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *SessionUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *SessionUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Session.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(session.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type SessionUpsertOne

type SessionUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

SessionUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one Session node.

func (*SessionUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *SessionUpsertOne) DoNothing() *SessionUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*SessionUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *SessionUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*SessionUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *SessionUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionUpsertOne) ID

func (u *SessionUpsertOne) ID(ctx context.Context) (id schema.ID, err error)

Exec executes the UPSERT query and returns the inserted/updated ID.

func (*SessionUpsertOne) IDX

IDX is like ID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*SessionUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *SessionUpsertOne) Ignore() *SessionUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Session.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*SessionUpsertOne) Update

func (u *SessionUpsertOne) Update(set func(*SessionUpsert)) *SessionUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the SessionCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*SessionUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *SessionUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *SessionUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create except the ID field. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Session.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(session.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type Sessions

type Sessions []*Session

Sessions is a parsable slice of Session.

type Token

type Token struct {

	// ID of the ent.
	ID sid.ID `json:"id,omitempty"`
	// Body holds the value of the "body" field.
	Body string `json:"body,omitempty"`
	// Edges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.
	// The values are being populated by the TokenQuery when eager-loading is set.
	Edges TokenEdges `json:"edges"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Token is the model entity for the Token schema.

func (*Token) QueryAccount

func (t *Token) QueryAccount() *AccountQuery

QueryAccount queries the "account" edge of the Token entity.

func (*Token) String

func (t *Token) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*Token) Unwrap

func (t *Token) Unwrap() *Token

Unwrap unwraps the Token entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*Token) Update

func (t *Token) Update() *TokenUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this Token. Note that you need to call Token.Unwrap() before calling this method if this Token was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type TokenClient

type TokenClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

TokenClient is a client for the Token schema.

func NewTokenClient

func NewTokenClient(c config) *TokenClient

NewTokenClient returns a client for the Token from the given config.

func (*TokenClient) Create

func (c *TokenClient) Create() *TokenCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a Token entity.

func (*TokenClient) CreateBulk

func (c *TokenClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*TokenCreate) *TokenCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of Token entities.

func (*TokenClient) Delete

func (c *TokenClient) Delete() *TokenDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for Token.

func (*TokenClient) DeleteOne

func (c *TokenClient) DeleteOne(t *Token) *TokenDeleteOne

DeleteOne returns a builder for deleting the given entity.

func (*TokenClient) DeleteOneID

func (c *TokenClient) DeleteOneID(id sid.ID) *TokenDeleteOne

DeleteOneID returns a builder for deleting the given entity by its id.

func (*TokenClient) Get

func (c *TokenClient) Get(ctx context.Context, id sid.ID) (*Token, error)

Get returns a Token entity by its id.

func (*TokenClient) GetX

func (c *TokenClient) GetX(ctx context.Context, id sid.ID) *Token

GetX is like Get, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenClient) Hooks

func (c *TokenClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*TokenClient) Intercept

func (c *TokenClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `token.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*TokenClient) Interceptors

func (c *TokenClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*TokenClient) Query

func (c *TokenClient) Query() *TokenQuery

Query returns a query builder for Token.

func (*TokenClient) QueryAccount

func (c *TokenClient) QueryAccount(t *Token) *AccountQuery

QueryAccount queries the account edge of a Token.

func (*TokenClient) Update

func (c *TokenClient) Update() *TokenUpdate

Update returns an update builder for Token.

func (*TokenClient) UpdateOne

func (c *TokenClient) UpdateOne(t *Token) *TokenUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*TokenClient) UpdateOneID

func (c *TokenClient) UpdateOneID(id sid.ID) *TokenUpdateOne

UpdateOneID returns an update builder for the given id.

func (*TokenClient) Use

func (c *TokenClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `token.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type TokenCreate

type TokenCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

TokenCreate is the builder for creating a Token entity.

func (*TokenCreate) Exec

func (tc *TokenCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*TokenCreate) ExecX

func (tc *TokenCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenCreate) Mutation

func (tc *TokenCreate) Mutation() *TokenMutation

Mutation returns the TokenMutation object of the builder.

func (*TokenCreate) OnConflict

func (tc *TokenCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *TokenUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Token.Create().
	SetBody(v).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.TokenUpsert) {
		SetBody(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*TokenCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (tc *TokenCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *TokenUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Token.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*TokenCreate) Save

func (tc *TokenCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Token, error)

Save creates the Token in the database.

func (*TokenCreate) SaveX

func (tc *TokenCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Token

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*TokenCreate) SetAccount

func (tc *TokenCreate) SetAccount(a *Account) *TokenCreate

SetAccount sets the "account" edge to the Account entity.

func (*TokenCreate) SetAccountID

func (tc *TokenCreate) SetAccountID(id sid.ID) *TokenCreate

SetAccountID sets the "account" edge to the Account entity by ID.

func (*TokenCreate) SetBody

func (tc *TokenCreate) SetBody(s string) *TokenCreate

SetBody sets the "body" field.

func (*TokenCreate) SetID

func (tc *TokenCreate) SetID(s sid.ID) *TokenCreate

SetID sets the "id" field.

func (*TokenCreate) SetNillableID

func (tc *TokenCreate) SetNillableID(s *sid.ID) *TokenCreate

SetNillableID sets the "id" field if the given value is not nil.

type TokenCreateBulk

type TokenCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

TokenCreateBulk is the builder for creating many Token entities in bulk.

func (*TokenCreateBulk) Exec

func (tcb *TokenCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*TokenCreateBulk) ExecX

func (tcb *TokenCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (tcb *TokenCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *TokenUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.Token.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	// Override some of the fields with custom
	// update values.
	Update(func(u *ent.TokenUpsert) {
		SetBody(v+v).
	}).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*TokenCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (tcb *TokenCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *TokenUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Token.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*TokenCreateBulk) Save

func (tcb *TokenCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*Token, error)

Save creates the Token entities in the database.

func (*TokenCreateBulk) SaveX

func (tcb *TokenCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*Token

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type TokenDelete

type TokenDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

TokenDelete is the builder for deleting a Token entity.

func (*TokenDelete) Exec

func (td *TokenDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*TokenDelete) ExecX

func (td *TokenDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenDelete) Where

func (td *TokenDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.Token) *TokenDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the TokenDelete builder.

type TokenDeleteOne

type TokenDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

TokenDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single Token entity.

func (*TokenDeleteOne) Exec

func (tdo *TokenDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*TokenDeleteOne) ExecX

func (tdo *TokenDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type TokenEdges

type TokenEdges struct {
	// Account holds the value of the account edge.
	Account *Account `json:"account,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

TokenEdges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.

func (TokenEdges) AccountOrErr

func (e TokenEdges) AccountOrErr() (*Account, error)

AccountOrErr returns the Account value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading, or loaded but was not found.

type TokenFilter

type TokenFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

TokenFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for TokenQuery.

func (*TokenFilter) Where

func (f *TokenFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*TokenFilter) WhereBody

func (f *TokenFilter) WhereBody(p entql.StringP)

WhereBody applies the entql string predicate on the body field.

func (*TokenFilter) WhereHasAccount

func (f *TokenFilter) WhereHasAccount()

WhereHasAccount applies a predicate to check if query has an edge account.

func (*TokenFilter) WhereHasAccountWith

func (f *TokenFilter) WhereHasAccountWith(preds ...predicate.Account)

WhereHasAccountWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge account with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*TokenFilter) WhereID

func (f *TokenFilter) WhereID(p entql.OtherP)

WhereID applies the entql other predicate on the id field.

type TokenGroupBy

type TokenGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

TokenGroupBy is the group-by builder for Token entities.

func (*TokenGroupBy) Aggregate

func (tgb *TokenGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *TokenGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*TokenGroupBy) Bool

func (s *TokenGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*TokenGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *TokenGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenGroupBy) Bools

func (s *TokenGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*TokenGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *TokenGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenGroupBy) Float64

func (s *TokenGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*TokenGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *TokenGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *TokenGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*TokenGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *TokenGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenGroupBy) Int

func (s *TokenGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*TokenGroupBy) IntX

func (s *TokenGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenGroupBy) Ints

func (s *TokenGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*TokenGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *TokenGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenGroupBy) Scan

func (tgb *TokenGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*TokenGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *TokenGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenGroupBy) String

func (s *TokenGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*TokenGroupBy) StringX

func (s *TokenGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenGroupBy) Strings

func (s *TokenGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*TokenGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *TokenGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type TokenMutation

type TokenMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

TokenMutation represents an operation that mutates the Token nodes in the graph.

func (*TokenMutation) AccountCleared

func (m *TokenMutation) AccountCleared() bool

AccountCleared reports if the "account" edge to the Account entity was cleared.

func (*TokenMutation) AccountID

func (m *TokenMutation) AccountID() (id sid.ID, exists bool)

AccountID returns the "account" edge ID in the mutation.

func (*TokenMutation) AccountIDs

func (m *TokenMutation) AccountIDs() (ids []sid.ID)

AccountIDs returns the "account" edge IDs in the mutation. Note that IDs always returns len(IDs) <= 1 for unique edges, and you should use AccountID instead. It exists only for internal usage by the builders.

func (*TokenMutation) AddField

func (m *TokenMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*TokenMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *TokenMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*TokenMutation) AddedField

func (m *TokenMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*TokenMutation) AddedFields

func (m *TokenMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*TokenMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *TokenMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*TokenMutation) Body

func (m *TokenMutation) Body() (r string, exists bool)

Body returns the value of the "body" field in the mutation.

func (*TokenMutation) ClearAccount

func (m *TokenMutation) ClearAccount()

ClearAccount clears the "account" edge to the Account entity.

func (*TokenMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *TokenMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*TokenMutation) ClearField

func (m *TokenMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*TokenMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *TokenMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*TokenMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *TokenMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (TokenMutation) Client

func (m TokenMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*TokenMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *TokenMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*TokenMutation) Field

func (m *TokenMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*TokenMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *TokenMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*TokenMutation) Fields

func (m *TokenMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*TokenMutation) Filter

func (m *TokenMutation) Filter() *TokenFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the TokenMutation builder.

func (*TokenMutation) ID

func (m *TokenMutation) ID() (id sid.ID, exists bool)

ID returns the ID value in the mutation. Note that the ID is only available if it was provided to the builder or after it was returned from the database.

func (*TokenMutation) IDs

func (m *TokenMutation) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]sid.ID, error)

IDs queries the database and returns the entity ids that match the mutation's predicate. That means, if the mutation is applied within a transaction with an isolation level such as sql.LevelSerializable, the returned ids match the ids of the rows that will be updated or updated by the mutation.

func (*TokenMutation) OldBody

func (m *TokenMutation) OldBody(ctx context.Context) (v string, err error)

OldBody returns the old "body" field's value of the Token entity. If the Token object wasn't provided to the builder, the object is fetched from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the database query fails.

func (*TokenMutation) OldField

func (m *TokenMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*TokenMutation) Op

func (m *TokenMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*TokenMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *TokenMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*TokenMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *TokenMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*TokenMutation) ResetAccount

func (m *TokenMutation) ResetAccount()

ResetAccount resets all changes to the "account" edge.

func (*TokenMutation) ResetBody

func (m *TokenMutation) ResetBody()

ResetBody resets all changes to the "body" field.

func (*TokenMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *TokenMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*TokenMutation) ResetField

func (m *TokenMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*TokenMutation) SetAccountID

func (m *TokenMutation) SetAccountID(id sid.ID)

SetAccountID sets the "account" edge to the Account entity by id.

func (*TokenMutation) SetBody

func (m *TokenMutation) SetBody(s string)

SetBody sets the "body" field.

func (*TokenMutation) SetField

func (m *TokenMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*TokenMutation) SetID

func (m *TokenMutation) SetID(id sid.ID)

SetID sets the value of the id field. Note that this operation is only accepted on creation of Token entities.

func (*TokenMutation) SetOp

func (m *TokenMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (TokenMutation) Tx

func (m TokenMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*TokenMutation) Type

func (m *TokenMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (Token).

func (*TokenMutation) Where

func (m *TokenMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.Token)

Where appends a list predicates to the TokenMutation builder.

func (*TokenMutation) WhereP

func (m *TokenMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the TokenMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type TokenQuery

type TokenQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

TokenQuery is the builder for querying Token entities.

func (*TokenQuery) Aggregate

func (tq *TokenQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *TokenSelect

Aggregate returns a TokenSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*TokenQuery) All

func (tq *TokenQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*Token, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of Tokens.

func (*TokenQuery) AllX

func (tq *TokenQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*Token

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenQuery) Clone

func (tq *TokenQuery) Clone() *TokenQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the TokenQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*TokenQuery) Count

func (tq *TokenQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*TokenQuery) CountX

func (tq *TokenQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenQuery) Exist

func (tq *TokenQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*TokenQuery) ExistX

func (tq *TokenQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenQuery) Filter

func (tq *TokenQuery) Filter() *TokenFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the TokenQuery builder.

func (*TokenQuery) First

func (tq *TokenQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*Token, error)

First returns the first Token entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Token was found.

func (*TokenQuery) FirstID

func (tq *TokenQuery) FirstID(ctx context.Context) (id sid.ID, err error)

FirstID returns the first Token ID from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Token ID was found.

func (*TokenQuery) FirstIDX

func (tq *TokenQuery) FirstIDX(ctx context.Context) sid.ID

FirstIDX is like FirstID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenQuery) FirstX

func (tq *TokenQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *Token

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenQuery) GroupBy

func (tq *TokenQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *TokenGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

Example:

var v []struct {
	Body string `json:"body,omitempty"`
	Count int `json:"count,omitempty"`
}

client.Token.Query().
	GroupBy(token.FieldBody).
	Aggregate(ent.Count()).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*TokenQuery) IDs

func (tq *TokenQuery) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]sid.ID, error)

IDs executes the query and returns a list of Token IDs.

func (*TokenQuery) IDsX

func (tq *TokenQuery) IDsX(ctx context.Context) []sid.ID

IDsX is like IDs, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenQuery) Limit

func (tq *TokenQuery) Limit(limit int) *TokenQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*TokenQuery) Offset

func (tq *TokenQuery) Offset(offset int) *TokenQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*TokenQuery) Only

func (tq *TokenQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*Token, error)

Only returns a single Token entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Token entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no Token entities are found.

func (*TokenQuery) OnlyID

func (tq *TokenQuery) OnlyID(ctx context.Context) (id sid.ID, err error)

OnlyID is like Only, but returns the only Token ID in the query. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one Token ID is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no entities are found.

func (*TokenQuery) OnlyIDX

func (tq *TokenQuery) OnlyIDX(ctx context.Context) sid.ID

OnlyIDX is like OnlyID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenQuery) OnlyX

func (tq *TokenQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *Token

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenQuery) Order

func (tq *TokenQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *TokenQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (*TokenQuery) QueryAccount

func (tq *TokenQuery) QueryAccount() *AccountQuery

QueryAccount chains the current query on the "account" edge.

func (*TokenQuery) Select

func (tq *TokenQuery) Select(fields ...string) *TokenSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

Example:

var v []struct {
	Body string `json:"body,omitempty"`
}

client.Token.Query().
	Select(token.FieldBody).
	Scan(ctx, &v)

func (*TokenQuery) Unique

func (tq *TokenQuery) Unique(unique bool) *TokenQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*TokenQuery) Where

func (tq *TokenQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.Token) *TokenQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the TokenQuery builder.

func (*TokenQuery) WithAccount

func (tq *TokenQuery) WithAccount(opts ...func(*AccountQuery)) *TokenQuery

WithAccount tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "account" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

type TokenSelect

type TokenSelect struct {
	*TokenQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

TokenSelect is the builder for selecting fields of Token entities.

func (*TokenSelect) Aggregate

func (ts *TokenSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *TokenSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*TokenSelect) Bool

func (s *TokenSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*TokenSelect) BoolX

func (s *TokenSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenSelect) Bools

func (s *TokenSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*TokenSelect) BoolsX

func (s *TokenSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenSelect) Float64

func (s *TokenSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*TokenSelect) Float64X

func (s *TokenSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenSelect) Float64s

func (s *TokenSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*TokenSelect) Float64sX

func (s *TokenSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenSelect) Int

func (s *TokenSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*TokenSelect) IntX

func (s *TokenSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenSelect) Ints

func (s *TokenSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*TokenSelect) IntsX

func (s *TokenSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenSelect) Scan

func (ts *TokenSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*TokenSelect) ScanX

func (s *TokenSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenSelect) String

func (s *TokenSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*TokenSelect) StringX

func (s *TokenSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenSelect) Strings

func (s *TokenSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*TokenSelect) StringsX

func (s *TokenSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type TokenUpdate

type TokenUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

TokenUpdate is the builder for updating Token entities.

func (*TokenUpdate) ClearAccount

func (tu *TokenUpdate) ClearAccount() *TokenUpdate

ClearAccount clears the "account" edge to the Account entity.

func (*TokenUpdate) Exec

func (tu *TokenUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*TokenUpdate) ExecX

func (tu *TokenUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenUpdate) Mutation

func (tu *TokenUpdate) Mutation() *TokenMutation

Mutation returns the TokenMutation object of the builder.

func (*TokenUpdate) Save

func (tu *TokenUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*TokenUpdate) SaveX

func (tu *TokenUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenUpdate) SetAccount

func (tu *TokenUpdate) SetAccount(a *Account) *TokenUpdate

SetAccount sets the "account" edge to the Account entity.

func (*TokenUpdate) SetAccountID

func (tu *TokenUpdate) SetAccountID(id sid.ID) *TokenUpdate

SetAccountID sets the "account" edge to the Account entity by ID.

func (*TokenUpdate) SetBody

func (tu *TokenUpdate) SetBody(s string) *TokenUpdate

SetBody sets the "body" field.

func (*TokenUpdate) Where

func (tu *TokenUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.Token) *TokenUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the TokenUpdate builder.

type TokenUpdateOne

type TokenUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

TokenUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single Token entity.

func (*TokenUpdateOne) ClearAccount

func (tuo *TokenUpdateOne) ClearAccount() *TokenUpdateOne

ClearAccount clears the "account" edge to the Account entity.

func (*TokenUpdateOne) Exec

func (tuo *TokenUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*TokenUpdateOne) ExecX

func (tuo *TokenUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenUpdateOne) Mutation

func (tuo *TokenUpdateOne) Mutation() *TokenMutation

Mutation returns the TokenMutation object of the builder.

func (*TokenUpdateOne) Save

func (tuo *TokenUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*Token, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated Token entity.

func (*TokenUpdateOne) SaveX

func (tuo *TokenUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *Token

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenUpdateOne) Select

func (tuo *TokenUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *TokenUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

func (*TokenUpdateOne) SetAccount

func (tuo *TokenUpdateOne) SetAccount(a *Account) *TokenUpdateOne

SetAccount sets the "account" edge to the Account entity.

func (*TokenUpdateOne) SetAccountID

func (tuo *TokenUpdateOne) SetAccountID(id sid.ID) *TokenUpdateOne

SetAccountID sets the "account" edge to the Account entity by ID.

func (*TokenUpdateOne) SetBody

func (tuo *TokenUpdateOne) SetBody(s string) *TokenUpdateOne

SetBody sets the "body" field.

type TokenUpsert

type TokenUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

TokenUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

func (*TokenUpsert) SetBody

func (u *TokenUpsert) SetBody(v string) *TokenUpsert

SetBody sets the "body" field.

func (*TokenUpsert) UpdateBody

func (u *TokenUpsert) UpdateBody() *TokenUpsert

UpdateBody sets the "body" field to the value that was provided on create.

type TokenUpsertBulk

type TokenUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

TokenUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of Token nodes.

func (*TokenUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *TokenUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *TokenUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*TokenUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *TokenUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*TokenUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *TokenUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenUpsertBulk) Ignore

func (u *TokenUpsertBulk) Ignore() *TokenUpsertBulk

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Token.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*TokenUpsertBulk) SetBody

func (u *TokenUpsertBulk) SetBody(v string) *TokenUpsertBulk

SetBody sets the "body" field.

func (*TokenUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *TokenUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*TokenUpsert)) *TokenUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the TokenCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*TokenUpsertBulk) UpdateBody

func (u *TokenUpsertBulk) UpdateBody() *TokenUpsertBulk

UpdateBody sets the "body" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*TokenUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *TokenUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *TokenUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Token.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(token.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type TokenUpsertOne

type TokenUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

TokenUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one Token node.

func (*TokenUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *TokenUpsertOne) DoNothing() *TokenUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*TokenUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *TokenUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*TokenUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *TokenUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenUpsertOne) ID

func (u *TokenUpsertOne) ID(ctx context.Context) (id sid.ID, err error)

Exec executes the UPSERT query and returns the inserted/updated ID.

func (*TokenUpsertOne) IDX

func (u *TokenUpsertOne) IDX(ctx context.Context) sid.ID

IDX is like ID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*TokenUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *TokenUpsertOne) Ignore() *TokenUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Token.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*TokenUpsertOne) SetBody

func (u *TokenUpsertOne) SetBody(v string) *TokenUpsertOne

SetBody sets the "body" field.

func (*TokenUpsertOne) Update

func (u *TokenUpsertOne) Update(set func(*TokenUpsert)) *TokenUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the TokenCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*TokenUpsertOne) UpdateBody

func (u *TokenUpsertOne) UpdateBody() *TokenUpsertOne

UpdateBody sets the "body" field to the value that was provided on create.

func (*TokenUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *TokenUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *TokenUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create except the ID field. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.Token.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(token.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type Tokens

type Tokens []*Token

Tokens is a parsable slice of Token.

type TraverseFunc

type TraverseFunc = ent.TraverseFunc

ent aliases to avoid import conflicts in user's code.

type Traverser

type Traverser = ent.Traverser

ent aliases to avoid import conflicts in user's code.

type Tx

type Tx struct {

	// Account is the client for interacting with the Account builders.
	Account *AccountClient
	// Blob is the client for interacting with the Blob builders.
	Blob *BlobClient
	// BlobLink is the client for interacting with the BlobLink builders.
	BlobLink *BlobLinkClient
	// Car is the client for interacting with the Car builders.
	Car *CarClient
	// Device is the client for interacting with the Device builders.
	Device *DeviceClient
	// Doc is the client for interacting with the Doc builders.
	Doc *DocClient
	// Group is the client for interacting with the Group builders.
	Group *GroupClient
	// IntSID is the client for interacting with the IntSID builders.
	IntSID *IntSIDClient
	// Link is the client for interacting with the Link builders.
	Link *LinkClient
	// MixinID is the client for interacting with the MixinID builders.
	MixinID *MixinIDClient
	// Note is the client for interacting with the Note builders.
	Note *NoteClient
	// Other is the client for interacting with the Other builders.
	Other *OtherClient
	// Pet is the client for interacting with the Pet builders.
	Pet *PetClient
	// Revision is the client for interacting with the Revision builders.
	Revision *RevisionClient
	// Session is the client for interacting with the Session builders.
	Session *SessionClient
	// Token is the client for interacting with the Token builders.
	Token *TokenClient
	// User is the client for interacting with the User builders.
	User *UserClient
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

Tx is a transactional client that is created by calling Client.Tx().

func TxFromContext

func TxFromContext(ctx context.Context) *Tx

TxFromContext returns a Tx stored inside a context, or nil if there isn't one.

func (*Tx) Client

func (tx *Tx) Client() *Client

Client returns a Client that binds to current transaction.

func (*Tx) Commit

func (tx *Tx) Commit() error

Commit commits the transaction.

func (*Tx) OnCommit

func (tx *Tx) OnCommit(f CommitHook)

OnCommit adds a hook to call on commit.

func (*Tx) OnRollback

func (tx *Tx) OnRollback(f RollbackHook)

OnRollback adds a hook to call on rollback.

func (*Tx) Rollback

func (tx *Tx) Rollback() error

Rollback rollbacks the transaction.

type User

type User struct {

	// ID of the ent.
	ID int `json:"id,omitempty"`
	// Edges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.
	// The values are being populated by the UserQuery when eager-loading is set.
	Edges UserEdges `json:"edges"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

User is the model entity for the User schema.

func (*User) QueryChildren

func (u *User) QueryChildren() *UserQuery

QueryChildren queries the "children" edge of the User entity.

func (*User) QueryGroups

func (u *User) QueryGroups() *GroupQuery

QueryGroups queries the "groups" edge of the User entity.

func (*User) QueryParent

func (u *User) QueryParent() *UserQuery

QueryParent queries the "parent" edge of the User entity.

func (*User) QueryPets

func (u *User) QueryPets() *PetQuery

QueryPets queries the "pets" edge of the User entity.

func (*User) String

func (u *User) String() string

String implements the fmt.Stringer.

func (*User) Unwrap

func (u *User) Unwrap() *User

Unwrap unwraps the User entity that was returned from a transaction after it was closed, so that all future queries will be executed through the driver which created the transaction.

func (*User) Update

func (u *User) Update() *UserUpdateOne

Update returns a builder for updating this User. Note that you need to call User.Unwrap() before calling this method if this User was returned from a transaction, and the transaction was committed or rolled back.

type UserClient

type UserClient struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

UserClient is a client for the User schema.

func NewUserClient

func NewUserClient(c config) *UserClient

NewUserClient returns a client for the User from the given config.

func (*UserClient) Create

func (c *UserClient) Create() *UserCreate

Create returns a builder for creating a User entity.

func (*UserClient) CreateBulk

func (c *UserClient) CreateBulk(builders ...*UserCreate) *UserCreateBulk

CreateBulk returns a builder for creating a bulk of User entities.

func (*UserClient) Delete

func (c *UserClient) Delete() *UserDelete

Delete returns a delete builder for User.

func (*UserClient) DeleteOne

func (c *UserClient) DeleteOne(u *User) *UserDeleteOne

DeleteOne returns a builder for deleting the given entity.

func (*UserClient) DeleteOneID

func (c *UserClient) DeleteOneID(id int) *UserDeleteOne

DeleteOneID returns a builder for deleting the given entity by its id.

func (*UserClient) Get

func (c *UserClient) Get(ctx context.Context, id int) (*User, error)

Get returns a User entity by its id.

func (*UserClient) GetX

func (c *UserClient) GetX(ctx context.Context, id int) *User

GetX is like Get, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserClient) Hooks

func (c *UserClient) Hooks() []Hook

Hooks returns the client hooks.

func (*UserClient) Intercept

func (c *UserClient) Intercept(interceptors ...Interceptor)

Use adds a list of query interceptors to the interceptors stack. A call to `Intercept(f, g, h)` equals to `user.Intercept(f(g(h())))`.

func (*UserClient) Interceptors

func (c *UserClient) Interceptors() []Interceptor

Interceptors returns the client interceptors.

func (*UserClient) Query

func (c *UserClient) Query() *UserQuery

Query returns a query builder for User.

func (*UserClient) QueryChildren

func (c *UserClient) QueryChildren(u *User) *UserQuery

QueryChildren queries the children edge of a User.

func (*UserClient) QueryGroups

func (c *UserClient) QueryGroups(u *User) *GroupQuery

QueryGroups queries the groups edge of a User.

func (*UserClient) QueryParent

func (c *UserClient) QueryParent(u *User) *UserQuery

QueryParent queries the parent edge of a User.

func (*UserClient) QueryPets

func (c *UserClient) QueryPets(u *User) *PetQuery

QueryPets queries the pets edge of a User.

func (*UserClient) Update

func (c *UserClient) Update() *UserUpdate

Update returns an update builder for User.

func (*UserClient) UpdateOne

func (c *UserClient) UpdateOne(u *User) *UserUpdateOne

UpdateOne returns an update builder for the given entity.

func (*UserClient) UpdateOneID

func (c *UserClient) UpdateOneID(id int) *UserUpdateOne

UpdateOneID returns an update builder for the given id.

func (*UserClient) Use

func (c *UserClient) Use(hooks ...Hook)

Use adds a list of mutation hooks to the hooks stack. A call to `Use(f, g, h)` equals to `user.Hooks(f(g(h())))`.

type UserCreate

type UserCreate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

UserCreate is the builder for creating a User entity.

func (*UserCreate) AddChildIDs

func (uc *UserCreate) AddChildIDs(ids ...int) *UserCreate

AddChildIDs adds the "children" edge to the User entity by IDs.

func (*UserCreate) AddChildren

func (uc *UserCreate) AddChildren(u ...*User) *UserCreate

AddChildren adds the "children" edges to the User entity.

func (*UserCreate) AddGroupIDs

func (uc *UserCreate) AddGroupIDs(ids ...int) *UserCreate

AddGroupIDs adds the "groups" edge to the Group entity by IDs.

func (*UserCreate) AddGroups

func (uc *UserCreate) AddGroups(g ...*Group) *UserCreate

AddGroups adds the "groups" edges to the Group entity.

func (*UserCreate) AddPetIDs

func (uc *UserCreate) AddPetIDs(ids ...string) *UserCreate

AddPetIDs adds the "pets" edge to the Pet entity by IDs.

func (*UserCreate) AddPets

func (uc *UserCreate) AddPets(p ...*Pet) *UserCreate

AddPets adds the "pets" edges to the Pet entity.

func (*UserCreate) Exec

func (uc *UserCreate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*UserCreate) ExecX

func (uc *UserCreate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserCreate) Mutation

func (uc *UserCreate) Mutation() *UserMutation

Mutation returns the UserMutation object of the builder.

func (*UserCreate) OnConflict

func (uc *UserCreate) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *UserUpsertOne

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.User.Create().
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*UserCreate) OnConflictColumns

func (uc *UserCreate) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *UserUpsertOne

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.User.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*UserCreate) Save

func (uc *UserCreate) Save(ctx context.Context) (*User, error)

Save creates the User in the database.

func (*UserCreate) SaveX

func (uc *UserCreate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *User

SaveX calls Save and panics if Save returns an error.

func (*UserCreate) SetID

func (uc *UserCreate) SetID(i int) *UserCreate

SetID sets the "id" field.

func (*UserCreate) SetNillableParentID

func (uc *UserCreate) SetNillableParentID(id *int) *UserCreate

SetNillableParentID sets the "parent" edge to the User entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*UserCreate) SetParent

func (uc *UserCreate) SetParent(u *User) *UserCreate

SetParent sets the "parent" edge to the User entity.

func (*UserCreate) SetParentID

func (uc *UserCreate) SetParentID(id int) *UserCreate

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the User entity by ID.

type UserCreateBulk

type UserCreateBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

UserCreateBulk is the builder for creating many User entities in bulk.

func (*UserCreateBulk) Exec

func (ucb *UserCreateBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*UserCreateBulk) ExecX

func (ucb *UserCreateBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserCreateBulk) OnConflict

func (ucb *UserCreateBulk) OnConflict(opts ...sql.ConflictOption) *UserUpsertBulk

OnConflict allows configuring the `ON CONFLICT` / `ON DUPLICATE KEY` clause of the `INSERT` statement. For example:

client.User.CreateBulk(builders...).
	OnConflict(
		// Update the row with the new values
		// the was proposed for insertion.
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*UserCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns

func (ucb *UserCreateBulk) OnConflictColumns(columns ...string) *UserUpsertBulk

OnConflictColumns calls `OnConflict` and configures the columns as conflict target. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.User.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ConflictColumns(columns...)).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*UserCreateBulk) Save

func (ucb *UserCreateBulk) Save(ctx context.Context) ([]*User, error)

Save creates the User entities in the database.

func (*UserCreateBulk) SaveX

func (ucb *UserCreateBulk) SaveX(ctx context.Context) []*User

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

type UserDelete

type UserDelete struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

UserDelete is the builder for deleting a User entity.

func (*UserDelete) Exec

func (ud *UserDelete) Exec(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Exec executes the deletion query and returns how many vertices were deleted.

func (*UserDelete) ExecX

func (ud *UserDelete) ExecX(ctx context.Context) int

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserDelete) Where

func (ud *UserDelete) Where(ps ...predicate.User) *UserDelete

Where appends a list predicates to the UserDelete builder.

type UserDeleteOne

type UserDeleteOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

UserDeleteOne is the builder for deleting a single User entity.

func (*UserDeleteOne) Exec

func (udo *UserDeleteOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the deletion query.

func (*UserDeleteOne) ExecX

func (udo *UserDeleteOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

type UserEdges

type UserEdges struct {
	// Groups holds the value of the groups edge.
	Groups []*Group `json:"groups,omitempty"`
	// Parent holds the value of the parent edge.
	Parent *User `json:"parent,omitempty"`
	// Children holds the value of the children edge.
	Children []*User `json:"children,omitempty"`
	// Pets holds the value of the pets edge.
	Pets []*Pet `json:"pets,omitempty"`
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

UserEdges holds the relations/edges for other nodes in the graph.

func (UserEdges) ChildrenOrErr

func (e UserEdges) ChildrenOrErr() ([]*User, error)

ChildrenOrErr returns the Children value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading.

func (UserEdges) GroupsOrErr

func (e UserEdges) GroupsOrErr() ([]*Group, error)

GroupsOrErr returns the Groups value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading.

func (UserEdges) ParentOrErr

func (e UserEdges) ParentOrErr() (*User, error)

ParentOrErr returns the Parent value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading, or loaded but was not found.

func (UserEdges) PetsOrErr

func (e UserEdges) PetsOrErr() ([]*Pet, error)

PetsOrErr returns the Pets value or an error if the edge was not loaded in eager-loading.

type UserFilter

type UserFilter struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

UserFilter provides a generic filtering capability at runtime for UserQuery.

func (*UserFilter) Where

func (f *UserFilter) Where(p entql.P)

Where applies the entql predicate on the query filter.

func (*UserFilter) WhereHasChildren

func (f *UserFilter) WhereHasChildren()

WhereHasChildren applies a predicate to check if query has an edge children.

func (*UserFilter) WhereHasChildrenWith

func (f *UserFilter) WhereHasChildrenWith(preds ...predicate.User)

WhereHasChildrenWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge children with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*UserFilter) WhereHasGroups

func (f *UserFilter) WhereHasGroups()

WhereHasGroups applies a predicate to check if query has an edge groups.

func (*UserFilter) WhereHasGroupsWith

func (f *UserFilter) WhereHasGroupsWith(preds ...predicate.Group)

WhereHasGroupsWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge groups with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*UserFilter) WhereHasParent

func (f *UserFilter) WhereHasParent()

WhereHasParent applies a predicate to check if query has an edge parent.

func (*UserFilter) WhereHasParentWith

func (f *UserFilter) WhereHasParentWith(preds ...predicate.User)

WhereHasParentWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge parent with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*UserFilter) WhereHasPets

func (f *UserFilter) WhereHasPets()

WhereHasPets applies a predicate to check if query has an edge pets.

func (*UserFilter) WhereHasPetsWith

func (f *UserFilter) WhereHasPetsWith(preds ...predicate.Pet)

WhereHasPetsWith applies a predicate to check if query has an edge pets with a given conditions (other predicates).

func (*UserFilter) WhereID

func (f *UserFilter) WhereID(p entql.IntP)

WhereID applies the entql int predicate on the id field.

type UserGroupBy

type UserGroupBy struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

UserGroupBy is the group-by builder for User entities.

func (*UserGroupBy) Aggregate

func (ugb *UserGroupBy) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *UserGroupBy

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the group-by query.

func (*UserGroupBy) Bool

func (s *UserGroupBy) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*UserGroupBy) BoolX

func (s *UserGroupBy) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserGroupBy) Bools

func (s *UserGroupBy) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*UserGroupBy) BoolsX

func (s *UserGroupBy) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserGroupBy) Float64

func (s *UserGroupBy) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*UserGroupBy) Float64X

func (s *UserGroupBy) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserGroupBy) Float64s

func (s *UserGroupBy) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*UserGroupBy) Float64sX

func (s *UserGroupBy) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserGroupBy) Int

func (s *UserGroupBy) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*UserGroupBy) IntX

func (s *UserGroupBy) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserGroupBy) Ints

func (s *UserGroupBy) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*UserGroupBy) IntsX

func (s *UserGroupBy) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserGroupBy) Scan

func (ugb *UserGroupBy) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*UserGroupBy) ScanX

func (s *UserGroupBy) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserGroupBy) String

func (s *UserGroupBy) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*UserGroupBy) StringX

func (s *UserGroupBy) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserGroupBy) Strings

func (s *UserGroupBy) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*UserGroupBy) StringsX

func (s *UserGroupBy) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type UserMutation

type UserMutation struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

UserMutation represents an operation that mutates the User nodes in the graph.

func (*UserMutation) AddChildIDs

func (m *UserMutation) AddChildIDs(ids ...int)

AddChildIDs adds the "children" edge to the User entity by ids.

func (*UserMutation) AddField

func (m *UserMutation) AddField(name string, value ent.Value) error

AddField adds the value to the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*UserMutation) AddGroupIDs

func (m *UserMutation) AddGroupIDs(ids ...int)

AddGroupIDs adds the "groups" edge to the Group entity by ids.

func (*UserMutation) AddPetIDs

func (m *UserMutation) AddPetIDs(ids ...string)

AddPetIDs adds the "pets" edge to the Pet entity by ids.

func (*UserMutation) AddedEdges

func (m *UserMutation) AddedEdges() []string

AddedEdges returns all edge names that were set/added in this mutation.

func (*UserMutation) AddedField

func (m *UserMutation) AddedField(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

AddedField returns the numeric value that was incremented/decremented on a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*UserMutation) AddedFields

func (m *UserMutation) AddedFields() []string

AddedFields returns all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented during this mutation.

func (*UserMutation) AddedIDs

func (m *UserMutation) AddedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

AddedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were added for the given edge name in this mutation.

func (*UserMutation) ChildrenCleared

func (m *UserMutation) ChildrenCleared() bool

ChildrenCleared reports if the "children" edge to the User entity was cleared.

func (*UserMutation) ChildrenIDs

func (m *UserMutation) ChildrenIDs() (ids []int)

ChildrenIDs returns the "children" edge IDs in the mutation.

func (*UserMutation) ClearChildren

func (m *UserMutation) ClearChildren()

ClearChildren clears the "children" edge to the User entity.

func (*UserMutation) ClearEdge

func (m *UserMutation) ClearEdge(name string) error

ClearEdge clears the value of the edge with the given name. It returns an error if that edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*UserMutation) ClearField

func (m *UserMutation) ClearField(name string) error

ClearField clears the value of the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*UserMutation) ClearGroups

func (m *UserMutation) ClearGroups()

ClearGroups clears the "groups" edge to the Group entity.

func (*UserMutation) ClearParent

func (m *UserMutation) ClearParent()

ClearParent clears the "parent" edge to the User entity.

func (*UserMutation) ClearPets

func (m *UserMutation) ClearPets()

ClearPets clears the "pets" edge to the Pet entity.

func (*UserMutation) ClearedEdges

func (m *UserMutation) ClearedEdges() []string

ClearedEdges returns all edge names that were cleared in this mutation.

func (*UserMutation) ClearedFields

func (m *UserMutation) ClearedFields() []string

ClearedFields returns all nullable fields that were cleared during this mutation.

func (UserMutation) Client

func (m UserMutation) Client() *Client

Client returns a new `ent.Client` from the mutation. If the mutation was executed in a transaction (ent.Tx), a transactional client is returned.

func (*UserMutation) EdgeCleared

func (m *UserMutation) EdgeCleared(name string) bool

EdgeCleared returns a boolean which indicates if the edge with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*UserMutation) Field

func (m *UserMutation) Field(name string) (ent.Value, bool)

Field returns the value of a field with the given name. The second boolean return value indicates that this field was not set, or was not defined in the schema.

func (*UserMutation) FieldCleared

func (m *UserMutation) FieldCleared(name string) bool

FieldCleared returns a boolean indicating if a field with the given name was cleared in this mutation.

func (*UserMutation) Fields

func (m *UserMutation) Fields() []string

Fields returns all fields that were changed during this mutation. Note that in order to get all numeric fields that were incremented/decremented, call AddedFields().

func (*UserMutation) Filter

func (m *UserMutation) Filter() *UserFilter

Filter returns an entql.Where implementation to apply filters on the UserMutation builder.

func (*UserMutation) GroupsCleared

func (m *UserMutation) GroupsCleared() bool

GroupsCleared reports if the "groups" edge to the Group entity was cleared.

func (*UserMutation) GroupsIDs

func (m *UserMutation) GroupsIDs() (ids []int)

GroupsIDs returns the "groups" edge IDs in the mutation.

func (*UserMutation) ID

func (m *UserMutation) ID() (id int, exists bool)

ID returns the ID value in the mutation. Note that the ID is only available if it was provided to the builder or after it was returned from the database.

func (*UserMutation) IDs

func (m *UserMutation) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

IDs queries the database and returns the entity ids that match the mutation's predicate. That means, if the mutation is applied within a transaction with an isolation level such as sql.LevelSerializable, the returned ids match the ids of the rows that will be updated or updated by the mutation.

func (*UserMutation) OldField

func (m *UserMutation) OldField(ctx context.Context, name string) (ent.Value, error)

OldField returns the old value of the field from the database. An error is returned if the mutation operation is not UpdateOne, or the query to the database failed.

func (*UserMutation) Op

func (m *UserMutation) Op() Op

Op returns the operation name.

func (*UserMutation) ParentCleared

func (m *UserMutation) ParentCleared() bool

ParentCleared reports if the "parent" edge to the User entity was cleared.

func (*UserMutation) ParentID

func (m *UserMutation) ParentID() (id int, exists bool)

ParentID returns the "parent" edge ID in the mutation.

func (*UserMutation) ParentIDs

func (m *UserMutation) ParentIDs() (ids []int)

ParentIDs returns the "parent" edge IDs in the mutation. Note that IDs always returns len(IDs) <= 1 for unique edges, and you should use ParentID instead. It exists only for internal usage by the builders.

func (*UserMutation) PetsCleared

func (m *UserMutation) PetsCleared() bool

PetsCleared reports if the "pets" edge to the Pet entity was cleared.

func (*UserMutation) PetsIDs

func (m *UserMutation) PetsIDs() (ids []string)

PetsIDs returns the "pets" edge IDs in the mutation.

func (*UserMutation) RemoveChildIDs

func (m *UserMutation) RemoveChildIDs(ids ...int)

RemoveChildIDs removes the "children" edge to the User entity by IDs.

func (*UserMutation) RemoveGroupIDs

func (m *UserMutation) RemoveGroupIDs(ids ...int)

RemoveGroupIDs removes the "groups" edge to the Group entity by IDs.

func (*UserMutation) RemovePetIDs

func (m *UserMutation) RemovePetIDs(ids ...string)

RemovePetIDs removes the "pets" edge to the Pet entity by IDs.

func (*UserMutation) RemovedChildrenIDs

func (m *UserMutation) RemovedChildrenIDs() (ids []int)

RemovedChildren returns the removed IDs of the "children" edge to the User entity.

func (*UserMutation) RemovedEdges

func (m *UserMutation) RemovedEdges() []string

RemovedEdges returns all edge names that were removed in this mutation.

func (*UserMutation) RemovedGroupsIDs

func (m *UserMutation) RemovedGroupsIDs() (ids []int)

RemovedGroups returns the removed IDs of the "groups" edge to the Group entity.

func (*UserMutation) RemovedIDs

func (m *UserMutation) RemovedIDs(name string) []ent.Value

RemovedIDs returns all IDs (to other nodes) that were removed for the edge with the given name in this mutation.

func (*UserMutation) RemovedPetsIDs

func (m *UserMutation) RemovedPetsIDs() (ids []string)

RemovedPets returns the removed IDs of the "pets" edge to the Pet entity.

func (*UserMutation) ResetChildren

func (m *UserMutation) ResetChildren()

ResetChildren resets all changes to the "children" edge.

func (*UserMutation) ResetEdge

func (m *UserMutation) ResetEdge(name string) error

ResetEdge resets all changes to the edge with the given name in this mutation. It returns an error if the edge is not defined in the schema.

func (*UserMutation) ResetField

func (m *UserMutation) ResetField(name string) error

ResetField resets all changes in the mutation for the field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema.

func (*UserMutation) ResetGroups

func (m *UserMutation) ResetGroups()

ResetGroups resets all changes to the "groups" edge.

func (*UserMutation) ResetParent

func (m *UserMutation) ResetParent()

ResetParent resets all changes to the "parent" edge.

func (*UserMutation) ResetPets

func (m *UserMutation) ResetPets()

ResetPets resets all changes to the "pets" edge.

func (*UserMutation) SetField

func (m *UserMutation) SetField(name string, value ent.Value) error

SetField sets the value of a field with the given name. It returns an error if the field is not defined in the schema, or if the type mismatched the field type.

func (*UserMutation) SetID

func (m *UserMutation) SetID(id int)

SetID sets the value of the id field. Note that this operation is only accepted on creation of User entities.

func (*UserMutation) SetOp

func (m *UserMutation) SetOp(op Op)

SetOp allows setting the mutation operation.

func (*UserMutation) SetParentID

func (m *UserMutation) SetParentID(id int)

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the User entity by id.

func (UserMutation) Tx

func (m UserMutation) Tx() (*Tx, error)

Tx returns an `ent.Tx` for mutations that were executed in transactions; it returns an error otherwise.

func (*UserMutation) Type

func (m *UserMutation) Type() string

Type returns the node type of this mutation (User).

func (*UserMutation) Where

func (m *UserMutation) Where(ps ...predicate.User)

Where appends a list predicates to the UserMutation builder.

func (*UserMutation) WhereP

func (m *UserMutation) WhereP(ps ...func(*sql.Selector))

WhereP appends storage-level predicates to the UserMutation builder. Using this method, users can use type-assertion to append predicates that do not depend on any generated package.

type UserQuery

type UserQuery struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

UserQuery is the builder for querying User entities.

func (*UserQuery) Aggregate

func (uq *UserQuery) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *UserSelect

Aggregate returns a UserSelect configured with the given aggregations.

func (*UserQuery) All

func (uq *UserQuery) All(ctx context.Context) ([]*User, error)

All executes the query and returns a list of Users.

func (*UserQuery) AllX

func (uq *UserQuery) AllX(ctx context.Context) []*User

AllX is like All, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserQuery) Clone

func (uq *UserQuery) Clone() *UserQuery

Clone returns a duplicate of the UserQuery builder, including all associated steps. It can be used to prepare common query builders and use them differently after the clone is made.

func (*UserQuery) Count

func (uq *UserQuery) Count(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Count returns the count of the given query.

func (*UserQuery) CountX

func (uq *UserQuery) CountX(ctx context.Context) int

CountX is like Count, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserQuery) Exist

func (uq *UserQuery) Exist(ctx context.Context) (bool, error)

Exist returns true if the query has elements in the graph.

func (*UserQuery) ExistX

func (uq *UserQuery) ExistX(ctx context.Context) bool

ExistX is like Exist, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserQuery) Filter

func (uq *UserQuery) Filter() *UserFilter

Filter returns a Filter implementation to apply filters on the UserQuery builder.

func (*UserQuery) First

func (uq *UserQuery) First(ctx context.Context) (*User, error)

First returns the first User entity from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no User was found.

func (*UserQuery) FirstID

func (uq *UserQuery) FirstID(ctx context.Context) (id int, err error)

FirstID returns the first User ID from the query. Returns a *NotFoundError when no User ID was found.

func (*UserQuery) FirstIDX

func (uq *UserQuery) FirstIDX(ctx context.Context) int

FirstIDX is like FirstID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserQuery) FirstX

func (uq *UserQuery) FirstX(ctx context.Context) *User

FirstX is like First, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserQuery) GroupBy

func (uq *UserQuery) GroupBy(field string, fields ...string) *UserGroupBy

GroupBy is used to group vertices by one or more fields/columns. It is often used with aggregate functions, like: count, max, mean, min, sum.

func (*UserQuery) IDs

func (uq *UserQuery) IDs(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

IDs executes the query and returns a list of User IDs.

func (*UserQuery) IDsX

func (uq *UserQuery) IDsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IDsX is like IDs, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserQuery) Limit

func (uq *UserQuery) Limit(limit int) *UserQuery

Limit the number of records to be returned by this query.

func (*UserQuery) Offset

func (uq *UserQuery) Offset(offset int) *UserQuery

Offset to start from.

func (*UserQuery) Only

func (uq *UserQuery) Only(ctx context.Context) (*User, error)

Only returns a single User entity found by the query, ensuring it only returns one. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one User entity is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no User entities are found.

func (*UserQuery) OnlyID

func (uq *UserQuery) OnlyID(ctx context.Context) (id int, err error)

OnlyID is like Only, but returns the only User ID in the query. Returns a *NotSingularError when more than one User ID is found. Returns a *NotFoundError when no entities are found.

func (*UserQuery) OnlyIDX

func (uq *UserQuery) OnlyIDX(ctx context.Context) int

OnlyIDX is like OnlyID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserQuery) OnlyX

func (uq *UserQuery) OnlyX(ctx context.Context) *User

OnlyX is like Only, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserQuery) Order

func (uq *UserQuery) Order(o ...OrderFunc) *UserQuery

Order specifies how the records should be ordered.

func (*UserQuery) QueryChildren

func (uq *UserQuery) QueryChildren() *UserQuery

QueryChildren chains the current query on the "children" edge.

func (*UserQuery) QueryGroups

func (uq *UserQuery) QueryGroups() *GroupQuery

QueryGroups chains the current query on the "groups" edge.

func (*UserQuery) QueryParent

func (uq *UserQuery) QueryParent() *UserQuery

QueryParent chains the current query on the "parent" edge.

func (*UserQuery) QueryPets

func (uq *UserQuery) QueryPets() *PetQuery

QueryPets chains the current query on the "pets" edge.

func (*UserQuery) Select

func (uq *UserQuery) Select(fields ...string) *UserSelect

Select allows the selection one or more fields/columns for the given query, instead of selecting all fields in the entity.

func (*UserQuery) Unique

func (uq *UserQuery) Unique(unique bool) *UserQuery

Unique configures the query builder to filter duplicate records on query. By default, unique is set to true, and can be disabled using this method.

func (*UserQuery) Where

func (uq *UserQuery) Where(ps ...predicate.User) *UserQuery

Where adds a new predicate for the UserQuery builder.

func (*UserQuery) WithChildren

func (uq *UserQuery) WithChildren(opts ...func(*UserQuery)) *UserQuery

WithChildren tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "children" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

func (*UserQuery) WithGroups

func (uq *UserQuery) WithGroups(opts ...func(*GroupQuery)) *UserQuery

WithGroups tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "groups" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

func (*UserQuery) WithParent

func (uq *UserQuery) WithParent(opts ...func(*UserQuery)) *UserQuery

WithParent tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "parent" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

func (*UserQuery) WithPets

func (uq *UserQuery) WithPets(opts ...func(*PetQuery)) *UserQuery

WithPets tells the query-builder to eager-load the nodes that are connected to the "pets" edge. The optional arguments are used to configure the query builder of the edge.

type UserSelect

type UserSelect struct {
	*UserQuery
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

UserSelect is the builder for selecting fields of User entities.

func (*UserSelect) Aggregate

func (us *UserSelect) Aggregate(fns ...AggregateFunc) *UserSelect

Aggregate adds the given aggregation functions to the selector query.

func (*UserSelect) Bool

func (s *UserSelect) Bool(ctx context.Context) (_ bool, err error)

Bool returns a single bool from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*UserSelect) BoolX

func (s *UserSelect) BoolX(ctx context.Context) bool

BoolX is like Bool, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserSelect) Bools

func (s *UserSelect) Bools(ctx context.Context) ([]bool, error)

Bools returns list of bools from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*UserSelect) BoolsX

func (s *UserSelect) BoolsX(ctx context.Context) []bool

BoolsX is like Bools, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserSelect) Float64

func (s *UserSelect) Float64(ctx context.Context) (_ float64, err error)

Float64 returns a single float64 from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*UserSelect) Float64X

func (s *UserSelect) Float64X(ctx context.Context) float64

Float64X is like Float64, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserSelect) Float64s

func (s *UserSelect) Float64s(ctx context.Context) ([]float64, error)

Float64s returns list of float64s from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*UserSelect) Float64sX

func (s *UserSelect) Float64sX(ctx context.Context) []float64

Float64sX is like Float64s, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserSelect) Int

func (s *UserSelect) Int(ctx context.Context) (_ int, err error)

Int returns a single int from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*UserSelect) IntX

func (s *UserSelect) IntX(ctx context.Context) int

IntX is like Int, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserSelect) Ints

func (s *UserSelect) Ints(ctx context.Context) ([]int, error)

Ints returns list of ints from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*UserSelect) IntsX

func (s *UserSelect) IntsX(ctx context.Context) []int

IntsX is like Ints, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserSelect) Scan

func (us *UserSelect) Scan(ctx context.Context, v any) error

Scan applies the selector query and scans the result into the given value.

func (*UserSelect) ScanX

func (s *UserSelect) ScanX(ctx context.Context, v any)

ScanX is like Scan, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserSelect) String

func (s *UserSelect) String(ctx context.Context) (_ string, err error)

String returns a single string from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*UserSelect) StringX

func (s *UserSelect) StringX(ctx context.Context) string

StringX is like String, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserSelect) Strings

func (s *UserSelect) Strings(ctx context.Context) ([]string, error)

Strings returns list of strings from a selector. It is only allowed when selecting one field.

func (*UserSelect) StringsX

func (s *UserSelect) StringsX(ctx context.Context) []string

StringsX is like Strings, but panics if an error occurs.

type UserUpdate

type UserUpdate struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

UserUpdate is the builder for updating User entities.

func (*UserUpdate) AddChildIDs

func (uu *UserUpdate) AddChildIDs(ids ...int) *UserUpdate

AddChildIDs adds the "children" edge to the User entity by IDs.

func (*UserUpdate) AddChildren

func (uu *UserUpdate) AddChildren(u ...*User) *UserUpdate

AddChildren adds the "children" edges to the User entity.

func (*UserUpdate) AddGroupIDs

func (uu *UserUpdate) AddGroupIDs(ids ...int) *UserUpdate

AddGroupIDs adds the "groups" edge to the Group entity by IDs.

func (*UserUpdate) AddGroups

func (uu *UserUpdate) AddGroups(g ...*Group) *UserUpdate

AddGroups adds the "groups" edges to the Group entity.

func (*UserUpdate) AddPetIDs

func (uu *UserUpdate) AddPetIDs(ids ...string) *UserUpdate

AddPetIDs adds the "pets" edge to the Pet entity by IDs.

func (*UserUpdate) AddPets

func (uu *UserUpdate) AddPets(p ...*Pet) *UserUpdate

AddPets adds the "pets" edges to the Pet entity.

func (*UserUpdate) ClearChildren

func (uu *UserUpdate) ClearChildren() *UserUpdate

ClearChildren clears all "children" edges to the User entity.

func (*UserUpdate) ClearGroups

func (uu *UserUpdate) ClearGroups() *UserUpdate

ClearGroups clears all "groups" edges to the Group entity.

func (*UserUpdate) ClearParent

func (uu *UserUpdate) ClearParent() *UserUpdate

ClearParent clears the "parent" edge to the User entity.

func (*UserUpdate) ClearPets

func (uu *UserUpdate) ClearPets() *UserUpdate

ClearPets clears all "pets" edges to the Pet entity.

func (*UserUpdate) Exec

func (uu *UserUpdate) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*UserUpdate) ExecX

func (uu *UserUpdate) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserUpdate) Mutation

func (uu *UserUpdate) Mutation() *UserMutation

Mutation returns the UserMutation object of the builder.

func (*UserUpdate) RemoveChildIDs

func (uu *UserUpdate) RemoveChildIDs(ids ...int) *UserUpdate

RemoveChildIDs removes the "children" edge to User entities by IDs.

func (*UserUpdate) RemoveChildren

func (uu *UserUpdate) RemoveChildren(u ...*User) *UserUpdate

RemoveChildren removes "children" edges to User entities.

func (*UserUpdate) RemoveGroupIDs

func (uu *UserUpdate) RemoveGroupIDs(ids ...int) *UserUpdate

RemoveGroupIDs removes the "groups" edge to Group entities by IDs.

func (*UserUpdate) RemoveGroups

func (uu *UserUpdate) RemoveGroups(g ...*Group) *UserUpdate

RemoveGroups removes "groups" edges to Group entities.

func (*UserUpdate) RemovePetIDs

func (uu *UserUpdate) RemovePetIDs(ids ...string) *UserUpdate

RemovePetIDs removes the "pets" edge to Pet entities by IDs.

func (*UserUpdate) RemovePets

func (uu *UserUpdate) RemovePets(p ...*Pet) *UserUpdate

RemovePets removes "pets" edges to Pet entities.

func (*UserUpdate) Save

func (uu *UserUpdate) Save(ctx context.Context) (int, error)

Save executes the query and returns the number of nodes affected by the update operation.

func (*UserUpdate) SaveX

func (uu *UserUpdate) SaveX(ctx context.Context) int

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserUpdate) SetNillableParentID

func (uu *UserUpdate) SetNillableParentID(id *int) *UserUpdate

SetNillableParentID sets the "parent" edge to the User entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*UserUpdate) SetParent

func (uu *UserUpdate) SetParent(u *User) *UserUpdate

SetParent sets the "parent" edge to the User entity.

func (*UserUpdate) SetParentID

func (uu *UserUpdate) SetParentID(id int) *UserUpdate

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the User entity by ID.

func (*UserUpdate) Where

func (uu *UserUpdate) Where(ps ...predicate.User) *UserUpdate

Where appends a list predicates to the UserUpdate builder.

type UserUpdateOne

type UserUpdateOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

UserUpdateOne is the builder for updating a single User entity.

func (*UserUpdateOne) AddChildIDs

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) AddChildIDs(ids ...int) *UserUpdateOne

AddChildIDs adds the "children" edge to the User entity by IDs.

func (*UserUpdateOne) AddChildren

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) AddChildren(u ...*User) *UserUpdateOne

AddChildren adds the "children" edges to the User entity.

func (*UserUpdateOne) AddGroupIDs

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) AddGroupIDs(ids ...int) *UserUpdateOne

AddGroupIDs adds the "groups" edge to the Group entity by IDs.

func (*UserUpdateOne) AddGroups

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) AddGroups(g ...*Group) *UserUpdateOne

AddGroups adds the "groups" edges to the Group entity.

func (*UserUpdateOne) AddPetIDs

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) AddPetIDs(ids ...string) *UserUpdateOne

AddPetIDs adds the "pets" edge to the Pet entity by IDs.

func (*UserUpdateOne) AddPets

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) AddPets(p ...*Pet) *UserUpdateOne

AddPets adds the "pets" edges to the Pet entity.

func (*UserUpdateOne) ClearChildren

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) ClearChildren() *UserUpdateOne

ClearChildren clears all "children" edges to the User entity.

func (*UserUpdateOne) ClearGroups

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) ClearGroups() *UserUpdateOne

ClearGroups clears all "groups" edges to the Group entity.

func (*UserUpdateOne) ClearParent

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) ClearParent() *UserUpdateOne

ClearParent clears the "parent" edge to the User entity.

func (*UserUpdateOne) ClearPets

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) ClearPets() *UserUpdateOne

ClearPets clears all "pets" edges to the Pet entity.

func (*UserUpdateOne) Exec

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query on the entity.

func (*UserUpdateOne) ExecX

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserUpdateOne) Mutation

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) Mutation() *UserMutation

Mutation returns the UserMutation object of the builder.

func (*UserUpdateOne) RemoveChildIDs

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) RemoveChildIDs(ids ...int) *UserUpdateOne

RemoveChildIDs removes the "children" edge to User entities by IDs.

func (*UserUpdateOne) RemoveChildren

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) RemoveChildren(u ...*User) *UserUpdateOne

RemoveChildren removes "children" edges to User entities.

func (*UserUpdateOne) RemoveGroupIDs

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) RemoveGroupIDs(ids ...int) *UserUpdateOne

RemoveGroupIDs removes the "groups" edge to Group entities by IDs.

func (*UserUpdateOne) RemoveGroups

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) RemoveGroups(g ...*Group) *UserUpdateOne

RemoveGroups removes "groups" edges to Group entities.

func (*UserUpdateOne) RemovePetIDs

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) RemovePetIDs(ids ...string) *UserUpdateOne

RemovePetIDs removes the "pets" edge to Pet entities by IDs.

func (*UserUpdateOne) RemovePets

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) RemovePets(p ...*Pet) *UserUpdateOne

RemovePets removes "pets" edges to Pet entities.

func (*UserUpdateOne) Save

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) Save(ctx context.Context) (*User, error)

Save executes the query and returns the updated User entity.

func (*UserUpdateOne) SaveX

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) SaveX(ctx context.Context) *User

SaveX is like Save, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserUpdateOne) Select

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) Select(field string, fields ...string) *UserUpdateOne

Select allows selecting one or more fields (columns) of the returned entity. The default is selecting all fields defined in the entity schema.

func (*UserUpdateOne) SetNillableParentID

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) SetNillableParentID(id *int) *UserUpdateOne

SetNillableParentID sets the "parent" edge to the User entity by ID if the given value is not nil.

func (*UserUpdateOne) SetParent

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) SetParent(u *User) *UserUpdateOne

SetParent sets the "parent" edge to the User entity.

func (*UserUpdateOne) SetParentID

func (uuo *UserUpdateOne) SetParentID(id int) *UserUpdateOne

SetParentID sets the "parent" edge to the User entity by ID.

type UserUpsert

type UserUpsert struct {
	*sql.UpdateSet
}

UserUpsert is the "OnConflict" setter.

type UserUpsertBulk

type UserUpsertBulk struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

UserUpsertBulk is the builder for "upsert"-ing a bulk of User nodes.

func (*UserUpsertBulk) DoNothing

func (u *UserUpsertBulk) DoNothing() *UserUpsertBulk

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*UserUpsertBulk) Exec

func (u *UserUpsertBulk) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*UserUpsertBulk) ExecX

func (u *UserUpsertBulk) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserUpsertBulk) Ignore

func (u *UserUpsertBulk) Ignore() *UserUpsertBulk

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.User.Create().
	OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
	Exec(ctx)

func (*UserUpsertBulk) Update

func (u *UserUpsertBulk) Update(set func(*UserUpsert)) *UserUpsertBulk

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the UserCreateBulk.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*UserUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues

func (u *UserUpsertBulk) UpdateNewValues() *UserUpsertBulk

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.User.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(user.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type UserUpsertOne

type UserUpsertOne struct {
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

UserUpsertOne is the builder for "upsert"-ing

one User node.

func (*UserUpsertOne) DoNothing

func (u *UserUpsertOne) DoNothing() *UserUpsertOne

DoNothing configures the conflict_action to `DO NOTHING`. Supported only by SQLite and PostgreSQL.

func (*UserUpsertOne) Exec

func (u *UserUpsertOne) Exec(ctx context.Context) error

Exec executes the query.

func (*UserUpsertOne) ExecX

func (u *UserUpsertOne) ExecX(ctx context.Context)

ExecX is like Exec, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserUpsertOne) ID

func (u *UserUpsertOne) ID(ctx context.Context) (id int, err error)

Exec executes the UPSERT query and returns the inserted/updated ID.

func (*UserUpsertOne) IDX

func (u *UserUpsertOne) IDX(ctx context.Context) int

IDX is like ID, but panics if an error occurs.

func (*UserUpsertOne) Ignore

func (u *UserUpsertOne) Ignore() *UserUpsertOne

Ignore sets each column to itself in case of conflict. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.User.Create().
    OnConflict(sql.ResolveWithIgnore()).
    Exec(ctx)

func (*UserUpsertOne) Update

func (u *UserUpsertOne) Update(set func(*UserUpsert)) *UserUpsertOne

Update allows overriding fields `UPDATE` values. See the UserCreate.OnConflict documentation for more info.

func (*UserUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues

func (u *UserUpsertOne) UpdateNewValues() *UserUpsertOne

UpdateNewValues updates the mutable fields using the new values that were set on create except the ID field. Using this option is equivalent to using:

client.User.Create().
	OnConflict(
		sql.ResolveWithNewValues(),
		sql.ResolveWith(func(u *sql.UpdateSet) {
			u.SetIgnore(user.FieldID)
		}),
	).
	Exec(ctx)

type Users

type Users []*User

Users is a parsable slice of User.

type ValidationError

type ValidationError struct {
	Name string // Field or edge name.
	// contains filtered or unexported fields
}

ValidationError returns when validating a field or edge fails.

func (*ValidationError) Error

func (e *ValidationError) Error() string

Error implements the error interface.

func (*ValidationError) Unwrap

func (e *ValidationError) Unwrap() error

Unwrap implements the errors.Wrapper interface.

type Value

type Value = ent.Value

ent aliases to avoid import conflicts in user's code.

Jump to

Keyboard shortcuts

? : This menu
/ : Search site
f or F : Jump to
y or Y : Canonical URL